Unassociated Document
 
Report of Foreign Private Issuer

Pursuant to Rule 13a-16 or 15d-16 of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

31 August 2012



The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc


Gogarburn
PO Box 1000
Edinburgh EH12 1HQ
Scotland
United Kingdom

(Address of principal executive offices)



Indicate by check mark whether the registrant files or will file annual reports under cover of Form 20-F or Form 40-F.

Form 20-F                                              Form 40-F     

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is submitting the Form 6-K in paper as permitted by Regulation S-T Rule 101(b)(1):__

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is submitting the Form 6-K in paper as permitted by Regulation S-T Rule 101(b)(7):__

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant by furnishing the information contained in this Form is also thereby furnishing the information to the Commission pursuant to Rule 12g3-2(b) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes                                                                  No  X 

If "Yes" is marked, indicate below the file number assigned to
the registrant in connection with Rule 12g3-2(b): 82-            

This report on Form 6-K shall be deemed incorporated by reference into the company's Registration Statement on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-162219 and 333-162219-01) and to be a part thereof from the date which it was filed, to the extent not superseded by documents or reports subsequently filed or furnished.

 
 

 
 
Explanatory Note
 
The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc (the "Group") is filing this Form 6-K to add note 20 (Consolidating financial information) to its results for the six months ended 30 June 2012 and to update note 16 (Litigation, investigations and reviews) for recent developments relating to 'Multilateral interchange fees', 'Technology incident' and 'Securitisation and collateralised debt obligation business', which were previously filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") on a separate Form 6-K on 8 August 2012. Note 20 contains condensed consolidating financial information in accordance with Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X for:

- RBSG plc on a stand-alone basis as guarantor ("RBSG Company")
- RBS plc on a stand-alone basis as issuer ("RBS Company")
- Non-guarantor Subsidiaries of RBSG Company and RBS Company on a combined basis ("Subsidiaries")
- Consolidation adjustments; and
- RBSG plc consolidated amounts ("RBSG Group").
 
References in this Form 6-K to the Group's annual report for the year ended 31 December 2011 on Form 20-F have been amended to refer to the Group's restated annual report for the year ended 31 December 2011 on Form 6-K filed with the SEC on 10 August 2012 (the "2011 Annual Report").
 
 
 
 

 
 
Contents

 
Page 
Forward-looking statements
3
Presentation of information
4
Condensed consolidated income statement
6
Highlights
7
Analysis of results
13
  Net interest income
13
  Non-interest income
14
  Operating expenses and insurance net claims
16
  Impairment losses
18
  Capital resources and ratios
20
  Balance sheet
21
Divisional performance
22
   
UK Retail
25
UK Corporate
29
Wealth
33
International Banking
36
Ulster Bank
40
US Retail & Commercial
43
Markets
49
Direct Line Group
53
Central items
59
Non-Core
61
Results
69
   
Condensed consolidated income statement
69
Condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income
70
Condensed consolidated balance sheet
71
Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet
72
Average balance sheet
74
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
77
Condensed consolidated cash flow statement
80
Notes
81
   
  1.   Basis of preparation
81
  2.   Accounting policies
82
  3.   Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses
83
  4.   Loan impairment provisions
85
  5.   Pensions
86
  6.   Tax
86
  7.   (Loss)/profit attributable to non-controlling interests
87
  8.   Dividends
88
  9.   Share consolidation
88
  10. Earnings per ordinary and B share
89
  11. Segmental analysis
90

 
 
1

 
 
Contents (continued)

Notes (continued)
Page
   
  12. Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups
97
  13. Financial instruments
99
  14. Available-for-sale reserve
112
  15. Contingent liabilities and commitments
112
  16. Litigation, investigations and reviews
113
  17. Other developments
126
  18. Related party transactions
129
  19. Post balance sheet events
130
  20. Consolidating financial information
130
Risk and balance sheet management
134
   
General overview
134
Balance sheet management
137
Capital
137
Regulatory capital developments
140
Liquidity and funding risk
142
  Funding sources
143
  Securitisations and asset transfers
147
  Conduits
150
  Liquidity portfolio
151
  Net stable funding ratio
152
Non-traded interest rate risk
153
Interest rate risk
154
Structural hedges
155
Structural foreign currency exposures
156
Risk management
157
Credit risk
157
  Financial assets
157
  Problem debt management
170
  Key credit portfolios
185
   - Commercial real estate
185
   - Residential mortgages
191
   - Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core)
195
Market risk
199
Country risk
206
   
Risk factors
242
Additional information
244
   
Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal
 
Appendix 2 Credit risk assets
 
 
 
2

 
 
Forward-looking statements

 
Certain sections in this document contain ‘forward-looking statements’ as that term is defined in the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, such as statements that include the words ‘expect’, ‘estimate’, ‘project’, ‘anticipate’, ‘believes’, ‘should’, ‘intend’, ‘plan’, ‘could’, ‘probability’, ‘risk’, ‘Value-at-Risk (VaR)’, ‘target’, ‘goal’, ‘objective’, ‘will’, ‘endeavour’, ‘outlook’, ‘optimistic’, ‘prospects’ and similar expressions or variations on such expressions.

In particular, this document includes forward-looking statements relating, but not limited to: the Group’s restructuring plans, divestments, capitalisation, portfolios, net interest margin, capital ratios, liquidity, risk weighted assets (RWAs), return on equity (ROE), profitability, cost:income ratios, leverage and loan:deposit ratios, funding and risk profile; discretionary coupon and dividend payments; certain ring-fencing proposals; sustainability targets; the Group’s future financial performance; the level and extent of future impairments and write-downs, including sovereign debt impairments; the protection provided by the Asset Protection Scheme (APS); and the Group’s potential exposures to various types of market risks, such as interest rate risk, foreign exchange rate risk and commodity and equity price risk. These statements are based on current plans, estimates and projections, and are subject to inherent risks, uncertainties and other factors which could cause actual results to differ materially from the future results expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. For example, certain market risk disclosures are dependent on choices about key model characteristics and assumptions and are subject to various limitations. By their nature, certain of the market risk disclosures are only estimates and, as a result, actual future gains and losses could differ materially from those that have been estimated.

Other factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those estimated by the forward-looking statements contained in this document include, but are not limited to: global economic and financial market conditions and other geopolitical risks, and their impact on the financial industry in general and on the Group in particular; the ability to implement strategic plans on a timely basis, or at all, including the disposal of certain Non-Core assets and of certain assets and businesses required as part of the State Aid restructuring plan; organisational restructuring, including any adverse consequences of a failure to transfer, or a further delay in transferring, certain business assets and liabilities from RBS N.V. to RBS; the ability to access sufficient sources of liquidity and funding when required; deteriorations in borrower and counterparty credit quality; litigation, government and regulatory investigations including investigations relating to the setting of LIBOR and other interest rates; costs or exposures borne by the Group arising out of the origination or sale of mortgages or mortgage-backed securities in the United States; the extent of future write-downs and impairment charges caused by depressed asset valuations; the value and effectiveness of any credit protection purchased by the Group; unanticipated turbulence in interest rates, yield curves, foreign currency exchange rates, credit spreads, bond prices, commodity prices, equity prices and basis, volatility and correlation risks; changes in the credit ratings of the Group; ineffective management of capital or changes to capital adequacy or liquidity requirements; changes to the valuation of financial instruments recorded at fair value; competition and consolidation in the banking sector; the ability of the Group to attract or retain senior management or other key employees; regulatory or legal changes (including those requiring any restructuring of the Group’s operations) in the United Kingdom, the United States and other countries in which the Group operates or a change in United Kingdom Government policy; changes to regulatory requirements relating to capital and liquidity; changes to the monetary and interest rate policies of central banks and other governmental and regulatory bodies; changes in UK and foreign laws, regulations, accounting standards and taxes, including changes in regulatory capital regulations and liquidity requirements; the implementation of recommendations made by the Independent Commission on Banking (ICB) and their potential implications; impairments of goodwill; pension fund shortfalls; general operational risks; HM Treasury exercising influence over the operations of the Group; insurance claims; reputational risk; the ability to access the contingent capital arrangements with HM Treasury; the participation of the Group in the APS and the effect of the APS on the Group’s financial and capital position; the conversion of the B Shares in accordance with their terms; limitations on, or additional requirements imposed on, the Group’s activities as a result of HM Treasury’s investment in the Group; and the success of the Group in managing the risks involved in the foregoing.

The forward-looking statements contained in this document speak only as of the date of this announcement, and the Group does not undertake to update any forward-looking statement to reflect events or circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

The information, statements and opinions contained in this document do not constitute a public offer under any applicable legislation or an offer to sell or solicitation of any offer to buy any securities or financial instruments or any advice or recommendation with respect to such securities or other financial instruments.
 
 
3

 
 
Presentation of information

 
Non-GAAP financial information

The directors manage the Group’s performance by class of business, before certain reconciling items, as is presented in the segmental analysis on pages 90 to 97 (the “managed basis”). Discussion of the Group’s performance focuses on the managed basis as the Group believes that such measures allow a more meaningful analysis of the Group’s financial condition and the results of its operations. These measures are non-GAAP financial measures. A body of generally accepted accounting principles such as IFRS is commonly referred to as ‘GAAP’. A non-GAAP financial measure is defined as one that measures historical or future financial performance, financial position or cash flows but which excludes or includes amounts that would not be so adjusted in the most comparable GAAP measure. Reconciliations of these non-GAAP measures are presented throughout this document or in the segmental analysis on pages 90 to 97. These non-GAAP financial measures are not a substitute for GAAP measures. Furthermore, RBS has divided its operations into “Core” and “Non- Core”. Certain measures disclosed in this document for Core operations and used by RBS management are non- GAAP financial measures as they represent a combination of all reportable segments with the exception of Non-Core. In addition, RBS has further divided parts of the Core business into “Retail & Commercial” consisting of the UK Retail, UK Corporate, Wealth, International Banking, Ulster Bank and US Retail & Commercial divisions. This is a non GAAP financial measure. Lastly, the Basel III net stable funding ratio (see page 152) represents a non-GAAP financial measure given it is a metric that is not yet required to be disclosed by a government, governmental authority or self-regulatory organisation.

Disposal groups
In accordance with IFRS 5 ‘Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations’, in Q4 2011 the Group transferred the assets and liabilities relating to the planned disposal of its RBS England and Wales, and NatWest Scotland branch-based businesses, along with certain SME and corporate activities across the UK (‘UK branch-based businesses’), to assets and liabilities of disposal groups.
 
 
4

 
 
Presentation of information (continued)

 
Restatements

Organisational change
In January 2012, the Group announced changes to its wholesale banking operations in light of a changed market and regulatory environment. The changes have seen the reorganisation of the Group’s wholesale businesses into ‘Markets’ and ‘International Banking’ and the proposed exit and/or downsizing of selected activities. The changes will ensure the wholesale businesses continue to deliver against the Group’s strategy.

The changes include an exit from cash equities, corporate broking, equity capital markets and mergers and acquisitions advisory businesses. Significant reductions in balance sheet, funding requirements and cost base in the remaining wholesale businesses will be implemented.

Revised allocation of Group Treasury costs
In the first quarter of 2012, the Group revised its allocation of funding and liquidity costs and capital for the new divisional structure as well as for a new methodology. The new methodology is designed to ensure that the allocated funding and liquidity costs more fully reflect each division’s funding requirement.

Revised divisional return on equity ratios
For the purposes of divisional return on equity ratios, notional equity has been calculated as a percentage of the monthly average of divisional risk-weighted assets (RWAs), adjusted for capital deductions. Historically, notional equity was allocated at 9% of RWAs for the Retail & Commercial divisions and 10% of RWAs for Global Banking & Markets. This was revised in Q1 2012 and 10% of RWAs is now applied to both the Retail & Commercial and Markets divisions.

Fair value of own debt and derivative liabilities
The Group had previously excluded changes in the fair value of own debt (FVOD) in presenting the underlying performance of the Group on a managed basis given it is a volatile non-cash item. To better align our managed view of performance, movements in the fair value of own derivative liabilities (FVDL), previously incorporated within Markets operating performance, are now combined with movements in FVOD in a single measure, ‘Own Credit Adjustments’ (OCA). This took effect in Q1 2012 and Group and Markets operating results have been adjusted to reflect this change which does not affect profit/(loss) before and after tax.

Comparatives for all of the items discussed above were restated in Q1 2012. For further information on the restatements refer to the announcement dated 1 May 2012, available on www.sec.gov.

Share consolidation
Following approval at the Group’s Annual General Meeting on 30 May 2012, the sub-division and consolidation of the Group’s ordinary shares on a one-for-ten basis took effect on 6 June 2012. Consequently, disclosures relating to or affected by numbers of ordinary shares or share price have been restated.
 
 
5

 
 
Condensed consolidated income statement
for the period ended 30 June 2012

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Interest receivable
9,791 
10,805 
 
4,774 
5,017 
5,404 
Interest payable
(3,821)
(4,277)
 
(1,803)
(2,018)
(2,177)
             
Net interest income
5,970 
6,528 
 
2,971 
2,999 
3,227 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
2,937 
3,342 
 
1,450 
1,487 
1,700 
Fees and commissions payable
(604)
(583)
 
(314)
(290)
(323)
Income from trading activities
869 
1,982 
 
657 
212 
1,147 
Gain on redemption of own debt
577 
255 
 
577 
255 
Other operating income (excluding insurance net
  premium income)
(353)
1,533 
 
394 
(747)
1,142 
Insurance net premium income
1,867 
2,239 
 
929 
938 
1,090 
             
Non-interest income
5,293 
8,768 
 
3,116 
2,177 
5,011 
             
Total income
11,263 
15,296 
 
6,087 
5,176 
8,238 
             
Staff costs
(4,713)
(4,609)
 
(2,143)
(2,570)
(2,210)
Premises and equipment
(1,107)
(1,173)
 
(544)
(563)
(602)
Other administrative expenses
(2,172)
(2,673)
 
(1,156)
(1,016)
(1,752)
Depreciation and amortisation
(902)
(877)
 
(434)
(468)
(453)
             
Operating expenses
(8,894)
(9,332)
 
(4,277)
(4,617)
(5,017)
             
Profit before insurance net claims and
  impairment losses
2,369 
5,964 
 
1,810 
559 
3,221 
Insurance net claims
(1,225)
(1,705)
 
(576)
(649)
(793)
Impairment losses
(2,649)
(5,053)
 
(1,335)
(1,314)
(3,106)
             
Operating loss before tax
(1,505)
(794)
 
(101)
(1,404)
(678)
Tax charge
(429)
(645)
 
(290)
(139)
(222)
             
Loss from continuing operations
(1,934)
(1,439)
 
(391)
(1,543)
(900)
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
31 
 
(4)
21 
             
Loss for the period
(1,933)
(1,408)
 
(395)
(1,538)
(879)
Non-controlling interests
19 
(17)
 
14 
(18)
Preference share and other dividends
(76)
 
(76)
             
Loss attributable to ordinary and B shareholders
(1,990)
(1,425)
 
(466)
(1,524)
(897)
             
Basic and diluted loss per ordinary and B share from
  continuing operations (1)
(18.2p)
(13.2p)
 
(4.2p)
(14.0p)
(8.3p)
             
Basic and diluted loss per ordinary and B share from
  discontinued operations (1)
 

Note:
(1)
Prior periods have been adjusted for the sub-division and one-for-ten ordinary share consolidation of ordinary shares.
 
 
6

 
 
Highlights


First half 2012 results summary
The Royal Bank of Scotland Group (RBS) reported a Group operating loss before tax of £1,505 million for the first half of 2012. Operating profit on a managed basis was £1,834 million. The results included a provision of £125 million for costs arising from the technology incident that affected the Group’s systems in June, principally to cover customer redress. In addition, we have reserved £50 million for redress of a particular category of complex interest rate swaps based on agreement reached with the FSA. Excluding these provisions, operating profit on a managed basis was stable compared with H1 2011.

Core operating profit totalled £3,185 million in H1, down 19%, while return on equity was 10.2%.
Retail & Commercial (R&C) faced headwinds with a weakening economy and continuing low interest rates, but held costs flat and there was a continued improvement in impairments. R&C H1 operating profit was £2,067 million, down 12%. Although Q2 net interest margin was broadly stable at 2.94% compared with Q1, net interest income has remained under pressure as a consequence of muted lending demand. R&C ROE in H1 was 9.8%.
Markets also faced a difficult environment, reinforcing management’s decision to restructure the business, as the increased liquidity and investor confidence that followed the European Central Bank’s Long Term Refinancing Operation in Q1 proved short-lived. H1 operating profit fell 21% to £1,075 million, with weakness in currencies, credit markets and investor products and equity derivatives, mitigated by higher rates revenues. ROE for Markets’ ongoing business was 14.0%.
Direct Line Group H1 operating profit of £219 million was 6% higher than in the prior year, with significantly improved claims ratios despite the impact of more severe weather this year.
Non-Core operating losses were 31% lower than H1 2011 at £1,351 million, with expenses down 20% and impairments down 56% from the prior year.

Q2 2012 Group operating loss before tax was £101 million. Operating profit on a managed basis totalled £650 million, down 22% from Q2 2011 but only 1% excluding the provisions totalling £175 million described earlier. Core operating profit for the quarter was £1,518 million, down 9% from Q1 2012 and down 11% versus Q2 2011 (down 1% year-on-year and up 2% quarter-on-quarter excluding the provision totalling £175 million).

One-off and other items
H1 integration and restructuring costs totalled £673 million, of which £213 million was recorded in the second quarter. This was largely offset by the gain of £577 million recorded in March following a restructuring of the Group’s Lower Tier 2 debt. A disposal gain of £197 million was recorded on the sale of RBS Aviation Capital, completed in June 2012.

A further provision of £135 million in Q2 (H1 2012 - £260 million) was recorded for Payment Protection Insurance claims, bringing the cumulative charge taken to £1.3 billion, of which £0.7 billion in redress had been paid by 30 June 2012.

The significant narrowing of RBS’s credit spreads in debt markets, reflecting strengthened investor perceptions, that occurred in the first quarter of 2012 continued in Q2, resulting in an own credit charge of £2,974 million in H1 2012, of which £518 million was booked in Q2 2012. H1 2012 operating loss before tax was £1,505 million and attributable loss was £1,990 million. Excluding own credit adjustments of £2,974 million, H1 pre-tax operating profit on a managed basis was £1,469 million and attributable profit £287 million*. Tangible net asset value per share rose to 489 pence.
 
*Attributable loss adjusted for post-tax effect of own credit adjustments.
 
 
7

 

Highlights (continued)

 
First half 2012 results summary (continued)

Efficiency
Core expenses in H1 2012 were flat, with benefits from the Group’s cost reduction programme and the restructuring of Markets and International Banking offsetting the £88 million litigation settlement booked by US R&C in Q1 and the £125 million provision for costs arising from the technology incident accrued in Group Centre in Q2.

Staff expenses were reduced by 4% from H1 2011, with employee numbers down by 5,700, principally in Markets and International Banking. The compensation:revenue ratio in Markets declined to 33%, compared with 35% in H1 2011.


Despite strong expense control the Group cost: income ratio, net of claims worsened to 66% compared with 61% in H1 2011. The Core cost:income ratio, net of claims, worsened to 61%, compared with 57% in H1 2011, reflecting the weaker income trends. R&C cost:income ratio was 59% in H1, improving slightly from 60% in Q1 to 57% in Q2.

Risk
Group impairment losses totalled £2,649 million in H1 2012, with Q2 2012 in line with Q1 2012 at £1,335 million. R&C impairments were £241 million lower than H1 2011, with improvements particularly in UK Retail and US R&C. Core Ulster Bank impairments were in line with H1 2011 at £717 million, with Q2 2012 down 18% on Q1 2012. Non-Core impairments were down £1,390 million in H1 2012 at £1,096 million, principally reflecting the substantial provisioning of development land values in the Ulster Bank portfolio during the first half of 2011. Non-Core’s Q2 2012 impairments were £118 million higher than Q1 2012, largely reflecting one significant provision within the project finance portfolio.

Core annualised impairments represented 0.7% of loans and advances to customers in Q2 2012 compared with 0.8% in Q1. Group risk elements in lending totalled £41.1 billion at 30 June 2012, down from £42.4 billion at 31 December 2011, with provision coverage increasing from 49% to 51%. Ulster Bank provision coverage was 53% in Core and 57% in Non-Core.

Balance sheet
RBS made strong progress on the task of strengthening and derisking its balance sheet during the first half. Non-Core third party assets, which had been reduced by £11 billion in Q1, fell by a further £11 billion in Q2 to £72 billion at 30 June 2012, principally driven by the disposal of RBS Aviation Capital and run-off. In light of this strong progress the Group has lowered its year-end target for Non-Core assets to £60-65 billion.

Markets funded assets have been reduced by £60 billion over the 12 months to 30 June 2012, with a further £18 billion reduction in International Banking assets.

From its highest reported point in 2008 the Group has reduced its funded assets £298 billion (24%).
 
 
8

 
 
Highlights (continued)

 
First half 2012 results summary (continued)

Liquidity and funding
The Group maintained its trajectory towards a more stable, deposit-led balance sheet with the Group loan:deposit ratio improving further to 104% at 30 June 2012, compared with 114% a year earlier. Customer deposits grew by £3 billion during Q2 2012 and at 30 June 2012 were up £7 billion from a year earlier. No material impact was experienced from the credit rating downgrade during Q2 2012, on either the Group’s credit spreads or its ability to attract customer deposits.

Reflecting the Group’s strategy of sharply reducing its dependence on short-term wholesale funding, this funding fell to £62 billion at 30 June 2012, down £40 billion since the end of 2011. Short-term wholesale funding was covered 2.5 times by the Group’s liquidity buffer, which was maintained at £156 billion.

Capital
The Group’s Core Tier 1 ratio remained strong at 11.1%, and the leverage ratio was 15.6x. Although regulatory changes continued to increase risk-weightings on a number of portfolios, the Group reduced risk-weighted assets in Markets and successfully restructured a large derivative position in Non-Core, resulting in a substantial decrease in exposure to a highly leveraged counterparty. The capital relief afforded by the Asset Protection Scheme fell from 85 basis points in Q1 2012 to 77 basis points in Q2 2012 and continues to diminish. It remains the Group’s intention to exit the Scheme in H2 2012, subject to the approval of the Financial Services Authority. The Group has already expensed £2.5 billion for the APS, which equals the minimum fee payable.


Disposals
Preparations for the planned IPO of Direct Line Group in the latter part of 2012 remain on track. The company is prepared for separation and, from 1 July, is operating on a substantially standalone basis with its own corporate functions and HR platform. Residual IT services will be provided by the Group under a Transitional Services Agreement. Direct Line Group returned £800 million to the Group during H1 2012 as part of optimising its capital structure.

We continue to work with Santander on the sale of the RBS England & Wales and NatWest Scotland branch-based businesses along with certain SME and corporate activities. The complexity of the transaction and the focus on causing minimum disruption to our customers is likely to lead to an extension of the process well into 2013.

The sale of RBS Aviation Capital to Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corporation, acting on behalf of a consortium comprising its parent, Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, and Sumitomo Corporation, was completed on 1 June 2012. The disposal realised a net gain of £197 million and removed £5 billion of funded assets from the Non-Core balance sheet.
 
 
9

 
 
Highlights (continued)

 
First half 2012 results summary (continued)

Technology issues
In late June, a number of our customers were impacted by a technology incident affecting our transaction batch processing.

The immediate software issue was promptly identified and rectified. Despite this, significant manual intervention in a highly automated and complex batch processing environment was required. This resulted in a significant backlog of daily data and information processing. The consequential technology problems and backlog took time to resolve. However, at no point was any customer data lost or destroyed. Regrettably, in Ulster Bank, our customers experienced extended problems with their accounts, which have now been largely rectified.

Throughout the incident, we took action to help customers experiencing difficulty. We opened our branches for longer, doubled the number of staff in our UK-based call centres and gave staff greater authority to provide on-the-spot help. Thereafter, we focused on honouring our commitment that we would put impacted Group and non-Group customers back to the position they would have been in had the incident not occurred.

A full and detailed investigation is under way into the causes of the problem, overseen by independent experts and reporting to the Group Board Risk Committee. It will consider both the Group’s own operations and the role of third parties in the context of the incident. It will establish a full account of what happened, an assessment of how the Group responded and a thorough review of the root cause.

A charge of £125 million has been accrued in Q2 2012 in relation to the costs of this incident, principally covering redress to the Group’s customers. Additional costs may arise once all redress and business disruption items are clear and a further update will be given in Q3.
 
 
10

 
 
Highlights (continued)

 
First half 2012 results summary (continued)

Core UK franchise
The health of RBS’s core UK retail and commercial banking franchises is directly dependent on the health and success of its customers. Over the first half of 2012 the Group has maintained its support for these customers, with UK Retail increasing net lending to homeowners by £2.0 billion, or 2%, while UK Corporate increased loans to the manufacturing industry by 4%.

Gross mortgage lending in H1 2012 totalled £7.7 billion, with net new lending of over £3 billion in the same period. Gross new lending to first time buyers was up 26% from H1 2011.

Gross new lending to UK non-financial businesses totalled £41.5 billion, of which £19.2 billion was to SME customers. This included £28.3 billion of new loans and facilities (of which £15.2 billion was to SMEs) as well as £13.2 billion of overdraft renewals (including £4.0 billion to SMEs). Customer confidence has weakened in the face of economic newsflow, with many companies scaling back their investment plans, given concerns about the prospects for demand, and this is reflected in weak SME application volumes, down 18% on H1 2011. As a result, Q2 gross lending volumes were lower, with some impact from the technology incident as relationship managers prioritised the provision of operational support for affected customers. Overall, utilisation of overdraft facilities remained below 50% as it has for over two years.

It is into this challenging environment that the Bank of England recently launched the new Funding for Lending Scheme (FLS), aimed at increasing lending to the real economy. The Group welcomes this new initiative and has taken immediate steps to ensure that the FLS delivers real benefits for customers. UK Retail has introduced a new set of mortgage rates and products, offering low fixed rates to first time buyers and buyers of newly built homes as well as a strong offering for buy-to-let purchasers. In UK Corporate, the scheme will be used to cut interest rates on £2.5 billion of SME loans by an average of 1 percentage point, with larger reductions for the smallest businesses. The division will also remove arrangement fees on £2.5 billion of new SME loans. For larger businesses, the FLS benefits will be targeted at specific client segments where there are good opportunities to increase support to customers.

The Group also played an active role in the UK Government’s National Loan Guarantee Scheme (NLGS), launched in March, and by 30 June had provided over 8,000 loans and asset finance facilities, totalling £470 million. RBS was the only bank to make NLGS loans available for the full range of loans down to as little as £1,000, and approximately two-thirds of the facilities provided have been for amounts under £25,000, demonstrating the Group’s commitment to supporting as wide a range of customers as possible.

 
11

 
 
Highlights (continued)

 
First half 2012 results summary (continued)

Core UK franchise (continued)
We continue to conduct extensive research with our customers to ensure that we are well equipped to meet their needs. Customers’ principal expectations are that we will make their banking straightforward and simple, enabling them to interact with us in a way and at a time that suits them. When their needs are more complex, our customers want fast access to business expertise. They want to be confident that the person they talk to understands their business well. Key initiatives to ensure that we can meet these expectations include:

The launch of Business Connect, an enhanced telephony service that now supports 210,000 customers, with 75% of customers very satisfied with the service received;
   
Continuing efforts to ensure our relationship managers are fully equipped to serve their customers, through an accreditation programme in partnership with the Chartered Banker Institute; and
   
The “Working with you” programme, in which managers, of all levels, including senior executives, spend at least two days a year working in customers’ businesses. This has proved popular both with our managers and with our customers, and has substantially improved our ability to understand customers’ needs.


Outlook
The economic and regulatory challenges we face are unlikely to abate over the remainder of the year. We will continue to focus on maintaining a strong balance sheet and capital position.

We expect our Retail and Commercial businesses to continue to perform satisfactorily albeit Ulster Bank impairments are expected to remain elevated. Net interest margin is expected to be slightly up compared with the first half of 2012.

Markets’ revenues remain sensitive to client activity levels and broader market volatility.

Non-Core continues to make good progress operating within our loss expectations, with third party assets projected to fall to between £60 billion and £65 billion by the year end.

We will make an announcement regarding exit from the Asset Protection Scheme once formal regulatory clearance has been secured.

The divestment of Direct Line Group is on track and, subject to market conditions, the IPO is planned for October 2012.

 
12

 

Analysis of results

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
Net interest income
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Net interest income
5,970 
6,528 
 
2,971 
2,999 
3,227 
             
Average interest-earning assets
626,395 
658,887 
 
612,132 
640,658 
660,548 
             
Net interest margin
           
  - Group
1.92% 
2.00% 
 
1.95% 
1.88% 
1.96% 
  - Retail & Commercial (1)
2.93% 
3.02% 
 
2.94% 
2.91% 
2.99% 
  - Non-Core
0.28% 
0.77% 
 
0.24% 
0.31% 
0.83% 

Note:
(1)
Retail & Commercial (R&C) comprises the UK Retail, UK Corporate, Wealth, International Banking, Ulster Bank and US Retail & Commercial divisions.

Key points

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Group net interest income decreased by £558 million, 9%, driven by a 5% fall in Retail & Commercial and a 73% fall in Non-Core.
   
·
Retail & Commercial net interest income fell £286 million, reflecting the impact of lower long-term interest rate hedges and the impact of a competitive savings market on UK Retail. International Banking net interest income was also lower, as loans and advances to customers reduced by £15 billion. The decrease in Non-Core reflects continued run-down.
   
·
Group net interest margin (NIM) declined by 8 basis points, largely reflecting the cost of precautionary liquidity and funding strategies adopted in the latter part of 2011.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Group NIM increased by 7 basis points, benefiting from lower liquidity and funding costs as average short-term wholesale funding fell and low-yielding portfolios were managed down across the Group.
   
·
Group net interest income fell by 1%, driven by a £24 million decrease in Retail & Commercial, largely reflecting the roll-off of low yielding portfolios in International Banking.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Group NIM fell 1 basis point, reflecting increased funding and liquidity costs and pressure on liability margins.
 
 
13

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
Non-interest income
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
2,937 
3,342 
 
1,450 
1,487 
1,700 
Fees and commissions payable
(604)
(583)
 
(314)
(290)
(323)
Net fees and commissions
2,333 
2,759 
 
1,136 
1,197 
1,377 
Income from trading activities
           
  - managed basis
2,195 
2,789 
 
931 
1,264 
1,219 
  - Asset protection scheme
(45)
(637)
 
(2)
(43)
(168)
  - own credit adjustments*
(1,280)
(170)
 
(271)
(1,009)
96 
  -  RFS Holdings minority interest
(1)
 
(1)
 
869 
1,982 
 
657 
212 
1,147 
Gain on redemption of own debt
577 
255 
 
577 
255 
Other operating (loss)/income (excluding
  insurance net premium income)
           
  - managed basis
1,194 
1,573 
 
469 
725 
863 
  - strategic disposals **
152 
27 
 
160 
(8)
50 
  - own credit adjustments*
(1,694)
(66)
 
(247)
(1,447)
228 
  - integration and restructuring costs
(3)
 
  - RFS Holdings minority interest
(5)
 
12 
(17)
 
(353)
1,533 
 
394 
(747)
1,142 
             
Insurance net premium income
1,867 
2,239 
 
929 
938 
1,090 
             
Total non-interest income
5,293 
8,768 
 
3,116 
2,177 
5,011 
 
             
* Own credit adjustments impact:
           
Income from trading activities
(1,280)
(170)
 
(271)
(1,009)
96 
Other operating income
(1,694)
(66)
 
(247)
(1,447)
228 
             
Own credit adjustments
(2,974)
(236)
 
(518)
(2,456)
324 
             
**Strategic disposals
           
Gain/(loss) on sale and provision for loss on disposal of investments in:
           
  - RBS Aviation Capital
197 
 
197 
  - Global Merchant Services
47 
 
  - Other
(45)
(20)
 
(37)
(8)
50 
             
 
152 
27 
 
160 
(8)
50 

 
14

 

Analysis of results (continued)

 
Key points

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Non-interest income fell by £3,475 million, or 40%, driven by a  £2,974 million charge in relation to own credit adjustments, given the significant tightening in the Group’s credit spreads. This compares with a smaller charge of £236 million in H1 2011. H1 2012 also included a decrease of £807 million in Non-Core, which reflects significant gains recorded in H1 2011, and lower Markets non-interest income, down £470 million (15%). The Markets’ fall reflects sluggish market conditions relative to a year ago, as investor confidence has waned.
   
·
Retail & Commercial non-interest income of £2,924 million compares with £3,150 million in H1 2011. In UK Retail, lower card transaction volumes and changing customer behaviours drove a 20% decline. International Banking non-interest income fell as a result of lower revenue share from Markets as client activity levels were down.
   
·
H1 2012 includes £577 million gain on the redemption of own debt completed during the first quarter.
   
·
A net gain on strategic disposals of £152 million in H1 2012 largely reflects the sale of RBS Aviation Capital in June 2012.
 
·
Insurance net premium income decreased by 17% to £1,867 million driven by a decrease in volumes written by Direct Line Group during 2011, reflecting a planned decrease in the Motor book, the exit of certain business lines and the run-off of legacy policies.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Group non-interest income increased by 43%, primarily reflecting an own credit adjustment charge of £518 million compared with a charge of £2,456 million in Q1 2012 partially offset by lower Markets revenues following a seasonal uplift in the first quarter.
   
·
Non-Core recorded a £39 million loss on disposals in Q2 2012, compared with gains of £182 million in Q1 2012.
   
·
Retail & Commercial non-interest income increased by £80 million, or 6%, largely driven by a gain of £47 million on the sale of Visa B shares in US Retail & Commercial.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Non-interest income decreased by £1,895 million, or 38%, principally driven by Non-Core as significant gains on restructured assets in Q2 2011 were not repeated and reflecting an own credit adjustment charge of £518 million compared to a gain of £324 million in Q2 2011.
 
 
15

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
Operating expenses and net insurance claims
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Staff costs
4,713 
4,609 
 
2,143 
2,570 
2,210 
Premises and equipment
1,107 
1,173 
 
544 
563 
602 
Other administrative expenses
           
  - managed basis
1,755 
1,699 
 
936 
819 
834 
  - Payment Protection Insurance costs
260 
850 
 
135 
125 
850 
  - other
157 
124 
 
85 
72 
68 
 
2,172 
2,673 
 
1,156 
1,016 
1,752 
             
Depreciation and amortisation
902 
877 
 
434 
468 
453 
             
Operating expenses
8,894 
9,332 
 
4,277 
4,617 
5,017 
             
Insurance net claims
1,225 
1,705 
 
576 
649 
793 
             
Staff costs as a % of total income
42% 
30% 
 
35% 
50% 
27% 

Key points

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Group operating expenses decreased by 5%, largely driven by the on-going run-down of the Non-Core division and lower revenue-linked staff expenses in Markets and Payment Protection Insurance costs of £260 million compared to £850 million in H1 2011, bringing the cumulative charge to £1.3billion
   
·
Retail & Commercial expenses were broadly flat as benefits from the Group cost reduction programme were largely offset by a litigation settlement of £88 million ($138 million) in US Retail & Commercial in Q1.
   
·
Insurance net claims of £1,225 million were £480 million lower than H1 2011 as Direct Line Group loss ratios improved, reflecting reduced exposure, tight underwriting discipline and reserve releases from prior years. Legacy business run-off also contributed to the reduction.
 
·
Integration and restructuring costs totalled £673 million, driven by the restructure of Markets and International Banking, Group property exits and expenditure incurred in preparation for the divestment of Direct Line Group and the sale of branches to Santander.
 
Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Group operating expenses fell by 7%, with staff expenses down £427 million, largely driven by a seasonal fall in Markets revenues. This was partially offset by a 14% increase in other expenses, which includes a £125 million provision for customer redress relating to the technology incident in June 2012.
   
·
Retail & Commercial expenses declined 5%, principally reflecting the litigation settlement of £88 million ($138 million) in Q1 in US Retail & Commercial, and reductions in International Banking as a result of a planned reduction in headcount following the Q1 2012 restructuring.
   
·
Insurance net claims decreased by £73 million largely reflecting prior year reserve releases.

 
16

 

Analysis of results (continued)

 
Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Group operating expenses were down 15% compared with Q2 2011, as Non-Core run-down and lower expenses in Markets, largely driven by headcount reductions, and a provision of £135 million in respect of Payment Protection Insurance costs compared with £850 million in Q2 2011, were offset by the £125 million provision relating to the Q2 2012 technology incident.
   
·
Retail & Commercial expenses decreased by 3% as a result of savings achieved as part of the Group cost reduction programme.
   
·
Insurance net claims fell by 27% reflecting legacy business run-off and reduced exposures, particularly in Motor. Tightened claims management also supported prior year reserve releases.
 
 
17

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
Impairment losses
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Loan impairment losses
2,730 
4,135 
 
1,435 
1,295 
2,237 
Securities
           
  - managed basis
(81)
76 
 
(100)
19 
27 
  - Sovereign debt impairment (1)
733 
 
733 
  - interest rate hedge on impaired available-for-sale
    sovereign debt
109 
 
 - 
109 
 
(81)
918 
 
(100)
19 
869 
             
Group impairment losses
2,649 
5,053 
 
1,335 
1,314 
3,106 
             
Loan impairment losses
           
  - individually assessed
1,690 
3,119 
 
945 
745 
1,834 
  - collectively assessed
1,129 
1,311 
 
534 
595 
591 
  - latent
(113)
(295)
 
(56)
(57)
(188)
             
Customer loans
2,706 
4,135 
 
1,423 
1,283 
2,237 
Bank loans
24 
 
12 
12 
             
Loan impairment losses
2,730 
4,135 
 
1,435 
1,295 
2,237 
             
Core
1,515 
1,662 
 
719 
796 
810 
Non-Core
1,215 
2,473 
 
716 
499 
1,427 
             
Group
2,730 
4,135 
 
1,435 
1,295 
2,237 
             
Customer loan impairment charge as a % of
  gross loans and advances (2)
           
Group
1.1% 
1.6% 
 
1.2% 
1.1% 
1.8% 
Core
0.7% 
0.8% 
 
0.7% 
0.8% 
0.8% 
Non-Core
3.6% 
5.2% 
 
4.2% 
2.7% 
6.0% 

 
Notes:
(1)
In the second quarter of 2011, the Group recorded an impairment loss of £733 million in respect of its AFS portfolio of Greek government debt as a result of Greece’s continuing fiscal difficulties. In Q1 2012, as part of Private Sector Involvement in the Greek government bail-out, the vast majority of this portfolio was exchanged for Greek sovereign debt and European Financial Stability Facility notes; the Greek sovereign debt received in the exchange was sold.
(2)
Customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of gross customer loans and advances excluding reverse repurchase agreements and including disposal groups.

 
18

 

Analysis of results (continued)

 
Key points

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Group loan impairment losses fell 34% to £2,730 million, compared with £4,135 million in H1 2011, driven by a significant reduction in Non-Core and improvements in Retail & Commercial.
   
·
Non-Core loan impairment losses were 51% lower, reflecting the substantial provisioning of development land values in the Ulster Bank portfolio during H1 2011.
   
·
Retail & Commercial loan impairment losses decreased by £206 million, 12%, driven by an overall improvement in asset quality reflecting risk appetite tightening in UK Retail and an improved credit environment for US Retail & Commercial.
   
·
Total Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) loan impairments were £1,166 million, compared with £2,540 million in H1 2011, driven by the fall in Non-Core. Core Ulster Bank impairments decreased by 2%.
   
·
The Group customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of loans and advances fell to 1.1% compared with 1.6% for H1 2011. For Core, the comparable percentages were 0.7% and 0.8%.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Group loan impairment losses increased 11%, driven by Non-Core, where loan impairments rose by £217 million, largely reflecting one large provision in the Project Finance portfolio.
   
·
Retail & Commercial showed continuing improvement in credit trends, with loan impairment losses down 10%. This largely reflected a decrease in Ulster Bank, where significant provisions were recorded in Q1 2012 in respect of retail mortgages. UK Retail impairments also declined, with lower default volumes in both mortgages and unsecured lending reflecting risk appetite tightening.
   
·
Core and Non-Core Ulster Bank loan impairments totalled £512 million, a decrease of £142 million. Credit conditions remained difficult leading to a deterioration in asset quality. However, the level of deterioration of mortgages in default and the rate of decline in house prices slowed during the quarter.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Group loan impairment losses decreased by 36%, driven by a decline in Non-Core impairments, due to the non repeat of the Q2 2011 development land provisions in Ulster Bank.
   
·
Retail & Commercial loan impairment losses were down £147 million, or 17%. Excluding Ulster Bank, R&C loan impairment losses declined by £201 million reflecting broad strengthening in credit metrics.

 
19

 

Analysis of results (continued)

 
Capital resources and ratios
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
       
Core Tier 1 capital
£48bn 
£47bn 
£46bn 
Tier 1 capital
£58bn 
£57bn 
£57bn 
Total capital
£63bn 
£61bn 
£61bn 
Risk-weighted assets
     
  - gross
£488bn 
£496bn 
£508bn 
  - benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
(£53bn)
(£62bn)
(£69bn)
Risk-weighted assets
£435bn 
£434bn 
£439bn 
Core Tier 1 ratio (1)
11.1% 
10.8% 
10.6% 
Tier 1 ratio
13.4% 
13.2% 
13.0% 
Total capital ratio
14.6% 
14.0% 
13.8% 

Note:
(1)
The benefit of APS in the Core Tier 1 ratio was 77 basis points at 30 June 2012 (31 March 2012 - 85 basis points; 31 December 2011 - 90 basis points).

30 June 2012 compared with 31 March 2012
·
The Group’s Core Tier 1 ratio improved to 11.1%. Core Tier 1 capital increased by £1.4 billion. This reflected the issue of new shares and the sale of surplus shares held by the Group’s Employee Benefit Trust to fund deferred employee incentive awards, £0.5 billion, together with lower regulatory deductions, including APS, of £0.9 billion.
   
·
The impact of the Asset Protection Scheme (APS) on the Core Tier 1 ratio continued to decline, from 85 basis points at 31 March 2012 to 77 basis points at 30 June 2012.
   
·
Gross risk-weighted assets (RWAs) fell by £8 billion, reflecting a significant reduction in market risk coupled with Non-Core run-off and disposals.

30 June 2012 compared with 31 December 2011
·
The Core Tier 1 ratio increased by 50 basis points compared with 31 December 2011, driven by attributable profits (net of movements in fair value of own debt), issuance of new shares, lower regulatory capital deductions, and a 4% reduction in gross risk-weighted assets.
   
·
Gross risk-weighted assets fell by £20 billion, excluding the effect of the APS. Post APS, RWAs decreased by £4 billion.
 
 
20

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)


Balance sheet
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
       
Funded balance sheet (1)
£929bn 
£950bn 
£977bn 
Total assets
£1,415bn 
£1,403bn 
£1,507bn 
Loans and advances to customers (2)
£455bn 
£460bn 
£474bn 
Customer deposits (3)
£435bn 
£432bn 
£437bn 
Loan:deposit ratio - Core (4)
92% 
93% 
94% 
Loan:deposit ratio - Group (4)
104% 
106% 
108% 
Short-term wholesale funding
£62bn 
£80bn 
£102bn 
Wholesale funding
£213bn 
£234bn 
£258bn 
Liquidity portfolio
£156bn 
£153bn 
£155bn 

Notes:
(1)
Funded balance sheet represents total assets less derivatives.
(2)
Excluding reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing, and including disposal groups.
(3)
Excluding repurchase agreements and stock lending, and including disposal groups.
(4)
Net of provisions, including disposal groups and excluding repurchase agreements. Excluding disposal groups, the loan:deposit ratios of Core and Group at 30 June 2012 were 92% and 105% respectively (31 March 2012 - 93% and 107% respectively; 31 December 2011 - 94% and 110% respectively).

30 June 2012 compared with 31 March 2012
·
Group funded assets fell by £21 billion during Q2 2012 to £929 billion. Non-Core further reduced third party assets by £11 billion, including the disposal of RBS Aviation Capital.
   
·
The Group loan:deposit ratio improved to 104% compared with 106% at 31 March 2012, as customer deposits increased by £3 billion through successful deposit-gathering initiatives. A credit rating downgrade during Q2 2012 had negligible impact.
   
·
Short-term wholesale funding decreased by £18 billion in Q2 2012 to £62 billion, while a significant liquidity portfolio of £156 billion was maintained, a coverage ratio of 2.5 times.

30 June 2012 compared with 31 December 2011
·
Funded assets decreased by £48 billion to £929 billion, reflecting the Group’s programme of deleveraging and reducing capital intensive assets. Non-Core funded assets fell by £22 billion primarily reflecting disposals and run-off, and Markets reduced its assets by £11 billion.
   
·
Loans and advances to customers were £19 billion lower, reflecting net customer repayments in International Banking, weak customer credit demand and Non-Core run-down and disposals.
   
·
The Group loan:deposit ratio improved to 104% compared with 108% at 31 December 2011. The Core loan:deposit ratio improved to 92%.


Further analysis of the Group’s liquidity and funding position is included on pages 142 to 153.
 
 
21

 
 

Divisional performance

The operating profit/(loss) of each division is shown below.

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Operating profit/(loss) by division
           
UK Retail
914 
1,053 
 
437 
477 
535 
UK Corporate
1,004 
1,089 
 
512 
492 
472 
Wealth
109 
130 
 
64 
45 
60 
International Banking
264 
375 
 
167 
97 
149 
Ulster Bank
(555)
(543)
 
(245)
(310)
(178)
US Retail & Commercial
331 
237 
 
229 
102 
143 
             
Retail & Commercial
2,067 
2,341 
 
1,164 
903 
1,181 
Markets
1,075 
1,356 
 
251 
824 
327 
Direct Line Group
219 
206 
 
135 
84 
139 
Central items
(176)
24 
 
(32)
(144)
56 
             
Core
3,185 
3,927 
 
1,518 
1,667 
1,703 
Non-Core
(1,351)
(1,961)
 
(868)
(483)
(870)
             
Managed basis
1,834 
1,966 
 
650 
1,184 
833 
             
Reconciling items:
           
Own credit adjustments
(2,974)
(236)
 
(518)
(2,456)
324 
Asset Protection Scheme
(45)
(637)
 
(2)
(43)
(168)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(260)
(850)
 
(135)
(125)
(850)
Sovereign debt impairment
(733)
 
(733)
Interest rate hedge adjustments on impaired available-for-sale sovereign debt
(109)
 
(109)
Amortisation of purchased intangible assets
(99)
(100)
 
(51)
(48)
(56)
Integration and restructuring costs
(673)
(353)
 
(213)
(460)
(208)
Gain on redemption of debt
577 
255 
 
577 
255 
Strategic disposals
152 
27 
 
160 
(8)
50 
Bonus tax
(22)
 
(11)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(17)
(2)
 
(25)
(5)
             
Statutory basis
(1,505)
(794)
 
(101)
(1,404)
(1,326)
             
Impairment losses/(recoveries) by division
           
UK Retail
295 
402 
 
140 
155 
208 
UK Corporate
357 
327 
 
181 
176 
220 
Wealth
22 
 
12 
10 
International Banking
62 
98 
 
27 
35 
104 
Ulster Bank
717 
730 
 
323 
394 
269 
US Retail & Commercial
47 
176 
 
28 
19 
65 
             
Retail & Commercial
1,500 
1,741 
 
711 
789 
869 
Markets
21 
(14)
 
19 
(14)
Central items
32 
(2)
 
(2)
34 
(2)
             
Core
1,553 
1,725 
 
728 
825 
853 
Non-Core
1,096 
2,486 
 
607 
489 
1,411 
             
Managed basis
2,649 
4,211 
 
1,335 
1,314 
2,264 
             
Reconciling items:
           
Sovereign debt impairment
733 
 
733 
Interest rate hedge adjustments on impaired available-for-sale sovereign debt
109 
 
109 
             
Statutory basis
2,649 
5,053 
 
1,335 
1,314 
3,106 
 
 
 
RBS Group – 2012 Interim Results
 
22

 

 
Divisional performance (continued)

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
 
             
Net interest margin by division
           
UK Retail
3.59 
4.06 
 
3.57 
3.61 
4.04 
UK Corporate
3.13 
3.11 
 
3.17 
3.09 
3.03 
Wealth
3.68 
3.29 
 
3.69 
3.67 
3.33 
International Banking
1.62 
1.78 
 
1.65 
1.60 
1.73 
Ulster Bank
1.85 
1.82 
 
1.82 
1.87 
1.80 
US Retail & Commercial
3.04 
3.06 
 
3.02 
3.06 
3.12 
             
Retail & Commercial
2.93 
3.02 
 
2.94 
2.91 
2.99 
Non-Core
0.28 
0.77 
 
0.24 
0.31 
0.83 
             
Group net interest margin
1.92 
2.00 
 
1.95 
1.88 
1.96 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Total funded assets by division
     
UK Retail
116.9 
116.3 
114.5 
UK Corporate
113.7 
113.1 
114.1 
Wealth
21.2 
21.3 
21.6 
International Banking
61.4 
63.7 
69.9 
Ulster Bank
33.1 
33.4 
34.6 
US Retail & Commercial
74.3 
72.9 
74.9 
Markets
302.4 
300.6 
313.9 
Other
132.9 
144.2 
139.2 
       
Core
855.9 
865.5 
882.7 
Non-Core
72.1 
83.3 
93.7 
       
 
928.0 
948.8 
976.4 
RFS Holdings minority interest
0.8 
0.9 
0.8 
       
Total
928.8 
949.7 
977.2 
 
 
 
23

 

 
Divisional performance (continued)


 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Risk-weighted assets by division
           
UK Retail
47.4 
48.2 
(2%)
 
48.4 
(2%)
UK Corporate
79.4 
76.9 
3% 
 
79.3 
Wealth
12.3 
12.9 
(5%)
 
12.9 
(5%)
International Banking
46.0 
41.8 
10% 
 
43.2 
6% 
Ulster Bank
37.4 
38.4 
(3%)
 
36.3 
3% 
US Retail & Commercial
58.5 
58.6 
 
59.3 
(1%)
             
Retail & Commercial
281.0 
276.8 
2% 
 
279.4 
1% 
Markets
107.9 
115.6 
(7%)
 
120.3 
(10%)
Other
12.7 
11.0 
15% 
 
12.0 
6% 
             
Core
401.6 
403.4 
 
411.7 
(2%)
Non-Core
82.7 
89.9 
(8%)
 
93.3 
(11%)
             
Group before benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
484.3 
493.3 
(2%)
 
505.0 
(4%)
Benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
(52.9)
(62.2)
(15%)
 
(69.1)
(23%)
             
Group before RFS Holdings minority interest
431.4 
431.1 
 
435.9 
(1%)
RFS Holdings minority interest
3.3 
3.2 
3% 
 
3.1 
6% 
             
Group
434.7 
434.3 
 
439.0 
(1%)


Employee numbers by division (full time equivalents in continuing operations rounded to the nearest hundred)
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
       
UK Retail
27,500 
27,600 
27,700 
UK Corporate
13,100 
13,400 
13,600 
Wealth
5,600 
5,700 
5,700 
International Banking
4,800 
5,400 
5,400 
Ulster Bank
4,500 
4,500 
4,200 
US Retail & Commercial
14,500 
14,700 
15,400 
       
Retail & Commercial
70,000 
71,300 
72,000 
Markets
12,500 
13,200 
13,900 
Direct Line Group
15,100 
15,100 
14,900 
Group Centre
6,900 
6,600 
6,200 
       
Core
104,500 
106,200 
107,000 
Non-Core
3,800 
4,300 
4,700 
       
 
108,300 
110,500 
111,700 
Business Services
33,500 
33,600 
34,000 
Integration and restructuring
1,000 
1,000 
1,100 
       
Group
142,800 
145,100 
146,800 
 
 
 
 
24

 

 
UK Retail


 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
1,989 
2,184 
 
988 
1,001 
1,098 
             
Net fees and commissions
451 
565 
 
214 
237 
295 
Other non-interest income
57 
72 
 
28 
29 
38 
             
Non-interest income
508 
637 
 
242 
266 
333 
             
Total income
2,497 
2,821 
 
1,230 
1,267 
1,431 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(417)
(433)
 
(210)
(207)
(218)
  - other
(189)
(219)
 
(110)
(79)
(106)
Indirect expenses
(682)
(714)
 
(333)
(349)
(364)
             
 
(1,288)
(1,366)
 
(653)
(635)
(688)
             
Profit before impairment losses
1,209 
1,455 
 
577 
632 
743 
Impairment losses
(295)
(402)
 
(140)
(155)
(208)
             
Operating profit
914 
1,053 
 
437 
477 
535 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Personal advances
458 
553 
 
222 
236 
278 
Personal deposits
353 
511 
 
168 
185 
257 
Mortgages
1,159 
1,124 
 
596 
563 
581 
Cards
431 
481 
 
212 
219 
243 
Other
96 
152 
 
32 
64 
72 
             
Total income
2,497 
2,821 
 
1,230 
1,267 
1,431 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Mortgages
58 
116 
 
24 
34 
55 
Personal
166 
201 
 
84 
82 
106 
Cards
71 
85 
 
32 
39 
47 
             
Total impairment losses
295 
402 
 
140 
155 
208 
             
             
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer loans and advances (excluding reverse repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Mortgages
0.1% 
0.2% 
 
0.1% 
0.1% 
0.2% 
Personal
3.6% 
3.7% 
 
3.7% 
3.5% 
3.9% 
Cards
2.5% 
3.0% 
 
2.3% 
2.8% 
3.4% 
Total
0.5% 
0.7% 
 
0.5% 
0.6% 
0.8% 
 
 
 
 
25

 
 
UK Retail (continued)


Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
23.3% 
25.1% 
 
22.5% 
24.0% 
25.8% 
Net interest margin
3.59% 
4.06% 
 
3.57% 
3.61% 
4.04% 
Cost:income ratio
52% 
48% 
 
53% 
50% 
48% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross) (2)
           
  - mortgages
98.1 
97.5 
1% 
 
95.0 
3% 
  - personal
9.2 
9.4 
(2%)
 
10.1 
(9%)
  - cards
5.7 
5.6 
2% 
 
5.7 
             
 
113.0 
112.5 
 
110.8 
2% 
Customer deposits (2)
106.5 
104.2 
2% 
 
101.9 
5% 
Assets under management (excluding deposits)
5.8 
5.8 
 
5.5 
5% 
Risk elements in lending (2)
4.6 
4.6 
 
4.6 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
104% 
105% 
(100bp)
 
106% 
(200bp)
Risk-weighted assets
47.4 
48.2 
(2%)
 
48.4 
(2%)

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
(2)
Includes disposal groups: loans and advances to customers £7.5 billion (31 March 2012 and 31 December 2011 - £7.3 billion), risk elements in lending £0.5 billion (31 March 2012 and 31 December 2011 - £0.5 billion) and customer deposits £8.6 billion (31 March 2012 - £8.7 billion; 31 December 2011 - £8.8 billion).

Key points
UK Retail had a subdued H1 2012, with operating profit falling 13%, although the division continued to lend more despite the tough economic conditions reducing demand for unsecured lending. The division had a successful ISA season and has achieved balance growth well in excess of the market, although deposit margins remained under pressure.

UK Retail’s aspiration to become the UK’s most helpful bank suffered a setback in June, following the technology problems that affected a number of the Group’s payment systems. The division’s priority has been to take all steps possible to help customers experiencing difficulty by opening branches for longer, doubling staff numbers in UK-based call centres and giving greater authority to local staff to provide on-the-spot help.

In early July, the Bank of England announced the Funding for Lending Scheme (FLS) designed to boost lending to the real economy. UK Retail will use this scheme to cut costs for first time buyers, introducing a new set of mortgages with lower rates.
 
 
 
 
26

 

UK Retail (continued)

Key points (continued)

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Net interest income was 9% lower with net interest margin falling 47 basis points to 3.59%. This was driven by the decline in liability margins due to the continued impact of low rates on long term interest rate hedges and the competitive savings market.
   
·
Total customer lending grew by £3 billion, or 2%, with mortgage balances increasing 4% while unsecured balances fell 9%. Deposit balances grew 11%, with both savings and current account deposits up 11%.
   
·
Costs decreased by 6% from H1 2011 with the majority of savings coming from direct cost initiatives.
   
·
Impairment losses fell 27% in H1 2012, as overall asset quality improved reflecting risk appetite tightening and lower unsecured balances.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Operating profit decreased by 8%, with increased costs and falling income, partially offset by a 10% reduction in impairments.
   
·
The division further reduced the loan to deposit ratio to 104%.
 
Customer deposits grew 2%, driven by increases of 2% in both savings and current account balances following successful savings campaigns in the quarter.
 
Mortgage balances increased by 1% in the quarter. Unsecured lending continued to be managed carefully, contracting by 1% as a result of the strategic decision to improve the Group’s risk profile combined with customer deleveraging.
   
·
Income growth has been challenging in the current economic environment, as total income fell by 3%.
 
Net interest margin declined 4 basis points largely due to the impact of lower rates on long term interest rate hedges. In addition, competition in the deposit market continued to drive down overall liability margins.
 
Changes in consumer behaviour has reduced fee income and driven down unsecured interest-bearing balances, putting pressure on net interest income.
   
·
Costs increased, primarily due to the timing of regulatory expenses.
   
·
Impairment losses decreased 10%, reflecting the continued impact of tightening risk appetite. Impairments are expected to remain broadly stable subject to normal seasonal fluctuations and the economic environment.
 
Mortgage impairment losses decreased in the quarter due to further improvement in default volumes and a stable collection outlook.
 
The unsecured portfolio charge fell 4%, with slightly lower default volumes and continued good collections performance. Industry benchmarks for cards arrears remain stable, with RBS continuing to perform better than the market.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets decreased 2%, with volume growth in lower risk secured mortgages offset by a decrease in the unsecured portfolio, and a small improvement in credit quality across both the secured and unsecured portfolios.
 
 
 
 
27

 

 
UK Retail (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Operating profit fell by £98 million with income down 14%, costs down 5% and impairments down 33%.
   
·
Net interest income was £110 million lower than Q2 2011, with the unsecured book being managed down and continued pressure on liability margins, partly offset by strong mortgage growth.
   
·
Costs were 5% lower than in Q2 2011 due to continued implementation of process efficiencies and headcount reductions.
   
·
The continued effect of risk appetite tightening and muted demand for unsecured lending contributed to lower default volumes, with impairment losses decreasing by 33%.
 
 
 
 
28

 

 
UK Corporate

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
1,528 
1,581 
 
772 
756 
770 
             
Net fees and commissions
682 
681 
 
346 
336 
336 
Other non-interest income
202 
218 
 
93 
109 
112 
             
Non-interest income
884 
899 
 
439 
445 
448 
             
Total income
2,412 
2,480 
 
1,211 
1,201 
1,218 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(477)
(470)
 
(232)
(245)
(235)
  - other
(174)
(189)
 
(89)
(85)
(85)
Indirect expenses
(400)
(405)
 
(197)
(203)
(206)
             
 
(1,051)
(1,064)
 
(518)
(533)
(526)
             
Profit before impairment losses
1,361 
1,416 
 
693 
668 
692 
Impairment losses
(357)
(327)
 
(181)
(176)
(220)
             
Operating profit
1,004 
1,089 
 
512 
492 
472 
             
             
Analysis of income by business
           
Corporate and commercial lending
1,351 
1,379 
 
664 
687 
657 
Asset and invoice finance
333 
315 
 
171 
162 
164 
Corporate deposits
340 
348 
 
174 
166 
174 
Other
388 
438 
 
202 
186 
223 
             
Total income
2,412 
2,480 
 
1,211 
1,201 
1,218 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Financial institutions
16 
 
13 
Hotels and restaurants
23 
21 
 
15 
13 
Housebuilding and construction
104 
47 
 
79 
25 
15 
Manufacturing
19 
12 
 
19 
Other
31 
94 
 
(9)
40 
91 
Private sector education, health, social work, recreational and community services
43 
12 
 
21 
22 
Property
64 
69 
 
34 
30 
51 
Wholesale and retail trade, repairs
49 
32 
 
16 
33 
16 
Asset and invoice finance
20 
24 
 
11 
14 
             
Total impairment losses
357 
327 
 
181 
176 
220 
 
 
 
29

 

 
UK Corporate (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer loans and advances (excluding reverse repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Financial institutions
0.1% 
0.5% 
 
0.1% 
0.1% 
0.9% 
Hotels and restaurants
0.8% 
0.6% 
 
0.5% 
1.0% 
0.8% 
Housebuilding and construction
5.9% 
2.2% 
 
9.0% 
2.7% 
1.4% 
Manufacturing
0.8% 
0.5% 
 
1.6% 
0.5% 
Other
0.2% 
0.6% 
 
(0.1%)
0.5% 
1.1% 
Private sector education, health, social work,
  recreational and community services
1.0% 
0.3% 
 
0.9% 
1.0% 
Property
0.5% 
0.5% 
 
0.5% 
0.4% 
0.7% 
Wholesale and retail trade, repairs
1.1% 
0.7% 
 
0.7% 
1.5% 
0.7% 
Asset and invoice finance
0.4% 
0.5% 
 
0.4% 
0.3% 
0.6% 
             
Total
0.6% 
0.6% 
 
0.7% 
0.6% 
0.8% 

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
16.5% 
16.9% 
 
16.8% 
16.2% 
14.6% 
Net interest margin
3.13% 
3.11% 
 
3.17% 
3.09% 
3.03% 
Cost:income ratio
44% 
43% 
 
43% 
44% 
43% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
113.7 
113.2 
 
114.2 
Loans and advances to customers (gross) (2)
           
  - financial institutions
6.1 
6.2 
(2%)
 
5.8 
5% 
  - hotels and restaurants
6.1 
6.0 
2% 
 
6.1 
  - housebuilding and construction
3.5 
3.7 
(5%)
 
3.9 
(10%)
  - manufacturing
4.9 
4.7 
4% 
 
4.7 
4% 
  - other
34.1 
34.4 
(1%)
 
34.2 
  - private sector education, health, social
    work, recreational and community services
8.9 
8.6 
3% 
 
8.7 
2% 
  - property
26.9 
26.7 
1% 
 
28.2 
(5%)
  - wholesale and retail trade, repairs
8.9 
9.1 
(2%)
 
8.7 
2% 
  - asset and invoice finance
10.7 
10.3 
4% 
 
10.4 
3% 
             
 
110.1 
109.7 
 
110.7 
(1%)
             
Customer deposits (2)
127.5 
124.3 
3% 
 
126.3 
1% 
Risk elements in lending (2)
4.9 
4.9 
 
5.0 
(2%)
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
85% 
87% 
(200bp)
 
86% 
(100bp)
Risk-weighted assets
79.4 
76.9 
3% 
 
79.3 

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax, divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
(2)
Includes disposal groups: loans and advances to customers £11.9 billion (31 March 2012 - £12.0 billion; 31 December 2011 - £12.2 billion), risk elements in lending £0.9 billion (31 March 2012 and 31 December 2011 - £1.0 billion) and customer deposits £13.1 billion (31 March 2012 - £12.7 billion; 31 December 2011- £13.0 billion).
 
 
 
30

 
 
UK Corporate (continued)

Key points
In a challenging environment, UK Corporate delivered a resilient performance in the first half, with a stronger operating profit in Q2 than Q1. Customer confidence has weakened in the face of economic newsflow, with many companies scaling back their investment plans, given concerns about the prospects for demand. This was reflected in weak SME application volumes.

UK Corporate has, nevertheless, continued to support its customers, playing an active role in supporting government initiatives, including over 8,000 new loans and asset finance facilities under the Government’s National Loan Guarantee Scheme. The Group has also welcomed the new FLS, and will use the scheme to cut interest rates on £2.5 billion of SME loans by an average of 1% and to remove arrangement fees on the same amount of new SME loans.

H1 2012 saw the launch of an enhanced telephony offering aimed at Business Banking customers: Business Connect. This service now supports 210,000 customers and has already processed over 28,000 calls with 75% of customers very satisfied with the service received. UK Corporate also rolled out an FX campaign, which uses expertise from Corporate & Institutional Banking, Transaction Services UK and Corporate Banking Risk Services to help customers trade internationally.

UK Corporate responded swiftly and decisively to minimise the impact on its customers from the recent Group technology incident. Corporate service centre hours were immediately extended, and business banking customers had access to additional support during extended branch opening hours, while relationship managers were empowered to take critical decisions to action customer payments and drawdowns.

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Operating profit decreased 8% to £1,004 million, driven by higher net funding costs and lower non-interest income, partly offset by reduced costs.
   
·
Net interest income decreased by 3%, predominantly driven by higher net funding costs. While lending income benefited from asset margin increases, this was offset by increased competition on deposit margins.
   
·
Non-interest income decreased 2%, reflecting fee accelerations from refinancing and asset disposal gains in H1 2011, partially offset by a higher revenue share of Markets income.
   
·
Total costs decreased 1% due to cost efficiencies achieved in discretionary spending categories.
   
·
Impairments were 9% higher, primarily driven by the significant release of latent provisions in H1 2011, partially offset by lower individual and collectively assessed provisions.
 
 
 
31

 

UK Corporate (continued)

 
Key points (continued)

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Operating profit increased by 4% to £512 million, driven by higher income and lower costs.
   
·
Net interest income rose by 2% and net interest margin increased 8 basis points largely driven by lower net costs of funding. Strong customer deposit growth supported an improvement in the loan to deposit ratio to 85%.
   
·
Non-interest income decreased 1% as a result of lower Markets revenue share income and valuation movements, partially offset by growth in operating lease activity.
   
·
Total costs decreased 3%, due to the phasing of staff incentive costs and lower Markets revenue related costs, partly offset by operating lease costs.
   
·
Impairments of £181 million were £5 million higher, exhibiting a similar profile to Q1 2012.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Operating profit increased by £40 million, or 8%, predominantly driven by lower impairments.
   
·
Net interest income was broadly flat while net interest margin increased 14 basis points, benefiting from a revision to deferred income recognition assumptions, partially offset by deposit margin pressure and increased net funding costs.
   
·
Non-interest income decreased by £9 million. Higher revenue share of Markets income in Q2 2012 was offset by the non-recurrence of asset disposal gains recorded in Q2 2011 and lower operating lease activity.
   
·
Impairments decreased £39 million, with lower individual provisions slightly offset by reduced latent provision releases.
 
 
 
32

 

 
Wealth

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
357 
325 
 
178 
179 
168 
             
Net fees and commissions
183 
191 
 
90 
93 
94 
Other non-interest income
53 
38 
 
35 
18 
21 
             
Non-interest income
236 
229 
 
125 
111 
115 
             
Total income
593 
554 
 
303 
290 
283 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(233)
(211)
 
(116)
(117)
(111)
  - other
(116)
(95)
 
(56)
(60)
(51)
Indirect expenses
(113)
(110)
 
(55)
(58)
(58)
             
 
(462)
(416)
 
(227)
(235)
(220)
             
Profit before impairment losses
131 
138 
 
76 
55 
63 
Impairment losses
(22)
(8)
 
(12)
(10)
(3)
             
Operating profit
109 
130 
 
64 
45 
60 
             
Analysis of income
           
Private banking
489 
452 
 
252 
237 
231 
Investments
104 
102 
 
51 
53 
52 
             
Total income
593 
554 
 
303 
290 
283 

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
11.6% 
13.9% 
 
13.8% 
9.5% 
12.8% 
Net interest margin
3.68% 
3.29% 
 
3.69% 
3.67% 
3.33% 
Cost:income ratio
78% 
75% 
 
75% 
81% 
78% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - mortgages
8.6 
8.4 
2% 
 
8.3 
4% 
  - personal
5.6 
6.8 
(18%)
 
6.9 
(19%)
  - other
2.8 
1.7 
65% 
 
1.7 
65% 
             
 
17.0 
16.9 
1% 
 
16.9 
1% 
Customer deposits
38.5 
38.3 
1% 
 
38.2 
1% 
Assets under management (excluding deposits)
30.6 
31.4 
(3%)
 
30.9 
(1%)
Risk elements in lending
0.2 
0.2 
 
0.2 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
44% 
44% 
 
44% 
Risk-weighted assets
12.3 
12.9 
(5%)
 
12.9 
(5%)

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
 
 
 
33

 

 
Wealth (continued)

Key points
H1 2012 delivered a strong income performance, driven by improved interest margins, more than offset by higher expenses and increased impairments. Continued volatile markets led to subdued client transactions, resulting in reduced brokerage and foreign exchange income.

The period saw further progress in the implementation of the refreshed Coutts divisional strategy across all jurisdictions. Coutts completed the sale of the Latin American, Caribbean and African business to RBC Wealth Management. The business, with client assets of around £1.5 billion, represented approximately 2% of Coutts’ total client assets. The decision to sell the business was consistent with the new Coutts strategy of simplifying the business and sharpening the focus on key regions and countries, specifically the UK, Switzerland, the Middle East, Russia, the Commonwealth of Independent States and selected countries in Asia.

The UK rollout of the Coutts global technology platform was completed in Q1 2012. The platform, and related strategic investment, will transform the division’s ability to serve clients globally, enabling the business to operate as an international organisation on a unified and common information technology platform.

The division continued to prepare for the implementation of the Retail Distribution Review (RDR) regulations in the UK. Revised Private Banker and Wealth Manager roles were announced aimed at ensuring clients continue to receive the best service and advice based on their specific needs.

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Operating profit declined 16% with a strong income performance more than offset by higher expenses and increased impairments.
   
·
Income increased 7% reflecting an improvement in lending and deposit margins and strong divisional treasury performance, together with the gain from the disposal of the Latin American, Caribbean and African business.
   
·
Expenses increased by 11% reflecting continued strategic investment in the business, a client redress expense following a past business review into the sale of the ALICO Enhanced Variable Rate Fund announced in November 2011 and the Financial Services Authority (FSA) fine incurred during Q1 2012.
   
·
Impairments were £22 million, up £14 million from the low level recorded in the prior period.
   
·
Client assets and liabilities managed by the division declined 3%. Lending volumes remained stable and deposit volumes grew 3%, predominantly through the UK. Assets under management declined 11% with adverse market movements of £2.1 billion, and client outflows of £1.9 billion, predominantly in the latter half of 2011.
   
·
Return on equity declined by 230 basis points to 11.6%, as operating profit declined.
 
 
 
34

 

Wealth (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Operating profit increased 42% to £64 million in the second quarter, including the gain from the sale of the Latin American, Caribbean and African business and the phasing of incentive accruals.
   
·
Income growth of 4% included a 13% increase in non-interest income, reflecting the disposal gain. Excluding the disposal gain, income declined 1%, with lower investment income linked to a decline in assets under management.
   
·
Expenses which include client redress expense following a past business review into the sale of the ALICO Enhanced Variable Rate Fund announced in November 2011 decreased by 3% as a result of lower incentive accruals and the non-recurrence of the FSA fine in Q1 2012.
   
·
Client assets and liabilities managed by the division declined 1%. Lending volumes were broadly stable and deposit volumes increased by 1%. Assets under management declined 3% due to adverse market movements which accounted for £0.6 billion of the movement and net new business outflows of £0.2 billion, mainly in international markets.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Operating profit rose 7% with strong growth in income including the disposal gain, partially offset by client redress costs and higher impairments.
   
·
Income increased 7% as a result of the disposal gain and strong growth in net interest income. Net interest income grew as a result of a 14 basis points improvement in lending margins and strong growth in divisional treasury income. Deposit income also increased with sustained growth in volumes and improved margins. Excluding the impact of the business disposal, non-interest income declined 4% with continued volatile markets subduing client transactions, leading to reduced brokerage and foreign exchange income.
   
·
Expenses increased by 3% due to the impact of the client redress. Excluding this, expenses decreased 5%, assisted by favourable exchange rate movements and management of discretionary costs.
   
·
Impairments were £12 million, up £9 million from the low level recorded in the prior period.
 
 
 
35

 

International Banking

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income from banking activities
494 
604 
 
234 
260 
301 
Funding costs of rental assets
(9)
(21)
 
(9)
(11)
             
Net interest income
485 
583 
 
234 
251 
290 
Non-interest income
618 
729 
 
327 
291 
375 
             
Total income
1,103 
1,312 
 
561 
542 
665 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(340)
(376)
 
(153)
(187)
(181)
  - other
(95)
(118)
 
(47)
(48)
(57)
Indirect expenses
(342)
(345)
 
(167)
(175)
(174)
             
 
(777)
(839)
 
(367)
(410)
(412)
             
Profit before impairment losses
326 
473 
 
194 
132 
253 
Impairment losses
(62)
(98)
 
(27)
(35)
(104)
             
Operating profit
264 
375 
 
167 
97 
149 
             
Of which:
           
Ongoing businesses
281 
395 
 
168 
113 
160 
Run-off businesses
(17)
(20)
 
(1)
(16)
(11)
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Cash management
514 
458 
 
246 
268 
242 
Trade finance
145 
131 
 
73 
72 
69 
Loan portfolio
430 
693 
 
233 
197 
340 
             
Ongoing businesses
1,089 
1,282 
 
552 
537 
651 
Run-off businesses
14 
30 
 
14 
             
Total income
1,103 
1,312 
 
561 
542 
665 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
19 
132 
 
17 
100 
Property and construction
 
Transport and storage
(4)
 
(4)
Telecommunications, media and technology
 
Banks and financial institutions
31 
 
19 
12 
Other
(50)
 
(1)
             
Total impairment losses
62 
98 
 
27 
35 
104 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer loans and advances (excluding reverse repurchase agreements)
0.2% 
0.3% 
 
0.2% 
0.3% 
0.6% 
 
 
 
36

 

International Banking (continued)

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios (ongoing businesses)
           
Return on equity (1)
9.0% 
11.5% 
 
10.5% 
7.5% 
9.6% 
Net interest margin
1.62% 
1.78% 
 
1.65% 
1.60% 
1.73% 
Cost:income ratio
69% 
62% 
 
65% 
72% 
59% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers
49.5 
52.3 
(5%)
 
56.9 
(13%)
Loans and advances to banks
5.1 
3.9 
31% 
 
3.4 
50% 
Securities
2.4 
4.0 
(40%)
 
6.0 
(60%)
Cash and eligible bills
0.7 
0.3 
133% 
 
0.3 
133% 
Other
3.7 
3.2 
16% 
 
3.3 
(12%)
             
Total third party assets (excluding derivatives mark-to-market)
61.4 
63.7 
(4%)
 
69.9 
(12%)
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
42.2 
45.0 
(6%)
 
45.1 
(6%)
Bank deposits
7.7 
10.5 
(27%)
 
11.4 
(32%)
Risk elements in lending
0.7 
0.9 
(22%)
 
1.6 
(56%)
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos and conduits)
102% 
95% 
700bp 
 
103% 
(100bp)
Risk-weighted assets
46.0 
41.8 
10% 
 
43.2 
6% 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax, divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions), for the ongoing businesses.

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Run-off businesses (1)
           
Total income
14 
30 
 
14 
Direct expenses
(31)
(50)
 
(10)
(21)
(25)
             
Operating loss
(17)
(20)
 
(1)
(16)
(11)

Note:
(1)
Run-off businesses consist of the exited corporate finance business.

Key points
H1 results for International Banking were affected by the division’s restructuring, with a substantial reduction in exposures improving capital efficiency but with a consequential impact on income. Debt capital markets were sluggish during the period affecting loan portfolio revenues, but trade finance activity has shown significant growth, particularly in Asia. In Europe, the European Central Bank (ECB) lending and deposit rate cuts in Q2 underlined growing fragility across the region. Clients remain cautious following continued economic uncertainty.

The International Banking structure and governance were fully bedded down by the end of Q2 2012. Management is focused on leveraging the International network and the Transaction Services offering to ensure relevance and intimacy with the division’s client base.
 
 
 
37

 

International Banking (continued)

Key points (continued)

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Operating profit decreased by £111 million as reduced income was only partially mitigated by lower expenses and impairments.
   
·
Income was 16% lower mainly due to a reduction in third party assets coupled with higher funding costs:
 
The lending portfolio decreased by 38%, as exposures were reduced to improve capital efficiency and liquidity levels. Ancillary debt financing income also declined, as economic uncertainty in H1 2012 resulted in sluggish debt capital markets.
 
Cash management increased 12% due to a higher funding surplus and robust deposit retention activity.
 
Trade finance was up by 11% reflecting significant growth in activity, particularly in Asia.
   
·
Expenses were down by £62 million as planned cost initiatives in the Markets & International Banking restructuring took effect.
   
·
Impairments fell by £36 million due to a single name trade finance provision in H1 2011.
   
·
Third party assets fell by 23% mainly due to loan portfolio reductions of £14 billion, reflecting capital management discipline, and a reduced collateral requirement for Japanese business activities.
   
·
Customer deposits decreased 11% as market conditions and a competitive environment created headwinds in raising deposits.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Operating profit was up £70 million driven primarily by planned cost reduction initiatives across the business (£43 million), higher loan portfolio-linked income, and lower impairment charges. Return on equity was 10.5%.
   
·
Income was up £19 million to £561 million despite continued macroeconomic uncertainty and the low interest rate environment.
 
Lending portfolio income was up 18%, benefiting from lower balance sheet funding costs, and positive valuation adjustments on credit hedging activity.
 
Cash management decreased 8% as increasingly difficult economic conditions led to suppressed deposit levels.
   
·
Expenses declined by £43 million, largely reflecting the planned headcount reduction following the formation of the International Banking division, and tight management of technology and support infrastructure costs.
   
·
Impairments in Q2 2012 included a charge of £18 million relating to a single name portfolio exposure.
   
·
Third party assets declined 4%, reflecting a reduction in loan portfolio and in the collateral required for Japanese business activities. This was partially offset by growth in trade finance as the business sought to increase market share and grow capital efficient lending.
   
·
Customer deposits fell by 6% as deposit gathering remained challenging due to continued macroeconomic uncertainty and a competitive environment.
 
 
 
38

 

 
International Banking (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Operating profit was up £18 million with lower expenses and impairments partially offset by lower income driven by planned balance sheet reduction across the loan portfolio.
   
·
Income decreased by 16%:
 
Loan portfolio income fell by £107 million, reflecting a reduction in assets in order to improve capital efficiency and liquidity levels, and lower ancillary revenues associated with debt financing following subdued market activity in Q2 2012.
 
Cash management was up £4 million, despite weak European activity and lower global payments, as a result of a higher funding surplus arising from lower liquidity buffer requirements.
 
Trade finance increased by 6% following continued business initiatives to increase penetration in chosen markets, primarily in Asia.
   
·
Expenses fell by £45 million, largely reflecting planned headcount reduction and increased focus on the management of discretionary costs.
   
·
Impairments were £77 million lower due to a single name trade finance provision in Q2 2011.
 
 
 
39

 

Ulster Bank

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
325 
363 
 
160 
165 
182 
             
Net fees and commissions
73 
73 
 
35 
38 
37 
Other non-interest income
22 
29 
 
11 
11 
14 
             
Non-interest income
95 
102 
 
46 
49 
51 
             
Total income
420 
465 
 
206 
214 
233 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(104)
(113)
 
(52)
(52)
(57)
  - other
(23)
(35)
 
(11)
(12)
(17)
Indirect expenses
(131)
(130)
 
(65)
(66)
(68)
             
 
(258)
(278)
 
(128)
(130)
(142)
             
Profit before impairment losses
162 
187 
 
78 
84 
91 
Impairment losses
(717)
(730)
 
(323)
(394)
(269)
             
Operating loss
(555)
(543)
 
(245)
(310)
(178)
             
             
Analysis of income by business
           
Corporate
190 
230 
 
88 
102 
117 
Retail
174 
211 
 
86 
88 
98 
Other
56 
24 
 
32 
24 
18 
             
Total income
420 
465 
 
206 
214 
233 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Mortgages
356 
311 
 
141 
215 
78 
Corporate
           
  - property
115 
163 
 
61 
54 
66 
  - other corporate
217 
223 
 
103 
114 
103 
Other lending
29 
33 
 
18 
11 
22 
             
Total impairment losses
717 
730 
 
323 
394 
269 
             
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer loans and advances (excluding reverse repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Mortgages
3.7% 
2.9% 
 
2.9% 
4.3% 
1.4% 
Corporate
           
  - property
4.8% 
6.2% 
 
5.1% 
4.4% 
5.0% 
  - other corporate
5.7% 
5.1% 
 
5.4% 
5.8% 
4.7% 
Other lending
4.1% 
4.1% 
 
5.1% 
3.4% 
5.5% 
             
Total
4.3% 
3.9% 
 
3.9% 
4.6% 
2.9% 
 
 
 
40

 

Ulster Bank (continued)

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
(22.8%)
(26.5%)
 
(19.8%)
(25.8%)
(16.9%)
Net interest margin
1.85% 
1.82% 
 
1.82% 
1.87% 
1.80% 
Cost:income ratio
61% 
60% 
 
62% 
61% 
61% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - mortgages
19.2 
19.8 
(3%)
 
20.0 
(4%)
  - corporate
           
     - property
4.8 
4.9 
(2%)
 
4.8 
     - other corporate
7.6 
7.9 
(4%)
 
7.7 
(1%)
  - other lending
1.4 
1.3 
8% 
 
1.6 
(13%)
             
 
33.0 
33.9 
(3%)
 
34.1 
(3%)
Customer deposits
20.6 
21.0 
(2%)
 
21.8 
(6%)
Risk elements in lending
           
  - mortgages
2.6 
2.5 
4% 
 
2.2 
18% 
  - corporate
           
     - property
1.4 
1.3 
8% 
 
1.3 
8% 
     - other corporate
2.0 
1.9 
5% 
 
1.8 
11% 
  - other lending
0.2 
0.2 
 
0.2 
             
Total risk elements in lending
6.2 
5.9 
5% 
 
5.5 
13% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
144% 
147% 
(300bp)
 
143% 
100bp 
Risk-weighted assets
37.4 
38.4 
(3%)
 
36.3 
3% 
             
Spot exchange rate - €/£
1.238 
1.200 
   
1.196 
 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating loss after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key points
Trading conditions remained difficult, as Irish economic indicators continue to be weak. The high cost of funding has an adverse impact on income, while impairment levels are still elevated, asset prices weakening over the period and residential mortgage arrears continue to rise, albeit with less deterioration in credit metrics in Q2 than in Q1 2012. Cost management remained a central priority.

The recent RBS Group technology incident, affecting a number of the Group’s payments systems, has had an extended impact on Ulster Bank customers. During the period of disruption Ulster Bank’s main priority was to help customers experiencing difficulty. Branches remained open for longer and the number of staff in call centres was trebled. Provision for costs arising from this incident are included in central items (see page 60).
 
 
 
41

 

Ulster Bank (continued)

Key points (continued)

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
The operating loss of £555 million was marginally higher than H1 2011, with lower income only partly offset by lower expenses and impairment losses.
   
·
Income decreased by 10% due to a combination of reducing assets and higher funding costs. Net interest margin increased by 3 basis points with the benefit of loan re-pricing initiatives largely offsetting the higher cost of funds.
   
·
Expenses decreased by 7% reflecting the benefits of cost saving initiatives, particularly relating to discretionary spend.
   
·
Impairment losses reduced marginally by 2%, however credit conditions in Ireland remain challenging with asset prices deteriorating over the period and residential mortgage arrears rising.
   
·
Loans and advances to customers declined by 12% reflecting further amortisation and the continuing weak demand for credit.
   
·
Customer deposit balances declined by 15% due to outflows of wholesale balances over the period with Retail and SME balances remaining stable despite the competitive market, particularly in the Republic of Ireland.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
The operating loss of £245 million decreased by £65 million primarily driven by a reduction in mortgage impairment losses.
   
·
Net interest income reduced marginally due to the continuing high cost of deposits. Net interest margin decreased by 5 basis points, principally due to higher liquid assets during the period.
   
·
Non-interest income fell by £3 million in the quarter largely due to lower volumes of derivative product sales during the period following the technology incident.
   
·
Expenses fell by £2 million over the period as cost management initiatives continued to be implemented.
   
·
Impairment losses decreased by £71 million reflecting a reduction in mortgage losses due to a reduced level of deterioration in credit metrics during the quarter.
   
·
Customer deposit balances remained flat despite significant market volatility and the impact of a credit rating downgrade. Loans and advances to customers fell 3% during the quarter.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets remained flat on a constant currency basis.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
The operating loss increased by £67 million as higher impairment losses and lower income were only partly offset by a reduction in expenses.
   
·
Income decreased by 12% due to lower earning asset volumes and higher funding costs. Net interest margin remained broadly flat.
   
·
Expenses decreased by 10% due to active management of the cost base with a focus on reducing discretionary expenditure.
   
·
Impairment losses increased by £54 million, largely reflecting affordability issues and the continued deterioration in asset quality as property prices declined further over the period.
 
 
 
42

 

 
US Retail & Commercial (£ Sterling)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
988 
922 
 
492 
496 
470 
             
Net fees and commissions
390 
419 
 
195 
195 
217 
Other non-interest income
193 
135 
 
128 
65 
62 
             
Non-interest income
583 
554 
 
323 
260 
279 
             
Total income
1,571 
1,476 
 
815 
756 
749 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(440)
(412)
 
(217)
(223)
(211)
  - other
(260)
(264)
 
(144)
(116)
(138)
  - litigation settlement
(88)
 
(88)
Indirect expenses
(405)
(387)
 
(197)
(208)
(192)
             
 
(1,193)
(1,063)
 
(558)
(635)
(541)
             
Profit before impairment losses
378 
413 
 
257 
121 
208 
Impairment losses
(47)
(176)
 
(28)
(19)
(65)
             
Operating profit
331 
237 
 
229 
102 
143 
             
             
Average exchange rate - US$/£
1.577 
1.616 
 
1.582 
1.571 
1.631 
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Mortgages and home equity
268 
216 
 
134 
134 
107 
Personal lending and cards
201 
225 
 
102 
99 
113 
Retail deposits
444 
452 
 
224 
220 
234 
Commercial lending
311 
286 
 
151 
160 
148 
Commercial deposits
227 
201 
 
113 
114 
102 
Other
120 
96 
 
91 
29 
45 
             
Total income
1,571 
1,476 
 
815 
756 
749 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Residential mortgages
18 
 
(4)
12 
Home equity
42 
51 
 
20 
22 
12 
Corporate and commercial
(22)
42 
 
(6)
(16)
23 
Other consumer
20 
28 
 
17 
Securities
37 
 
10 
             
Total impairment losses
47 
176 
 
28 
19 
65 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer loans and advances (excluding reverse repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Residential mortgages
0.1% 
0.6% 
 
(0.3%)
0.4% 
0.8% 
Home equity
0.6% 
0.7% 
 
0.6% 
0.6% 
0.3% 
Corporate and commercial
(0.2%)
0.4% 
 
(0.1%)
(0.3%)
0.4% 
Other consumer
0.5% 
0.9% 
 
0.8% 
0.2% 
0.5% 
             
Total
0.2% 
0.6% 
 
0.2% 
0.1% 
0.5% 
 
 
 
43

 

US Retail & Commercial (£ Sterling) (continued)

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
7.3% 
5.7% 
 
10.0% 
4.5% 
6.9% 
Return on equity - excluding litigation settlement
  and net gain on the sale of Visa B shares (1)
8.4% 
5.7% 
 
8.3% 
8.4% 
6.9% 
Net interest margin
3.04% 
3.06% 
 
3.02% 
3.06% 
3.12% 
Cost:income ratio
76% 
72% 
 
69% 
84% 
72% 
Cost:income ratio - excluding litigation settlement and net gain on the sale of Visa B shares
72% 
72% 
 
72% 
72% 
72% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
75.1 
73.7 
2% 
 
75.8 
(1%)
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - residential mortgages
6.1 
6.0 
2% 
 
6.1 
  - home equity
14.2 
14.2 
 
14.9 
(5%)
  - corporate and commercial
23.6 
22.6 
4% 
 
22.9 
3% 
  - other consumer
8.3 
8.1 
2% 
 
7.7 
8% 
             
 
52.2 
50.9 
3% 
 
51.6 
1% 
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
59.2 
58.7 
1% 
 
60.0 
(1%)
Bank deposits (excluding repos)
5.0 
4.3 
16% 
 
5.2 
(4%)
Risk elements in lending
           
  - retail
0.6 
0.6 
 
0.6 
  - commercial
0.4 
0.3 
33% 
 
0.4 
             
Total risk elements in lending
1.0 
0.9 
11% 
 
1.0 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
87% 
86% 
100bp 
 
85% 
200bp 
Risk-weighted assets
58.5 
58.6 
 
59.3 
(1%)
             
Spot exchange rate - US$/£
1.569 
1.599 
   
1.548 
 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key point
·
Sterling strengthened relative to the US dollar during the first half of 2012, with the spot exchange rate increasing by 1.4% compared with 31 December 2011.
   
 
 
 
44

 

US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
$m 
$m 
 
$m 
$m 
$m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
1,557 
1,491 
 
778 
779 
767 
             
Net fees and commissions
616 
678 
 
309 
307 
354 
Other non-interest income
304 
216 
 
202 
102 
100 
             
Non-interest income
920 
894 
 
511 
409 
454 
             
Total income
2,477 
2,385 
 
1,289 
1,188 
1,221 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(694)
(665)
 
(344)
(350)
(343)
  - other
(410)
(427)
 
(228)
(182)
(224)
  - litigation settlement
(138)
 
(138)
Indirect expenses
(638)
(625)
 
(311)
(327)
(313)
             
 
(1,880)
(1,717)
 
(883)
(997)
(880)
             
Profit before impairment losses
597 
668 
 
406 
191 
341 
Impairment losses
(74)
(285)
 
(43)
(31)
(108)
             
Operating profit
523 
383 
 
363 
160 
233 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Mortgages and home equity
422 
350 
 
211 
211 
175 
Personal lending and cards
317 
364 
 
161 
156 
185 
Retail deposits
701 
730 
 
355 
346 
381 
Commercial lending
490 
462 
 
239 
251 
241 
Commercial deposits
358 
325 
 
179 
179 
167 
Other
189 
154 
 
144 
45 
72 
             
Total income
2,477 
2,385 
 
1,289 
1,188 
1,221 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Residential mortgages
28 
 
(6)
19 
Home equity
65 
82 
 
30 
35 
19 
Corporate and commercial
(34)
67 
 
(9)
(25)
37 
Other consumer
33 
49 
 
27 
17 
Securities
59 
 
16 
             
Total impairment losses
74 
285 
 
43 
31 
108 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer loans and advances (excluding reverse repurchase agreements) by sector
           
Residential mortgages
0.1% 
0.6% 
 
(0.3%)
0.4% 
0.8% 
Home equity
0.6% 
0.7% 
 
0.5% 
0.6% 
0.3% 
Corporate and commercial
(0.2%)
0.4% 
 
(0.1%)
(0.3%)
0.4% 
Other consumer
0.5% 
0.9% 
 
0.8% 
0.2% 
0.7% 
             
Total
0.2% 
0.6% 
 
0.2% 
0.1% 
0.5% 
 
 
 
45

 

 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
7.3% 
5.7% 
 
10.0% 
4.5% 
6.9% 
Return on equity - excluding litigation settlement and net gain on the sale of Visa B shares (1)
8.4% 
5.7% 
 
8.3% 
8.4% 
6.9% 
Net interest margin
3.04% 
3.06% 
 
3.02% 
3.06% 
3.12% 
Cost:income ratio
76% 
72% 
 
69% 
84% 
72% 
Cost:income ratio - excluding litigation settlement and net gain on the sale of Visa B shares
72% 
72% 
 
72% 
72% 
72% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
$bn 
$bn 
Change 
 
$bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
117.8 
117.9 
 
117.3 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - residential mortgages
9.6 
9.5 
1% 
 
9.4 
2% 
  - home equity
22.3 
22.6 
(1%)
 
23.1 
(3%)
  - corporate and commercial
37.0 
36.2 
2% 
 
35.3 
5% 
  - other consumer
13.1 
13.2 
(1%)
 
12.0 
9% 
             
 
82.0 
81.5 
1% 
 
79.8 
3% 
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
92.9 
93.9 
(1%)
 
92.8 
Bank deposits (excluding repos)
7.8 
6.9 
13% 
 
8.0 
(3%)
Risk elements in lending
           
  - retail
1.0 
0.9 
11% 
 
1.0 
  - commercial
0.6 
0.6 
 
0.6 
             
Total risk elements in lending
1.6 
1.5 
7% 
 
1.6 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
87% 
86% 
100bp 
 
85% 
200bp 
Risk-weighted assets
91.7 
93.7 
(2%)
 
91.8 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key points
US Retail & Commercial performed strongly in H1 2012, with a significant improvement in operating profit, largely reflecting lower impairment losses. The macroeconomic operating environment remained challenging, with low rates, high unemployment, a soft housing market, sluggish consumer activity and the continuing impact of legislative changes. However, the credit environment showed signs of improvement.

US Retail & Commercial has focused on its back-to-basics strategy; concentrating on core banking products and competing on service and product capabilities rather than price. This was supported by the four core Customer Commitments launched across the entire branch footprint last year. The division enhanced its mobile capabilities, launching an Android app along with an improved iPhone user experience, including a new person-to-person (P2P) payment application. Consumers also recognised Citizens Bank as within the top 10 US banks for corporate reputation in the 2012 American Banker survey, an increase of eight places from 2011.
 
 
RBS Group – 2012 Interim Results
 
46

 

US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key points (continued)
In Q2 2012, Commercial Banking introduced its own four core Client Commitments, which were built around client feedback. Standard & Poor’s recently recognised US Retail & Commercial’s continued focus on strengthening and growing valued Commercial Banking client relationships as delivering results and providing differentiation from competitors based on the quality of ideas and solutions.

The reintegration of both Corporate Risk Solutions and Treasury Solutions into Commercial Banking has significantly strengthened the cross-sell of Treasury Solutions products as well as foreign exchange and derivatives hedging to the Commercial client base. Referrals increased by 25% for derivatives, 6% for foreign exchange services and 36% for cash management compared with the same period last year.

In Q2 2012, Citizens executed a referral partnership with Oppenheimer & Company to address the corporate finance needs of its Commercial Enterprise Banking and Middle Market clients. As a result, Commercial bankers are now able to offer their clients timely and relevant corporate finance solutions, including mergers & acquisitions, joint ventures, divestitures and common equity underwriting.

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
US Retail & Commercial posted an operating profit of £331 million ($523 million), up £94 million ($140 million), or 40%, from H1 2011. Excluding the £88 million ($138 million) litigation settlement in Q1 2012 and the £39 million ($62 million) net gain on the sale of Visa B shares in Q2 2012, operating profit was up £143 million ($216 million), or 60%, largely reflecting lower impairment losses due to an improved credit environment.
   
·
Net interest income was up £66 million ($66 million), or 7%, driven by commercial loan growth, deposit pricing discipline and lower funding costs, partially offset by consumer loan run-off and lower asset yields.
   
·
Non-interest income was up £29 million ($26 million), or 5%, reflecting the £47 million ($75 million) gain on Visa B shares and strong mortgage banking fees, significantly offset by lower security gains and a decline in debit card fees as a result of the Durbin Amendment legislation.
   
·
Citizens completed the sale of Visa B shares in June 2012 resulting in a net gain of £39 million ($62 million) consisting of a £47 million ($75 million) gain on sale and a £8 million ($13 million) litigation reserve associated with two outstanding lawsuits against Visa (and all Visa Class B owners).
   
·
The Durbin Amendment in the Dodd-Frank Act became effective 1 October 2011 and lowers the allowable interchange on debit transactions by approximately 50% to $0.23 - $0.24 per transaction.
   
·
Total expenses were up £130 million ($163 million), or 12%, as Q1 2012 included a £88 million ($138 million) litigation settlement in a class action lawsuit relating to how overdraft fees were assessed on customer accounts prior to 2010. Citizens was one of more than 30 banks included in these class action lawsuits.
   
·
Excluding the litigation settlement and the £8 million ($13 million) litigation reserve related to the sale of Visa B shares, total expenses were up £34 million ($12 million), largely reflecting a change in accrual methodology related to the annual incentive plan during H1 2011. This was partially offset by lower loan collection costs and the elimination of the Everyday Points rewards programme for consumer debit card customers.
 
 
 
47

 

 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key points (continued)

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011 (continued)
·
Impairment losses declined by £129 million ($211 million), reflecting an improved credit environment as well as lower impairments related to securities.
   
·
Customer deposits were up 4% with strong growth achieved in checking balances. Consumer checking balances grew by 3% while small business checking balances grew by 8% over the year.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Operating profit of £229 million ($363 million), compared with £102 million ($160 million) in the prior quarter, an increase of £127 million ($203 million). Excluding the Q1 2012 litigation settlement and the Q2 2012 net gain on the sale of Visa B shares, operating profit was broadly in line with Q1 2012.
   
·
Net interest income was in line with the prior quarter. Asset growth offset a decrease in net interest margin of 4 basis points to 3.02% reflecting lower asset yields, partially offset by lower funding costs.
   
·
Loans and advances were up £1.3 billion ($0.5 billion), or 3%, due to strong growth in commercial loan volumes partially offset by continued run-off of consumer loan balances reflecting reduced credit demand and the unwillingness to hold long term fixed rate products.
   
·
Non-interest income was up £63 million ($102 million), or 24%, reflecting a £47 million ($75 million) gain on the sale of Visa B shares and securities gains of £16 million ($26 million).
   
·
Excluding the £88 million ($138 million) litigation settlement and the £8 million ($13 million) litigation reserve associated with the sale of Visa B shares, total expenses were up £3 million ($11 million), or 1%, largely reflecting a mortgage servicing rights impairment.
   
·
Impairment losses were up £9 million ($12 million), although the credit environment remains broadly stable.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Excluding the £39 million ($62 million) net gain on the sale of Visa B shares in Q2 2012, operating profit increased to £190 million ($301 million) from £143 million ($233 million), an increase of £47 million ($68 million), or 33%, substantially driven by lower impairment losses.
   
·
Total expenses were broadly in line with Q2 2011. Excluding the £8 million ($13 million) litigation reserve related to the sale of Visa B shares, total expenses increased by £9 million. In US dollar terms expenses fell $10 million primarily reflecting lower loan collection costs and the elimination of the Everyday Points rewards programme for consumer debit card customers.
 
 
 
48

 

Markets

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
48 
56 
 
32 
16 
             
Net fees and commissions receivable
100 
274 
 
23 
77 
119 
Income from trading activities
2,304 
2,516 
 
925 
1,379 
893 
Other operating income (net of related funding costs)
348 
430 
 
86 
262 
153 
             
Non-interest income
2,752 
3,220 
 
1,034 
1,718 
1,165 
             
Total income
2,800 
3,276 
 
1,066 
1,734 
1,168 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(967)
(1,203)
 
(423)
(544)
(476)
  - other
(351)
(354)
 
(185)
(166)
(188)
Indirect expenses
(386)
(377)
 
(188)
(198)
(191)
             
 
(1,704)
(1,934)
 
(796)
(908)
(855)
             
Profit before impairment losses
1,096 
1,342 
 
270 
826 
313 
Impairment (losses)/recoveries
(21)
14 
 
(19)
(2)
14 
             
Operating profit
1,075 
1,356 
 
251 
824 
327 
             
Of which:
           
Ongoing businesses
1,129 
1,364 
 
268 
861 
325 
Run-off businesses
(54)
(8)
 
(17)
(37)
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Rates
1,217 
1,036 
 
416 
801 
287 
Currencies
421 
508 
 
175 
246 
267 
Asset backed products (ABP)
805 
984 
 
378 
427 
367 
Credit markets
497 
638 
 
184 
313 
208 
Investor products and equity derivatives
214 
399 
 
91 
123 
183 
             
Total income ongoing businesses
3,154 
3,565 
 
1,244 
1,910 
1,312 
Inter-divisional revenue share
(360)
(412)
 
(174)
(186)
(204)
Run-off businesses
123 
 
(4)
10 
60 
             
Total income
2,800 
3,276 
 
1,066 
1,734 
1,168 
             
Memo - Fixed income and currencies
           
Rates/currencies/ABP/credit markets
2,940 
3,166 
 
1,153 
1,787 
1,129 
Less: primary credit markets
(303)
(417)
 
(132)
(171)
(188)
             
Total fixed income and currencies
2,637 
2,749 
 
1,021 
1,616 
941 
 
 
 
49

 

 
Markets (continued)

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios (ongoing businesses)
           
Return on equity (1)
14.0% 
17.1% 
 
6.8% 
21.1% 
8.2% 
Cost:income ratio
59% 
57% 
 
73% 
50% 
72% 
Compensation ratio (2)
33% 
35% 
 
38% 
29% 
39% 


 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet (ongoing
  businesses)
           
Loans and advances
53.7 
50.5 
6% 
 
61.2 
(12%)
Reverse repos
97.6 
90.8 
7% 
 
100.4 
(3%)
Securities
101.7 
106.6 
(5%)
 
108.1 
(6%)
Cash and eligible bills
26.8 
24.2 
11% 
 
28.1 
(5%)
Other
22.2 
27.7 
(20%)
 
14.8 
50% 
             
Total third party assets (excluding derivatives mark-to-market)
302.0 
299.8 
1% 
 
312.6 
(3%)
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
34.3 
34.6 
(1%)
 
36.8 
(7%)
Bank deposits (excluding repos)
50.7 
46.2 
10% 
 
48.2 
5% 
Net derivative assets (after netting)
27.5 
29.3 
(6%)
 
37.0 
(26%)
Risk-weighted assets
107.9 
115.6 
(7%)
 
120.3 
(10%)

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax, divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions), for the ongoing businesses.
(2)
Compensation ratio is based on staff costs as a percentage of total income.


 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
Run-off businesses (1)
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Total income
123 
 
(4)
10 
60 
Direct expenses
(60)
(131)
 
(13)
(47)
(58)
             
Operating loss
(54)
(8)
 
(17)
(37)


 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
Run-off businesses (1)
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Total third party assets (excluding derivatives mark-to-market)
0.4 
0.8 
1.3 

Note:
(1)
Run-off businesses consist of the exited cash equities, corporate broking and equity capital markets operations.
 
 
 
50

 
 
Markets (continued)

Key points
In both H1 2011 and H1 2012, Markets benefited from an initial surge in investor confidence, with H1 2012 helped by the increased liquidity provided in Q1 2012 by the ECB’s Long Term Refinancing Operation (LTRO). In both periods, however, confidence fell away quickly, with the decline in H1 2012 being precipitated by heightened instability in peripheral European financial markets.

Trading conditions during Q2 2012 have been challenging, driven by renewed uncertainty in the Eurozone and slowing Chinese growth. Investor confidence and appetite for risk have declined, causing client volumes to weaken. This mirrors the conditions seen at the end of 2011 but contrasts with Q1 2012.

The difficult environment reinforces Markets’ decision to restructure, announced in January of this year. The sale of the cash equities business in the Asia Pacific region has been announced and the remainder of cash equities is being efficiently wound down. Within the ongoing businesses the new structure has been largely cascaded through the front office - the division’s focus remains the provision of a seamless service to clients within the context of the strategy to reduce the balance sheet.

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Operating profit of the ongoing businesses fell 17% as revenue generation weakened across a range of products.
   
 
Currencies suffered from historically low levels of client activity.
 
Asset backed products were less affected by the loss of confidence in markets, though the Q1 2012 recovery in demand was weaker than in Q1 2011, leading to an overall decrease in revenue in H1 2012 compared with H1 2011.
 
Credit and loan markets suffered from low origination activity as both issuers and investors lacked confidence and opportunity in difficult markets.
 
Investor products and equity derivatives fell 46%, as issuer and redemption volumes remained weak.
 
·
Revenue in rates was 17% higher. However, the increase was partially driven by an improvement in counterparty exposure management, a c.£90 million gain in H1 2012 compared with a c.£40 million loss in H1 2011, despite high volatility in counterparty spreads and real rates.
   
·
The overall decline in expenses was driven by a focus on cost discipline (including a reduction in headcount within the ongoing businesses), the wind-down of the run-off businesses and a lower level of variable compensation. The compensation ratio in the ongoing businesses declined to 33%, compared with 35% in H1 2011.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Markets’ profitability was constrained by the difficult trading conditions during Q2 2012, despite a decrease in costs.
   
·
Rates fell from a strong Q1 2012 as a heightened level of risk aversion limited trading opportunities. In the swaps market, underlying rates flattened and asset spreads widened.
   
·
In currencies, client volume remained subdued. Earnings were affected by the uncertainty in the Eurozone and slowing Chinese growth, with the generally risk-averse market sentiment negatively affecting emerging markets in particular, as investors sought safe havens.
 
 
 
51

 

Markets (continued)

Key points

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012 (continued)
·
Asset backed products continued to perform strongly, benefiting from both strong client volumes and a robust trading performance, although markets were less buoyant than during Q1 2012. Asset prices remained firm, despite an increase in supply through a series of auctions by the New York Federal Reserve.
   
·
The credit market recovery in Q1 2012 was short lived. Conditions began to deteriorate in March and this continued into Q2 2012, exacerbating the traditionally slow April and limiting recovery thereafter. Although the UK corporate debt capital market business maintained its market-leading position, opportunities for origination activity were limited. Flow credit trading remained robust, although weaker than a strong Q1 2012.
   
·
Demand for investor products and equity derivatives remained weak. Client volumes remained well below 2011 levels amid unsettled equity markets, with UK volumes also affected by the impact of the Retail Distribution Review.
   
·
Total expenses fell by 12%. Cost discipline remained a central focus for the division, with further reductions compared with Q1 2012 reflecting the wind-down of run-off businesses and a reduction in variable compensation, reflecting lower revenue. Other costs increased as a result of additional legal expenses in the quarter.
   
·
Impairments in both Q1 2012 and Q2 2012 reflected a small number of individual provisions.
   
·
Third party assets were flat and remain on track to meet previously disclosed targets.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets fell, reflecting a continued focus on mitigation actions.
   
·
Return on equity for the ongoing businesses was 6.8% compared with 21.1% in Q1 2012.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Operating profit of the ongoing businesses fell 18%, driven by lower revenue, partly offset by lower costs.
   
 
The increase in rates revenue reflected a positive contribution from counterparty exposure management, with a c.£70 million gain in Q2 2012 compared with a c.£30 million loss in Q2 2011, despite volatility in counterparty spreads and interest rates in the period.
 
Flow currencies revenues held up well despite lower client volumes, but the currency options business had poor trading results.
 
Investor products and equity derivatives fell sharply compared with the same period last year. Client activity declined significantly year on year.
   
·
Cost reduction measures introduced during 2011 have driven down discretionary expenditure. Staff costs have been reduced through headcount reductions in the ongoing businesses and the wind-down of the run-off businesses. Other costs in Q2 2012 were higher due to additional legal expenses.
   
·
A regulatory-led increase in risk-weighted assets in 2012 has been managed down through a range of mitigating actions, leading to a 10% reduction compared with 31 December 2011.
 
 
 
52

 

Direct Line Group

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Earned premiums
2,032 
2,121 
 
1,012 
1,020 
1,056 
Reinsurers' share
(165)
(114)
 
(83)
(82)
(60)
             
Net premium income
1,867 
2,007 
 
929 
938 
996 
Fees and commissions
(222)
(156)
 
(113)
(109)
(81)
Instalment income
62 
70 
 
31 
31 
35 
Investment income
163 
133 
 
73 
90 
69 
Other income
30 
62 
 
14 
16 
27 
             
Total income
1,900 
2,116 
 
934 
966 
1,046 
Net claims
(1,225)
(1,488)
 
(576)
(649)
(704)
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff expenses
(160)
(146)
 
(81)
(79)
(70)
  - other expenses
(172)
(166)
 
(81)
(91)
(79)
             
Total direct expenses
(332)
(312)
 
(162)
(170)
(149)
Indirect expenses
(124)
(110)
 
(61)
(63)
(54)
             
 
(456)
(422)
 
(223)
(233)
(203)
             
Net claims
(1,225)
(1,488)
 
(576)
(649)
(704)
 
           
Operating profit
219 
206 
 
135 
84 
139 
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
891 
939 
 
440 
451 
471 
  - partnerships
70 
143 
 
34 
36 
63 
Personal lines home excluding broker
           
  - own brands
244 
243 
 
123 
121 
123 
  - partnerships
190 
198 
 
98 
92 
95 
Personal lines rescue and other excluding broker
           
  - own brands
91 
94 
 
45 
46 
47 
  - partnerships
92 
99 
 
48 
44 
51 
Commercial
175 
173 
 
84 
91 
86 
International
175 
168 
 
88 
87 
87 
Other (1)
(28)
59 
 
(26)
(2)
23 
             
Total income
1,900 
2,116 
 
934 
966 
1,046 

For the notes to this table refer to page 55.
 
 
 
53

 

Direct Line Group (continued)

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
In-force policies (000s)
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
3,816 
3,931 
 
3,816 
3,827 
3,931 
  - partnerships
319 
474 
 
319 
322 
474 
Personal lines home excluding broker
           
  - own brands
1,795 
1,844 
 
1,795 
1,812 
1,844 
  - partnerships
2,509 
2,524 
 
2,509 
2,520 
2,524 
Personal lines rescue and other excluding broker
           
  - own brands
1,798 
1,932 
 
1,798 
1,803 
1,932 
  - partnerships
7,895 
7,577 
 
7,895 
7,493 
7,577 
Commercial
496 
393 
 
496 
417 
393 
International
1,441 
1,302 
 
1,441 
1,412 
1,302 
Other (1)
54 
211 
 
54 
123 
211 
             
Total in-force policies (2)
20,123 
20,188 
 
20,123 
19,729 
20,188 
             
Gross written premium (£m)
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
776 
798 
 
378 
398 
408 
  - partnerships
69 
73 
 
32 
37 
36 
Personal lines home excluding broker
           
  - own brands
222 
229 
 
112 
110 
117 
  - partnerships
263 
273 
 
127 
136 
135 
Personal lines rescue and other excluding broker
           
  - own brands
88 
86 
 
45 
43 
44 
  - partnerships
86 
82 
 
45 
41 
42 
Commercial
230 
232 
 
123 
107 
120 
International
306 
303 
 
133 
173 
134 
Other (1)
(5)
 
(2)
             
Total gross written premium
2,042 
2,071 
 
996 
1,046 
1,034 

For the notes to this table refer to page 55.
 
 
 
54

 

Direct Line Group (continued)

Key metrics (continued)
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on tangible equity (3)
10.1% 
9.5% 
 
13.4% 
7.4% 
12.9% 
Loss ratio (4)
66% 
74% 
 
62% 
69% 
71% 
Commission ratio (5)
12% 
8% 
 
12% 
12% 
8% 
Expense ratio (6)
24% 
21% 
 
24% 
25% 
20% 
Combined operating ratio (7)
102% 
103% 
 
98% 
106% 
99% 
             
Balance sheet
           
Total insurance reserves - (£m) (8)
     
8,184 
8,132 
7,557 

Notes:
(1)
‘Other’ predominantly consists of the personal lines broker business and from Q1 2012 business previously reported in Non-Core.
(2)
Total in-force policies include travel and creditor policies sold through RBS Group. These comprise travel policies included in bank accounts e.g. Royalties Gold Account, and creditor policies sold with bank products including mortgage, loan and card payment protection.
(3)
Return on tangible equity is based on annualised operating profit after tax divided by average tangible equity adjusted for dividend payments.
(4)
Loss ratio is based on net claims divided by net premium income.
(5)
Commission ratio is based on fees and commissions divided by net premium income.
(6)
Expense ratio is based on expenses divided by net premium income.
(7)
Combined operating ratio is the sum of the loss, commission and expense ratios.
(8)
Consists of general and life insurance liabilities, unearned premium reserve and liability adequacy reserve. Q1 2012 includes business previously reported in Non-Core.

Key points
Direct Line Group continues to make good progress with improved loss ratios and stabilisation of in-force policies demonstrating that the transformation plan is effective.

Operating profit for H1 2012 of £219 million was 6% higher than H1 2011. Operating profit of £135 million for Q2 2012 was 61% higher than Q1 2012 but in line with Q2 2011. Q2 2012 included Home weather claims of approximately £40 million worse than expected for a summer quarter following the wettest April to June period since UK meteorological records began. This was more than offset by significant releases from reserves held against prior year claims across the portfolio. Reserve releases were in part attributable to benefits arising from Direct Line Group’s claims transformation programme reflecting significant investment since 2010.

In 2012, Direct Line Group has made significant progress in developing its distribution capabilities. It has renewed or expanded partnership agreements that represent a substantial portion of its portfolio, especially in its home segment. The agreement with Sainsbury’s to provide motor insurance to its customers is now in its second year and was recently extended to provide home insurance. Furthermore, Direct Line Group is in the process of agreeing terms with the UK Retail division for an arm’s length, five year distribution agreement for the continued provision of general insurance products after the divestment.

Following launch on comparethemarket.com, Churchill and Privilege motor insurance products are now available on all four major price comparison websites in the UK. This move reinforces Direct Line Group’s multi-channel distribution strategy.
 
 
 
55

 

Direct Line Group (continued)

Key points (continued)
Execution of Direct Line Group’s clear strategic plan continues with further developments in its pricing capability, embedding peril level technical pricing models for Home and developing price optimisation for Motor. Within claims management, and following rigorous pilot testing, a number of claims initiatives were implemented and the benefits are beginning to emerge. Claims inflation in small bodily injury claims has reduced and together with lower litigation rates has contributed to higher reserve releases from estimates for prior year claims.

In-force policies of 20.1 million were up 2% in the quarter and 4% since the start of the year. The main growth was in Rescue and other personal lines due to an increase in travel policies from packaged bank accounts. Within Motor, in-force policies were stable marking a stabilisation in the portfolio following a period of de-risking and business exits during the period 2009 to 2011. The Motor market remained competitive with prices broadly stable in H1 2012.

Commercial income was slightly higher than the equivalent period for 2011. In-force policies continued to increase due to growth in Direct Line for Business.

International consolidated its position during the first half of 2012, although reported gross written premium was adversely affected by foreign exchange rates. This followed a period of strong growth in 2010 and 2011. Operating profit in the quarter improved, partially as a result of releases in prior year claims reserves. International continues to benefit from its multi-channel distribution model including partnerships.

In line with its strategic business transformation plan, Direct Line Group has identified further initiatives to realise £100 million of gross annual cost and claims savings by the end of 2014(1), with one-off restructuring costs, for all cost saving initiatives, expected to be c.£100 million. The initiatives include reducing administration costs in central functions and improving marketing efficiency.

Direct Line Group supports the current regulatory reviews and initiatives announced by the UK Government, the Ministry of Justice, the Office of Fair Trading and others in relation to the motor insurance industry. It is actively engaged with the major stakeholders, and supports the introduction of a coherent set of reforms.

Direct Line Group also made further progress in optimising its capital structure during the first six months of 2012. On 27 April 2012, £500 million of Tier 2 subordinated debt was raised following publication of inaugural credit ratings from both Standard and Poor’s and Moody’s Investor Services. In addition, a £500 million dividend was paid to RBS Group on 6 June 2012, a total of £800 million for H1 2012. At 30 June 2012, shareholders’ equity was £2.9 billion, with tangible shareholders’ equity of £2.6 billion.

Direct Line Group continues to be well capitalised, with an estimated Insurance Group’s Directive (IGD) coverage ratio of 299%.

Investment markets remained challenging with continued low yields. Direct Line Group continues to manage its investment portfolios carefully, with portfolios composed primarily of cash, investment grade corporate bonds and gilts. At 30 June 2012, exposure to peripheral Eurozone debt was £51 million, less than 1% of the portfolio, comprising non-sovereign debt issued in Ireland, Italy and Spain. During the quarter Direct Line Group invested c.£400 million in US dollar corporate credit, hedged back to Sterling, through leading global third party asset managers.

(1)
Cost savings expected to be recognised in operating expenses and claims handling expenses.
 
 
 
56

 
 
Direct Line Group (continued)

Key points (continued)

Separation update
From 1 July 2012, Direct Line Group is operating on a substantially standalone basis with independent corporate functions and governance following successful execution of a comprehensive programme of initiatives. During H1 2012, these included: launching a new corporate identity, confirming further senior management appointments, appointing a chairman, agreeing and issuing new terms and conditions for staff, implementing independent HR systems and making progress on an arm’s length transitional services agreement with RBS Group for residual services.

Overall, Direct Line Group continues to deliver on the transformation required to fulfil its aim to be Britain’s best retail general insurer.

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Operating profit of £219 million was £13 million, 6% higher than H1 2011 despite the impact of Home weather claims of c.£50 million more than expected, versus benign conditions in H1 2011. The result reflected stable underlying business performance in a competitive market.
   
·
Gross written premium of £2,042 million was broadly flat compared with H1 2011 in a competitive market.
   
·
Total income decreased by £216 million, predominantly driven by lower earned premiums following planned volume reduction on Motor and the exit of the personal lines Broker business. H1 2012 included commissions payable relating to business previously reported within Non-Core. Other income decreased by £32 million due to the loss of Tesco Personal Finance tariff income and reduced supply chain income, linked to lower claims volumes.
   
·
Net claims of £1,225 million were £263 million, 18%, lower than the same period last year driven by a combination of reduced exposure, exit of the personal line Broker business, tight underwriting discipline and prior year reserve releases partly attributable to the claims transformation programme. This was partly offset by adverse weather experienced in H1 2012.
   
·
Direct expenses increased by £20 million, mainly driven by the phasing of marketing expenditure in Q1 2012, and increased head office expenses as Direct Line Group prepares for separation from RBS Group.
   
·
Investment income was up £30 million, 23%, due to the inclusion of income from investments from business previously reported in Non-Core, together with investment gains arising from portfolio management initiatives, partially offset by lower yields and interest on the recent Tier 2 debt issued.
   
·
Total in-force policies remained relatively stable despite a competitive market. The decline in Motor was mainly due to termination of previous partnership arrangements and the exit of unprofitable business, partially offset by the commencement of the Sainsbury’s partnership. The decline was largely offset by growth in International and Personal Lines Rescue and other.
 
 
57

 

Direct Line Group (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Operating profit of £135 million was £51 million, 61% higher, reflecting lower expenses, and the benefit of releases of reserves from prior years across most products. This was partially offset by lower investment income.
   
·
Gross written premium of £996 million was £50 million, 5% lower primarily due to seasonality on the International book where a significant proportion of the business is written on 1 January each year.
   
·
Total income of £934 million was £32 million, 3%, lower, primarily driven by reduced earned premium on International and higher commissions payable on business previously reported within Non-Core.
   
·
Net claims fell by £73 million, 11%, to £576 million, largely reflecting reserve releases from prior years.
   
·
Total direct expenses of £162 million were £8 million, 5%, lower, predominantly due to higher marketing expenditure in Q1 2012.
   
·
Investment income of £73 million declined by £17 million, 19%, mainly as a result of lower yields combined with interest on the Tier 2 debt issued in April 2012.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Operating profit of £135 million was £4 million, 3%, lower compared with Q2 2011 as Q2 2012 included claims for adverse weather of £40 million more than expected.
   
·
Gross written premium declined by £38 million, 4%, due to the impact of de-risking in Motor during 2011 and competitive market conditions.
   
·
Total income decreased by £112 million, 11%, to £934 million, as a result of lower earned premiums following a managed reduction in volumes on Motor and run-off of personal lines Broker, together with higher commissions payable relating to business previously reported within Non-Core.
   
·
Net claims fell £128 million, 18%, as a result of reduced exposure, particularly on Motor, together with prior year reserve releases. Home was affected by adverse weather experienced in the quarter compared with benign conditions experienced during Q2 2011.
   
·
Total direct expenses increased by £13 million, 9%, as a result of increased head office expenses in preparation for separation from RBS Group.
   
·
Investment income increased by £4 million, 6%, as a result of investment gains arising from portfolio management initiatives, including those relating to the business previously reported in Non-Core. These gains were largely offset by lower investment yields in 2012 and interest associated with the Tier 2 debt issued in April 2012.
 
 
58

 

Central items

 
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Central items not allocated
(176)
24 
 
(32)
(144)
56 

Note:
(1)
Costs/charges are denoted by brackets.

Funding and operating costs have been allocated to operating divisions based on direct service usage, the requirement for market funding and other appropriate drivers where services span more than one division.

Residual unallocated items relate to volatile corporate items that do not naturally reside within a division.

Key points

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Central items not allocated represented a debit of £176 million, a deterioration of £200 million compared with H1 2011.
   
·
The movement was driven in part by a £125 million provision, taken in Q2 2012, for costs relating to the technology incident that affected the Group’s systems in June 2012. The provision is principally to cover customer redress. A break down of the provision by division is provided on the next page.
   
·
A provision of £50 million has also been recognised for redress in respect of interest rate hedging products. This follows the agreement reached with the FSA in June 2012 by a number of banks, including the Group, to carry out a review of sales of interest rate hedging products since 1 December 2001 to small and medium sized customers.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
Central items not allocated represented a debit of £32 million, an improvement of £112 million compared with Q1 2012.
   
·
The movement was due to increased available-for-sale bond disposals and unallocated volatility costs in Group Treasury, partially offset by the £125 million provision for the costs of redress following the technology incident.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
Central items not allocated represented a debit of £32 million, a deterioration of £88 million compared with Q2 2011.
   
·
The movement was driven primarily by the £125 million provision for the technology incident in Q2 2012, and the provision for redress partially offset by unallocated volatility costs in Group Treasury.
 
 
59

 
 
Central items (continued)

Technology incident - costs of redress
The following table provides an analysis by division of the estimated costs of redress following the technology incident in June 2012. These costs are included in Central items above and include waiver of interest and other charges together with other compensation payments all of which are reported in expenses. Additional costs may arise once all redress and business disruption items are clear and a further update will be given in Q3.

 
Total 
 
£m 
   
UK Retail
35 
UK Corporate
36 
International Banking
21 
Ulster Bank
28 
Group Centre
5 
   
 
125 
 
 
 
60

 
Non-Core

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
23 
315 
 
10 
13 
169 
Funding costs of rental assets
89 
105 
 
38 
51 
52 
             
Net interest income
112 
420 
 
48 
64 
221 
             
Net fees and commissions
60 
93 
 
29 
31 
46 
(Loss)/income from trading activities
(403)
(64)
 
(133)
(270)
232 
Insurance net premium income
233 
 
95 
Other operating income
           
  - rental income
392 
500 
 
173 
219 
257 
  - other (1)
109 
219 
 
(116)
225 
115 
             
Non-interest income/(loss)
158 
981 
 
(47)
205 
745 
             
Total income
270 
1,401 
 
269 
966 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(151)
(200)
 
(80)
(71)
(109)
  - operating lease depreciation
(152)
(174)
 
(69)
(83)
(87)
  - other
(87)
(137)
 
(46)
(41)
(68)
Indirect expenses
(135)
(147)
 
(67)
(68)
(71)
             
 
(525)
(658)
 
(262)
(263)
(335)
             
(Loss)/profit before insurance net claims and impairment losses
(255)
743 
 
(261)
631 
Insurance net claims
(218)
 
(90)
Impairment losses
(1,096)
(2,486)
 
(607)
(489)
(1,411)
             
Operating loss
(1,351)
(1,961)
 
(868)
(483)
(870)

Note:
(1)
Includes gains/(losses) on disposals (H1 2012 - £143 million gain; H1 2011 - £54 million loss; Q2 2012 - £39 million loss; Q1 2012 - £182 million gain; Q2 2011 - £20 million loss).
 
 
61

 

 
Non-Core (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Analysis of income/(loss) by business
           
Banking and portfolios
60 
1,374 
 
(117)
177 
818 
International businesses
161 
218 
 
76 
85 
137 
Markets
49 
(191)
 
42 
11 
             
Total income
270 
1,401 
 
269 
966 
             
(Loss)/income from trading activities
           
Monoline exposures
(191)
(197)
 
(63)
(128)
(67)
Credit derivative product companies
(7)
(61)
 
31 
(38)
(21)
Asset-backed products (1)
68 
102 
 
37 
31 
36 
Other credit exotics
(49)
(160)
 
(69)
20 
Equities
(1)
 
(1)
(2)
Banking book hedges
(22)
(38)
 
(22)
(9)
Other
(204)
291 
 
(50)
(154)
287 
             
 
(403)
(64)
 
(133)
(270)
232 
             
Impairment losses
           
Banking and portfolios
1,190 
2,463 
 
706 
484 
1,405 
International businesses
25 
35 
 
14 
11 
15 
Markets
(119)
(12)
 
(113)
(6)
(9)
             
Total impairment losses
1,096 
2,486 
 
607 
489 
1,411 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross customer loans and advances (excluding reverse repurchase agreements) (2)
           
Banking and portfolios
3.6% 
5.3% 
 
4.2% 
2.8% 
6.1% 
International businesses
3.0% 
2.3% 
 
3.4% 
2.1% 
1.9% 
Markets
(2.6%)
(0.7%)
 
(4.4%)
(0.8%)
(1.2%)
             
Total
3.6% 
5.2% 
 
4.2% 
2.7% 
6.0% 

Notes:
(1)
Asset-backed products include super senior asset-backed structures and other asset-backed products.
(2)
Includes disposal groups.
 
 
62

 

 
Non-Core (continued)

Key metrics
 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Performance ratios
           
Net interest margin
0.28% 
0.77% 
 
0.24% 
0.31% 
0.83% 
Cost:income ratio
194% 
47% 
 
nm 
98% 
35% 
Adjusted cost:income ratio
194% 
56% 
 
nm 
98% 
38% 

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
   
31 December 
2011 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets (excluding derivatives) (1)
72.1 
83.3 
(13%)
 
93.7 
(23%)
Total third party assets (including derivatives)
80.6 
91.8 
(12%)
 
104.7 
(23%)
Loans and advances to customers (gross) (2)
67.7 
72.7 
(7%)
 
79.4 
(15%)
Customer deposits (2)
2.9 
3.1 
(6%)
 
3.5 
(17%)
Risk elements in lending (2)
23.1 
23.5 
(2%)
 
24.0 
(4%)
Risk-weighted assets (1)
82.7 
89.9 
(8%)
 
93.3 
(11%)

nm = not meaningful

Notes:
(1)
Includes RBS Sempra Commodities JV (30 June 2012 third party assets, excluding derivatives (TPAs) nil, RWAs £1.0 billion, 31 March 2012 TPAs nil, RWAs £1.0 billion, 31 December 2011 TPAs £0.1 billion, RWAs £2.4 billion).
(2)
Excludes disposal groups.


 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Gross customer loans and advances
     
Banking and portfolios
66.3 
70.8 
77.3 
International businesses
1.4 
1.9 
2.0 
Markets
0.1 
       
 
67.7 
72.7 
79.4 
       
Risk-weighted assets
     
Banking and portfolios
64.4 
66.1 
64.8 
International businesses
2.9 
3.8 
4.1 
Markets
15.4 
20.0 
24.4 
       
 
82.7 
89.9 
93.3 
       
Third party assets (excluding derivatives)
     
Banking and portfolios
63.5 
73.2 
81.3 
International businesses
2.2 
2.7 
2.9 
Markets
6.4 
7.4 
9.5 
       
 
72.1 
83.3 
93.7 
 
 
63

 

Non-Core (continued)

Third party assets (excluding derivatives)

 
31 March 
2012 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
30 June 
2012 
Quarter ended 30 June 2012
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
29.1 
(1.2)
(0.2)
(0.4)
(0.4)
26.9 
Corporate
40.1 
(1.7)
(5.9)
0.5 
(0.2)
32.8 
SME
1.9 
(0.3)
(0.1)
0.1 
1.6 
Retail
4.2 
(0.3)
0.1 
(0.1)
0.1 
4.0 
Other
0.6 
(0.2)
0.4 
Markets
7.4 
(0.7)
(0.5)
0.1 
0.1 
6.4 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
83.3 
(4.4)
(6.7)
0.7 
(0.6)
(0.2)
72.1 


 
31 December 
2011 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
31 March 
2012 
Quarter ended 31 March 2012
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
31.5 
(1.5)
(0.4)
0.1 
(0.4)
(0.2)
29.1 
Corporate
42.2 
(0.8)
(1.1)
0.4 
(0.1)
(0.5)
40.1 
SME
2.1 
(0.3)
0.1 
1.9 
Retail
6.1 
(0.2)
(1.6)
(0.1)
4.2 
Other
1.9 
(1.2)
(0.1)
0.6 
Markets
9.8 
(0.2)
(2.1)
0.1 
(0.2)
7.4 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
93.6 
(4.2)
(5.2)
0.7 
(0.5)
(1.1)
83.3 
Markets - RBS Sempra Commodities JV
0.1 
(0.1)
               
Total (1)
93.7 
(4.3)
(5.2)
0.7 
(0.5)
(1.1)
83.3 


 
31 March 
2011 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
30 June 
2011 
Quarter ended 30 June 2011
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
38.7 
(1.1)
(0.3)
0.2 
(1.3)
0.4 
36.6 
Corporate
56.0 
(2.6)
(4.0)
0.6 
0.4 
50.4 
SME
3.1 
(0.4)
2.7 
Retail
8.3 
(0.2)
(0.1)
8.0 
Other
2.5 
(0.2)
2.3 
Markets
12.3 
(0.7)
(0.4)
0.3 
11.5 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
120.9 
(5.2)
(4.7)
1.1 
(1.4)
0.8 
111.5 
Markets - RBS Sempra Commodities JV
3.9 
(0.5)
(2.2)
(0.1)
1.1 
               
Total (1)
124.8 
(5.7)
(6.9)
1.1 
(1.4)
0.7 
112.6 

Note:
(1)
No disposals have been signed as at 30 June 2012 (31 March 2012 - £5 billion; 30 June 2011 - £2 billion).
 
 
64

 

 
Non-Core (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Impairment losses by donating division
  and sector
           
             
UK Retail
           
Mortgages
 
Personal
 
             
Total UK Retail
 
             
UK Corporate
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
14 
47 
 
47 
Property and construction
78 
49 
 
23 
55 
36 
Transport
14 
46 
 
16 
(2)
26 
Financial institutions
(2)
 
(3)
Lombard
22 
43 
 
12 
10 
25 
Other
17 
57 
 
11 
46 
             
Total UK Corporate
143 
246 
 
66 
77 
181 
             
Ulster Bank
           
Commercial real estate
           
  - investment
136 
384 
 
52 
84 
161 
  - development
262 
1,313 
 
120 
142 
810 
Other corporate
51 
113 
 
17 
34 
Other EMEA
11 
 
             
Total Ulster Bank
455 
1,821 
 
191 
264 
982 
             
US Retail & Commercial
           
Auto and consumer
20 
37 
 
11 
12 
Cards
(10)
 
(1)
(3)
SBO/home equity
62 
111 
 
44 
18 
58 
Residential mortgages
10 
 
Commercial real estate
(1)
30 
 
(3)
11 
Commercial and other
(7)
(9)
 
(3)
(4)
(6)
             
Total US Retail & Commercial
85 
169 
 
57 
28 
78 
             
International Banking
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
(8)
 
(1)
(6)
Property and construction
322 
322 
 
236 
86 
217 
Transport
147 
(7)
 
134 
13 
(1)
Telecoms, media and technology
27 
23 
 
11 
16 
34 
Banks and financial institutions
(114)
(38)
 
(102)
(12)
(39)
Other
23 
(47)
 
14 
(39)
             
Total International Banking
410 
245 
 
292 
118 
166 
             
Other
           
Wealth
 
(1)
(1)
Central items
 
(1)
             
Total Other
 
             
Total impairment losses
1,096 
2,486 
 
607 
489 
1,411 
 
 
 
65

 

 
Non-Core (continued)

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Gross loans and advances to customers (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) by donating division and sector
     
       
UK Retail
     
Mortgages
1.4 
Personal
0.1 
0.1 
0.1 
       
Total UK Retail
0.1 
0.1 
1.5 
       
UK Corporate
     
Manufacturing and infrastructure
0.1 
0.1 
0.1 
Property and construction
4.3 
4.8 
5.9 
Transport
4.1 
4.3 
4.5 
Financial institutions
0.6 
0.6 
0.6 
Lombard
0.7 
0.9 
1.0 
Other
6.9 
7.0 
7.5 
       
Total UK Corporate
16.7 
17.7 
19.6 
       
Ulster Bank
     
Commercial real estate
     
  - investment
3.7 
3.7 
3.9 
  - development
7.7 
8.0 
8.5 
Other corporate
1.6 
1.7 
1.6 
Other EMEA
0.4 
0.4 
0.4 
       
Total Ulster Bank
13.4 
13.8 
14.4 
       
US Retail & Commercial
     
Auto and consumer
0.6 
0.8 
0.8 
Cards
0.1 
0.1 
0.1 
SBO/home equity
2.3 
2.4 
2.5 
Residential mortgages
0.5 
0.5 
0.6 
Commercial real estate
0.7 
0.9 
1.0 
Commercial and other
0.2 
0.4 
       
Total US Retail & Commercial
4.4 
4.7 
5.4 
       
International Banking
     
Manufacturing and infrastructure
5.4 
5.8 
6.6 
Property and construction
14.3 
15.4 
15.3 
Transport
2.0 
2.4 
3.2 
Telecoms, media and technology
0.7 
0.7 
0.7 
Banks and financial institutions
5.3 
5.7 
5.6 
Other
5.4 
6.4 
7.0 
       
Total International Banking
33.1 
36.4 
38.4 
       
Other
     
Wealth
0.2 
0.2 
0.2 
Central items
(0.2)
(0.3)
(0.2)
       
Total Other
(0.1)
       
Gross loans and advances to customers (excluding reverse repurchase agreements)
67.7 
72.6 
79.3 
 
 
66

 

 
Non-Core (continued)

Key points
Non-Core continues to make significant progress towards exiting approximately 85% of the portfolio by the end of 2013. In Q2 2012 third party assets fell to £72 billion, a reduction of £11 billion during the quarter and an overall reduction to date of 72%. The successful completion of the disposal of the RBS Aviation Capital business contributed c£5 billion of the Q2 2012 reduction and c£2 billion of the risk-weighted asset reduction.

Risk-weighted assets were reduced by £7 billion during Q2 2012 as the division continued to focus on run-off, disposals and reducing exposure to capital intensive positions.

H1 2012 compared with H1 2011
·
Third party assets of £72 billion were £41 billion lower than H1 2011 reflecting disposals of £22 billion and run-off of £17 billion.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets decreased by £42 billion principally reflecting the restructuring on monoline exposures in 2011, totalling £17 billion, and associated market risk reductions of £7 billion. Sales and run-off reduced risk-weighted assets by a further £16 billion.
   
·
Non-Core operating loss decreased from £1,961 million in H1 2011 to £1,351 million in H1 2012. Lower impairments and costs were partially offset by a fall in income.
   
·
Impairments in H1 2012 of £1,096 million were £1,390 million favourable to H1 2011, reflecting substantial provisioning in respect of development land values in the Ulster Bank portfolio during the first half of 2011.
   
·
Costs fell by £133 million as the division continued to contract and headcount reduced. At the end of H1 2012, headcount totalled approximately 3,800, a decrease of 40% since June 2011.
   
·
Income declined by £1,131 million with continued run-down of the balance sheet reducing income streams by £654 million. H1 2011 included gains on a number of securities arising from restructured assets totalling approximately £500 million, not repeated in H1 2012.

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012
·
An operating loss of £868 million in Q2 2012 was £385 million higher than the previous quarter.
   
·
Trading losses in Q2 2012 were £137 million favourable to Q1 2012 as significant losses on disposal of trading positions in the first quarter were not repeated. This was partially offset by higher dealing losses as market conditions deteriorated.
   
·
Other income decreased by £341 million in Q2 2012 due to negative equity valuation movements of £147 million as well as losses on disposal of £39 million compared with gains of £182 million in Q1 2012.
   
·
Impairment losses increased by £118 million during Q2 2012 largely reflecting one significant provision within the Project Finance portfolio.
 
 
67

 

Non-Core (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q2 2012 compared with Q1 2012 (continued)
·
Third party assets fell by £11 billion to £72 billion in Q2 2012 reflecting disposals of £7 billion and run-off of £4 billion.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets decreased by £7 billion resulting from sales and run-off of £6 billion, market risk movements of £2 billion and the £2 billion impact of derivative restructuring. These reductions were partially offset by adverse foreign exchange and mark-to-market movements of £2 billion and credit model changes.

Q2 2012 compared with Q2 2011
·
The Q2 2012 operating loss of £868 million was broadly flat. Impairment losses fell significantly compared with Q2 2011, driven by a £789 million decrease in charges in relation to the Ulster Bank portfolio. Costs were £73 million lower as the division continued to run down and headcount reduces.
   
·
Income declined by £965 million as continuing run-off and disposal activity reduced revenue streams by £355 million. Trading revenues and other income in Q2 2011 included gains on a number of securities arising from restructured assets, totalling approximately £500 million.
 
 
 
68

 
 
Condensed consolidated income statement
for the period ended 30 June 2012


 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Interest receivable
9,791 
10,805 
 
4,774 
5,017 
5,404 
Interest payable
(3,821)
(4,277)
 
(1,803)
(2,018)
(2,177)
             
Net interest income
5,970 
6,528 
 
2,971 
2,999 
3,227 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
2,937 
3,342 
 
1,450 
1,487 
1,700 
Fees and commissions payable
(604)
(583)
 
(314)
(290)
(323)
Income from trading activities
869 
1,982 
 
657 
212 
1,147 
Gain on redemption of own debt
577 
255 
 
577 
255 
Other operating income (excluding insurance net
  premium income)
(353)
1,533 
 
394 
(747)
1,142 
Insurance net premium income
1,867 
2,239 
 
929 
938 
1,090 
             
Non-interest income
5,293 
8,768 
 
3,116 
2,177 
5,011 
             
Total income
11,263 
15,296 
 
6,087 
5,176 
8,238 
             
Staff costs
(4,713)
(4,609)
 
(2,143)
(2,570)
(2,210)
Premises and equipment
(1,107)
(1,173)
 
(544)
(563)
(602)
Other administrative expenses
(2,172)
(2,673)
 
(1,156)
(1,016)
(1,752)
Depreciation and amortisation
(902)
(877)
 
(434)
(468)
(453)
             
Operating expenses
(8,894)
(9,332)
 
(4,277)
(4,617)
(5,017)
             
Profit before insurance net claims and
  impairment losses
2,369 
5,964 
 
1,810 
559 
3,221 
Insurance net claims
(1,225)
(1,705)
 
(576)
(649)
(793)
Impairment losses
(2,649)
(5,053)
 
(1,335)
(1,314)
(3,106)
             
Operating loss before tax
(1,505)
(794)
 
(101)
(1,404)
(678)
Tax charge
(429)
(645)
 
(290)
(139)
(222)
             
Loss from continuing operations
(1,934)
(1,439)
 
(391)
(1,543)
(900)
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
31 
 
(4)
21 
             
Loss for the period
(1,933)
(1,408)
 
(395)
(1,538)
(879)
Non-controlling interests
19 
(17)
 
14 
(18)
Preference share and other dividends
(76)
 
(76)
             
Loss attributable to ordinary and B shareholders
(1,990)
(1,425)
 
(466)
(1,524)
(897)
             
Basic and diluted loss per ordinary and B share from
  continuing operations (1)
(18.2p)
(13.2p)
 
(4.2p)
(14.0p)
(8.3p)
             
Basic and diluted loss per ordinary and B share from
  discontinued operations (1)
 

Note:
(1)
Prior periods have been adjusted for the sub-division and one-for-ten ordinary share consolidation of ordinary shares.
 

 
 
69

 
Condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income
for the period ended 30 June 2012

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Loss for the period
(1,933)
(1,408)
 
(395)
(1,538)
(879)
             
Other comprehensive income
           
Available-for-sale financial assets
591 
1,369 
 
66 
525 
1,406 
Cash flow hedges
695 
361 
 
662 
33 
588 
Currency translation
(496)
(301)
 
58 
(554)
59 
             
Other comprehensive income before tax
790 
1,429 
 
786 
2,053 
Tax charge
(256)
(492)
 
(237)
(19)
(524)
             
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
  after tax
534 
937 
 
549 
(15)
1,529 
             
Total comprehensive (loss)/income for
  the period
(1,399)
(471)
 
154 
(1,553)
650 
             
Total comprehensive (loss)/income is
  attributable to:
           
Non-controlling interests
(13)
(6)
 
(10)
(3)
Ordinary and B shareholders
(1,386)
(465)
 
164 
(1,550)
647 
             
 
(1,399)
(471)
 
154 
(1,553)
650 

Key points
·
The movement in available-for-sale financial assets reflects net unrealised gains on high quality sovereign bonds.
   
·
Cash flow hedging gains largely result from reductions in swap rates with significant movements during the second quarter of 2012.
   
·
Currency translation losses during the half year largely result from the strengthening of Sterling against both the Euro, by 3.5%, and the US Dollar, by 1.4%. Movements in Q2 2012 reflect the weakening of Sterling against the US Dollar by 1.9%, partially offset by a 3.2% strengthening of Sterling against the Euro.
 
 
 
70

 
Condensed consolidated balance sheet
at 30 June 2012

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Assets
     
Cash and balances at central banks
78,647 
82,363 
79,269 
Net loans and advances to banks
39,436 
36,064 
43,870 
Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing
37,705 
34,626 
39,440 
Loans and advances to banks
77,141 
70,690 
83,310 
Net loans and advances to customers
434,965 
440,406 
454,112 
Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing
60,196 
56,503 
61,494 
Loans and advances to customers
495,161 
496,909 
515,606 
Debt securities
187,626 
195,931 
209,080 
Equity shares
13,091 
17,603 
15,183 
Settlement balances
15,312 
20,970 
7,771 
Derivatives
486,432 
453,354 
529,618 
Intangible assets
14,888 
14,771 
14,858 
Property, plant and equipment
11,337 
11,442 
11,868 
Deferred tax
3,502 
3,849 
3,878 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
10,983 
10,079 
10,976 
Assets of disposal groups
21,069 
25,060 
25,450 
       
Total assets
1,415,189 
1,403,021 
1,506,867 
       
Liabilities
     
Bank deposits
67,619 
65,735 
69,113 
Repurchase agreements and stock lending
39,125 
41,415 
39,691 
Deposits by banks
106,744 
107,150 
108,804 
Customer deposits
412,769 
410,207 
414,143 
Repurchase agreements and stock lending
88,950 
87,303 
88,812 
Customer accounts
501,719 
497,510 
502,955 
Debt securities in issue
119,855 
142,943 
162,621 
Settlement balances
15,126 
17,597 
7,477 
Short positions
38,376 
37,322 
41,039 
Derivatives
480,745 
446,534 
523,983 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
18,820 
20,278 
23,125 
Retirement benefit liabilities
1,791 
1,840 
2,239 
Deferred tax
1,815 
1,788 
1,945 
Insurance liabilities
6,322 
6,251 
6,312 
Subordinated liabilities
25,596 
25,513 
26,319 
Liabilities of disposal groups
23,064 
23,664 
23,995 
       
Total liabilities
1,339,973 
1,328,390 
1,430,814 
       
Equity
     
Non-controlling interests
1,200 
1,215 
1,234 
Owners’ equity*
     
  Called up share capital
6,528 
15,397 
15,318 
  Reserves
67,488 
58,019 
59,501 
       
Total equity
75,216 
74,631 
76,053 
       
Total liabilities and equity
1,415,189 
1,403,021 
1,506,867 
       
* Owners’ equity attributable to:
     
Ordinary and B shareholders
69,272 
68,672 
70,075 
Other equity owners
4,744 
4,744 
4,744 
       
 
74,016 
73,416 
74,819 
 

 
 
71

 
Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet

30 June 2012 compared with 31 December 2011

Key points
·
Total assets of £1,415.2 billion at 30 June 2012 were down £91.7 billion, 6%, compared with 31 December 2011. This was principally driven by the Group’s programme of deleveraging and reducing capital intensive assets, including Non-Core disposals and run-off, and the reduction in the mark-to-market value of derivatives.
   
·
Loans and advances to banks decreased by £6.2 billion, 7%, to £77.1 billion. Excluding reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing (‘reverse repos’), down £1.8 billion, 4%, to £37.7 billion, bank placings declined £4.4 billion, 10%, to £39.4 billion.
   
·
Loans and advances to customers declined £20.4 billion, 4%, to £495.2 billion. Within this, reverse repurchase agreements were down £1.3 billion, 2%, to £60.2 billion. Customer lending decreased by £19.1 billion, 4%, to £435.0 billion, or £18.7 billion to £455.1 billion before impairments. This reflected planned reductions in Non-Core of £10.6 billion, along with declines in International Banking, £6.8 billion, Markets, £0.6 billion, UK Corporate, £0.5 billion and Ulster Bank, £0.2 billion, together with the effect of exchange rate and other movements, £3.6 billion. These were partially offset by growth in UK Retail, £2.2 billion, US Retail & Commercial, £1.3 billion and Wealth, £0.1 billion.
   
·
Debt securities were down £21.5 billion, 10%, to £187.6 billion, driven mainly by a reduction in Eurozone government and financial institution bonds within Markets and Group Treasury.
   
·
Settlement balance assets and liabilities increased £7.5 billion to £15.3 billion and £7.6 billion to £15.1 billion respectively as a result of increased customer activity from seasonal year-end lows.
   
·
Movements in the value of derivative assets, down £43.2 billion, 8%, to £486.4 billion, and liabilities, down £43.2 billion, 8%, to £480.7 billion, primarily reflect decreases in interest rate and credit derivative contracts, together with the effect of currency movements, with Sterling strengthening against both the US dollar and the Euro.
   
·
The reduction in assets and liabilities of disposal groups, down £4.4 billion, 17%, to £21.1 billion, and £0.9 billion, 4%, to £23.1 billion respectively, primarily reflects the disposal of RBS Aviation Capital in the second quarter.
   
·
Deposits by banks decreased £2.1 billion, 2%, to £106.7 billion, with a reduction in repurchase agreements and stock lending (‘repos’), down £0.6 billion, 1%, to £39.1 billion and a decrease in inter-bank deposits, down £1.5 billion, 2%, to £67.6 billion.
   
·
Customer accounts decreased £1.2 billion to £501.7 billion. Within this, repos were broadly flat at £88.9 billion. Excluding repos, customer deposits were down £1.4 billion at £412.8 billion, reflecting decreases in International Banking, £2.2 billion, Markets, £1.9 billion, Non-Core, £0.7 billion and Ulster Bank, £0.6 billion, together with exchange and other movements, £2.2 billion. This was partially offset by increases in UK Retail, £4.8 billion, UK Corporate, £1.1 billion and Wealth, £0.3 billion.

 
72

 
Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet (continued)

·
Debt securities in issue decreased £42.8 billion, 26%, to £119.9 billion reflecting the maturity of the remaining notes issued under the UK Government’s Credit Guarantee Scheme, £21.3 billion, and the reduction of commercial paper and medium term notes in issue in line with the Group’s strategy.
   
·
Subordinated liabilities decreased by £0.7 billion, 3%, to £25.6 billion, primarily reflecting the net decrease in dated loan capital as a result of the liability management exercise completed in March 2012, with redemptions of £3.4 billion offset by the issuance of £2.8 billion new loan capital, together with exchange rate movements and other adjustments of £0.1 billion.
   
·
Owners’ equity decreased by £0.8 billion, 1%, to £74.0 billion, due to the £1.9 billion attributable loss for the period together with movements in foreign exchange reserves, £0.5 billion and other reserve movements of £0.1 billion. Partially offsetting these reductions were positive movements in available-for-sale reserves, £0.5 billion and cash flow hedging reserves, £0.5 billion and share capital and reserve movements in respect of employee benefits, £0.7 billion.

 
73

 
Average balance sheet

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
 
 
           
Average yields, spreads and margins of the banking
  business
         
Gross yield on interest-earning assets of banking business
3.14 
3.31 
 
3.14 
3.15 
Cost of interest-bearing liabilities of banking business
(1.58)
(1.63)
 
(1.53)
(1.62)
           
Interest spread of banking business
1.56 
1.68 
 
1.61 
1.53 
Benefit from interest-free funds
0.36 
0.32 
 
0.34 
0.35 
           
Net interest margin of banking business
1.92 
2.00 
 
1.95 
1.88 
           
           
Average interest rates
         
The Group's base rate
0.50 
0.50 
 
0.50 
0.50 
           
London inter-bank three month offered rates
         
  - Sterling
1.02 
0.81 
 
0.99 
1.06 
  - Eurodollar
0.49 
0.29 
 
0.47 
0.51 
  - Euro
0.79 
1.20 
 
0.61 
0.97 

 
74

 
Average balance sheet (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
Average 
     
Average 
   
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Assets
             
Loans and advances to banks
82,588 
282 
0.69 
 
65,627 
336 
1.03 
Loans and advances to
  customers
439,342 
8,369 
3.83 
 
471,729 
9,128 
3.90 
Debt securities
104,465 
1,140 
2.19 
 
121,531 
1,341 
2.23 
               
Interest-earning assets -
  banking business
626,395 
9,791 
3.14 
 
658,887 
10,805 
3.31 
               
Trading business (1)
246,256 
     
281,771 
   
Non-interest earning assets
619,373 
     
533,667 
   
               
Total assets
1,492,024 
     
1,474,325 
   
               
               
Liabilities
             
Deposits by banks
43,040 
347 
1.62 
 
66,283 
508 
1.55 
Customer accounts
329,197 
1,784 
1.09 
 
328,352 
1,684 
1.03 
Debt securities in issue
100,612 
1,209 
2.42 
 
162,980 
1,680 
2.08 
Subordinated liabilities
21,472 
415 
3.89 
 
22,235 
375 
3.40 
Internal funding of trading
  business
(6,884)
66 
(1.93)
 
(51,811)
30 
(0.12)
               
Interest-bearing liabilities -
  banking business
487,437 
3,821 
1.58 
 
528,039 
4,277 
1.63 
               
Trading business (1)
257,343 
     
307,926 
   
Non-interest-bearing liabilities
             
  - demand deposits
74,088 
     
64,256 
   
  - other liabilities
599,195 
     
499,745 
   
Owners’ equity
73,961 
     
74,359 
   
               
Total liabilities and
  owners’ equity
1,492,024 
     
1,474,325 
   

Note:
(1)
Interest receivable and interest payable on trading assets and liabilities are included in income from trading activities.

 
75

 
Average balance sheet (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
Average 
     
Average 
   
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Assets
             
Loans and advances to banks
78,151 
134 
0.69 
 
87,025 
148 
0.68 
Loans and advances to
  customers
435,270 
4,117 
3.80 
 
443,414 
4,252 
3.86 
Debt securities
98,711 
523 
2.13 
 
110,219 
617 
2.25 
               
Interest-earning assets -
  banking business
612,132 
4,774 
3.14 
 
640,658 
5,017 
3.15 
               
Trading business (1)
241,431 
     
251,081 
   
Non-interest earning assets
604,751 
     
633,995 
   
               
Total assets
1,458,314 
     
1,525,734 
   
               
               
Liabilities
             
Deposits by banks
41,608 
156 
1.51 
 
44,472 
191 
1.73 
Customer accounts
330,952 
870 
1.06 
 
327,442 
914 
1.12 
Debt securities in issue
88,770 
511 
2.32 
 
112,454 
698 
2.50 
Subordinated liabilities
21,308 
225 
4.25 
 
21,636 
190 
3.53 
Internal funding of trading
  business
(7,336)
41 
(2.25)
 
(6,432)
25 
(1.56)
               
Interest-bearing liabilities -
  banking business
475,302 
1,803 
1.53 
 
499,572 
2,018 
1.62 
               
Trading business (1)
252,639 
     
262,047 
   
Non-interest-bearing liabilities
             
  - demand deposits
75,806 
     
72,370 
   
  - other liabilities
580,445 
     
617,945 
   
Owners’ equity
74,122 
     
73,800 
   
               
Total liabilities and
  owners’ equity
1,458,314 
     
1,525,734 
   

Note:
(1)
Interest receivable and interest payable on trading assets and liabilities are included in income from trading activities.
 
 
 
76

 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the period ended 30 June 2012

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Called-up share capital
           
At beginning of period
15,318 
15,125 
 
15,397 
15,318 
15,156 
Ordinary shares issued
143 
192 
 
64 
79 
161 
Share capital sub-division and consolidation
(8,933)
 
(8,933)
             
At end of period
6,528 
15,317 
 
6,528 
15,397 
15,317 
             
Paid-in equity
           
At beginning and end of period
431 
431 
 
431 
431 
431 
             
Share premium account
           
At beginning of period
24,001 
23,922 
 
24,027 
24,001 
23,922 
Ordinary shares issued
197 
 
171 
26 
             
At end of period
24,198 
23,923 
 
24,198 
24,027 
23,923 
             
Merger reserve
           
At beginning of period
13,222 
13,272 
 
13,222 
13,222 
13,272 
Transfer to retained earnings
(50)
 
-
(50)
             
At end of period
13,222 
13,222 
 
13,222 
13,222 
13,222 
             
Available-for-sale reserve (1)
           
At beginning of period
(957)
(2,037)
 
(439)
(957)
(2,063)
Net unrealised gains
1,152 
943 
 
428 
724 
781 
Realised (gains)/losses
(582)
429 
 
(370)
(212)
626 
Tax
(63)
(361)
 
(69)
(370)
             
At end of period
(450)
(1,026)
 
(450)
(439)
(1,026)
             
Cash flow hedging reserve
           
At beginning of period
879 
(140)
 
921 
879 
(314)
Amount recognised in equity
1,218 
825 
 
928 
290 
811 
Amount transferred from equity to earnings
(523)
(464)
 
(266)
(257)
(223)
Tax
(175)
(108)
 
(184)
(161)
             
At end of period
1,399 
113 
 
1,399 
921 
113 

Note:
(1)
Analysis provided on page 112.
 
 
 
77

 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the period ended 30 June 2012 (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Foreign exchange reserve
           
At beginning of period
4,775 
5,138 
 
4,227 
4,775 
4,754 
Retranslation of net assets
(566)
(240)
 
82 
(648)
189 
Foreign currency gains/(losses) on hedges
  of net assets
88 
(40)
 
(8)
96 
(116)
Tax
20 
(24)
 
16 
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
  business (nil tax)
(3)
 
(3)
             
At end of period
4,314 
4,834 
 
4,314 
4,227 
4,834 
             
Capital redemption reserve
           
At beginning of period
198 
198 
 
198 
198 
198 
Share capital sub-division and consolidation
8,933 
 
8,933 
             
At end of period
9,131 
198 
 
9,131 
198 
198 
             
Contingent capital reserve
           
At beginning and end of period
(1,208)
(1,208)
 
(1,208)
(1,208)
(1,208)
             
Retained earnings
           
At beginning of period
18,929 
21,239 
 
17,405 
18,929 
20,713 
(Loss)/profit attributable to ordinary and B
  shareholders and other equity owners
           
  - continuing operations
(1,911)
(1,429)
 
(387)
(1,524)
(899)
  - discontinued operations
(3)
 
(3)
Transfer from merger reserve
50 
 
50 
Equity preference dividends paid
(76)
 
(76)
Actuarial losses recognised in retirement
  benefit schemes
           
  - tax
(38)
 
(38)
Loss on disposal of own shares held
(196)
 
(196)
Shares released for employee benefits
(129)
(207)
 
(116)
(13)
(166)
Share-based payments
           
  - gross
92 
67 
 
47 
45 
29 
  - tax
(11)
 
(17)
(3)
             
At end of period
16,657 
19,726 
 
16,657 
17,405 
19,726 
 
 
 
78

 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the period ended 30 June 2012 (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Own shares held
           
At beginning of period
(769)
(808)
 
(765)
(769)
(785)
Disposal/(purchase) of own shares
449 
 
451 
(2)
(6)
Shares released for employee benefits
114 
16 
 
108 
             
At end of period
(206)
(786)
 
(206)
(765)
(786)
             
Owners’ equity at end of period
74,016 
74,744 
 
74,016 
73,416 
74,744 
             
Non-controlling interests
           
At beginning of period
1,234 
1,719 
 
1,215 
1,234 
1,710 
Currency translation adjustments and other
  movements
(15)
(21)
 
(13)
(2)
(14)
(Loss)/profit attributable to non-controlling
  interests
           
  - continuing operations
(23)
(10)
 
(4)
(19)
(1)
  - discontinued operations
27 
 
(1)
19 
Dividends paid
(6)
(39)
 
(6)
(39)
Movements in available-for-sale securities
           
  - unrealised gains/(losses)
 
(4)
(1)
  - realised losses/(gains)
20 
(3)
 
17 
  - tax
 
Equity raised
 
Equity withdrawn and disposals
(16)
(176)
 
(16)
(176)
             
At end of period
1,200 
1,498 
 
1,200 
1,215 
1,498 
             
Total equity at end of period
75,216 
76,242 
 
75,216 
74,631 
76,242 
             
Total comprehensive (loss)/income
  recognised in the statement of
  changes in equity is attributable to:
           
Non-controlling interests
(13)
(6)
 
(10)
(3)
Ordinary and B shareholders
(1,386)
(465)
 
164 
(1,550)
647 
             
 
(1,399)
(471)
 
154 
(1,553)
650 
 
 
 
79

 
Condensed consolidated cash flow statement
for the period ended 30 June 2012

 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
     
Operating activities
   
Operating loss before tax
(1,505)
(794)
Operating profit before tax on discontinued operations
38 
Adjustments for non-cash items
4,969 
1,503 
     
Net cash inflow from trading activities
3,470 
747 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
(20,487)
7,595 
     
Net cash flows from operating activities before tax
(17,017)
8,342 
Income taxes paid
(90)
(90)
     
Net cash flows from operating activities
(17,107)
8,252 
     
Net cash flows from investing activities
18,697 
(4,362)
     
Net cash flows from financing activities
(40)
(1,212)
     
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
(3,108)
482 
     
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
(1,558)
3,160 
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
152,655 
152,530 
     
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
151,097 
155,690 
 
 

 
 
80

 
Notes

1. Basis of preparation
The Group’s condensed financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the Disclosure Rules and Transparency Rules of the Financial Services Authority and IAS 34 ‘Interim Financial Reporting’. They should be read in conjunction with the Group’s 2011 annual accounts which were prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards issued by the IASB and interpretations issued by the IFRS Interpretations Committee of the IASB as adopted by the EU (together IFRS). The EU has not adopted the complete text of IAS 39 'Financial Instruments:  Recognition and Measurement'; it has relaxed some of the standard's hedging requirements.  The Group has not taken advantage of this relaxation and has adopted IAS 39 as issued by the IASB; the Group's financial statements are prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB.
 
The condensed financial statements comprise the consolidated income statement, condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income, condensed consolidated balance sheet, condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity, condensed consolidated cash flow statement and related explanatory notes 1 to 19 and have been prepared in accordance with IAS 34 ‘Interim Financial Reporting’.

In line with the Group’s policy of providing users of its financial reports with relevant and transparent disclosures, it has adopted the British Bankers’ Association Code for Financial Reporting Disclosure published in September 2010. The code sets out five disclosure principles together with supporting guidance: the overarching principle being a commitment to provide high quality, meaningful and decision-useful disclosures. The Group’s 2012 interim financial statements have been prepared in compliance with the code.

The Group’s business activities and financial position, and the factors likely to affect its future development and performance are discussed on pages 6 to 133. Its objectives and policies in managing the financial risks to which it is exposed and its capital are discussed in the risk and balance sheet management sections on pages 134 to 241. A summary of the risk factors which could materially affect the Group’s future results are described on pages 242 and 243. The Group’s regulatory capital resources are set on page 138 and 139. The Group’s liquidity and funding management is described on pages 142 to 153. Having reviewed the Group’s forecasts, projections and other relevant evidence, the directors have a reasonable expectation that the Group will continue in operational existence for the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the interim financial statements for the six months ended 30 June 2012 have been prepared on a going concern basis.

 
81

 
2. Accounting policies
There have been no significant changes to the Group’s principal accounting policies as set out on pages 273 to 282 of the Group's restated annual report for the year ended December 2011 on Form 6-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on 10 August 2012 ("2011 Annual Report").

Critical accounting policies and key sources of estimation uncertainty
The reported results of the Group are sensitive to the accounting policies, assumptions and estimates that underlie the preparation of its financial statements. The judgements and assumptions that are considered to be the most important to the portrayal of Group’s financial condition are those relating to loan impairment provisions; pensions; financial instrument fair values; general insurance claims and deferred tax. These critical accounting policies and judgments are described on pages 282 to 284 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report.

Recent developments in IFRS

In May 2012, the IASB issued Annual Improvements 2009-2011 Cycle which clarified:
·
the requirements for comparative information in IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements and IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting;
·
the classification of servicing equipment in IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment;
·
the accounting for the tax effect of distributions to holders of equity instruments in IAS 32 Financial Instruments: Presentation; and
·
the requirement to disclose segmental net assets in IAS 34.

None of the amendments are effective before 1 January 2013. Earlier application is permitted. The Group is reviewing the amendments to determine their effect, if any, on the Group’s financial reporting.

 
82

 
Notes (continued)

3. Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Loans and advances to customers
8,369 
9,128 
 
4,117 
4,252 
4,535 
Loans and advances to banks
282 
336 
 
134 
148 
164 
Debt securities
1,140 
1,341 
 
523 
617 
705 
             
Interest receivable
9,791 
10,805 
 
4,774 
5,017 
5,404 
             
Customer accounts
1,784 
1,684 
 
870 
914 
853 
Deposits by banks
347 
508 
 
156 
191 
249 
Debt securities in issue
1,209 
1,680 
 
511 
698 
863 
Subordinated liabilities
415 
375 
 
225 
190 
190 
Internal funding of trading businesses
66 
30 
 
41 
25 
22 
             
Interest payable
3,821 
4,277 
 
1,803 
2,018 
2,177 
             
Net interest income
5,970 
6,528 
 
2,971 
2,999 
3,227 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
2,937 
3,342 
 
1,450 
1,487 
1,700 
Fees and commissions payable
           
  - banking
(380)
(419)
 
(201)
(179)
(238)
  - insurance related
(224)
(164)
 
(113)
(111)
(85)
             
Net fees and commissions
2,333 
2,759 
 
1,136 
1,197 
1,377 
             
Foreign exchange
435 
578 
 
210 
225 
375 
Interest rate
1,100 
651 
 
428 
672 
Credit
(893)
314 
 
(94)
(799)
562 
Other
227 
439 
 
113 
114 
208 
             
Income from trading activities
869 
1,982 
 
657 
212 
1,147 
             
Gain on redemption of own debt
577 
255 
 
577 
255 
             
Operating lease and other rental income
562 
672 
 
261 
301 
350 
Own credit adjustments
(1,694)
(66)
 
(247)
(1,447)
228 
Changes in the fair value of securities and
  other financial assets and liabilities
55 
292 
 
(26)
81 
224 
Changes in the fair value of investment
  properties
(56)
(52)
 
(88)
32 
(27)
Profit on sale of securities
482 
429 
 
259 
223 
193 
Profit on sale of property, plant and equipment
23 
22 
 
18 
11 
Profit/(loss) on sale of subsidiaries and
  associates
143 
26 
 
155 
(12)
55 
Life business losses
(6)
(5)
 
(4)
(2)
(3)
Dividend income
33 
33 
 
17 
16 
18 
Share of profits less losses of associated entities
15 
 
(4)
Other income
104 
167 
 
44 
60 
85 
             
Other operating (loss)/income
(353)
1,533 
 
394 
(747)
1,142 


 
83

 
Notes (continued)

3. Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses (continued)

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Non-interest income (excluding
  insurance net premium income)
3,426 
6,529 
 
2,187 
1,239 
3,921 
Insurance net premium income
1,867 
2,239 
 
929 
938 
1,090 
             
Total non-interest income
5,293 
8,768 
 
3,116 
2,177 
5,011 
             
Total income
11,263 
15,296 
 
6,087 
5,176 
8,238 
             
Staff costs
4,713 
4,609 
 
2,143 
2,570 
2,210 
Premises and equipment
1,107 
1,173 
 
544 
563 
602 
Other
2,172 
2,673 
 
1,156 
1,016 
1,752 
             
Administrative expenses
7,992 
8,455 
 
3,843 
4,149 
4,564 
Depreciation and amortisation
902 
877 
 
434 
468 
453 
             
Operating expenses
8,894 
9,332 
 
4,277 
4,617 
5,017 
             
Loan impairment losses
2,730 
4,135 
 
1,435 
1,295 
2,237 
Securities impairment (recoveries)/losses
           
  - sovereign debt impairment and related
    interest rate hedge adjustments
842 
 
842 
  - other
(81)
76 
 
(100)
19 
27 
             
Impairment losses
2,649 
5,053 
 
1,335 
1,314 
3,106 

Payment Protection Insurance (PPI)
To reflect current experience of PPI complaints received, the Group strengthened its provision for PPI by £125 million in Q1 2012 and a further £135 million in Q2 2012, bringing the cumulative charge taken to £1.3 billion, of which £0.7 billion in redress had been paid by 30 June 2012. The eventual cost is dependent upon complaint volumes, uphold rates and average redress costs. Assumptions relating to these are inherently uncertain and the ultimate financial impact may be different than the amount provided. The Group will continue to monitor the position closely and refresh its assumptions as more information becomes available.

 
Half year 
ended 
30 June 
2012 
Quarter ended
Year 
ended 
31 December 
2011 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
         
At beginning of period
745 
689 
745 
Transfers from accruals and other liabilities
215 
Charge to income statement
260 
135 
125 
850 
Utilisations
(417)
(236)
(181)
(320)
         
At end of period
588 
588 
689 
745 

 
84

 
Notes (continued)

4. Loan impairment provisions
Operating loss is stated after charging loan impairment losses of £2,730 million (H1 2011 - £4,135 million). The balance sheet loan impairment provisions increased in the half year ended 30 June 2012 from £19,883 million to £20,297 million and the movements thereon were:

 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS 
MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
At beginning of period
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
Intra-group transfers
 
177 
(177)
Currency translation and other adjustments
(316)
(315)
 
89 
240 
329 
Disposals
 
11 
11 
Amounts written-off
(991)
(934)
(1,925)
 
(1,018)
(912)
(1,930)
Recoveries of amounts previously written-off
127 
53 
180 
 
80 
206 
286 
Charge to income statement
               
  - continuing
1,515 
1,215 
2,730 
 
1,662 
2,473 
4,135 
  - discontinued
 
(11)
(11)
Unwind of discount (recognised in interest income)
(122)
(134)
(256)
 
(104)
(139)
(243)
                 
At end of period
8,944 
11,353 
20,297 
 
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS 
MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                         
At beginning of period
8,797 
11,414 
20,211 
 
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
 
8,416 
10,842 
19,258 
Transfers to disposal
  groups
 
 
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(236)
(227)
 
(8)
(80)
(88)
 
33 
145 
178 
Disposals
 
 
11 
11 
Amounts written-off
(586)
(494)
(1,080)
 
(405)
(440)
(845)
 
(504)
(474)
(978)
Recoveries of amounts
  previously written-off
65 
20 
85 
 
62 
33 
95 
 
41 
126 
167 
Charge to income
  statement
                       
  - continuing
719 
716 
1,435 
 
796 
499 
1,295 
 
810 
1,427 
2,237 
  - discontinued
 
 
(11)
(11)
Unwind of discount
  (recognised in interest
  income)
(60)
(67)
(127)
 
(62)
(67)
(129)
 
(44)
(68)
(112)
                         
At end of period
8,944 
11,353 
20,297 
 
8,797 
11,414 
20,211 
 
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 

Provisions at 30 June 2012 include £119 million in respect of loans and advances to banks (31 March 2012 - £135 million; 30 June 2011 - £132 million).

 
85

 

Notes (continued)

5. Pensions
Pension costs for the half year ended 30 June 2012 amounted to £267 million (half year ended 30 June 2011 - £245 million; quarter ended 30 June 2012 - £132 million; quarter ended 31 March 2012 - £135 million; quarter ended 30 June 2011 - £108 million). Defined benefit schemes charges are based on the actuarially determined pension cost rates at 31 December 2011.

The most recent funding valuation of the main UK scheme, as at 31 March 2010, showed the value of liabilities exceeded the value of assets by £3.5 billion, a ratio of assets to liabilities of 84%. In order to eliminate this deficit, the Group has agreed to pay additional contributions each year over the period 2011 to 2018. These contributions started at £375 million in September 2011 and in March 2012, increasing to £400 million per annum in 2013 and from 2016 onwards will be further increased in line with price inflation. These contributions are in addition to the regular annual contributions of around £300 million for future accrual benefits.

6. Tax
The actual tax charge differs from the expected tax credit computed by applying the standard UK corporation tax rate of 24.5% (2011 - 26.5%).

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Loss before tax
(1,505)
(794)
 
(101)
(1,404)
(678)
             
Expected tax credit
369 
210 
 
25 
344 
179 
Sovereign debt impairment where no
  deferred tax asset recognised
(183)
 
(183)
Derecognition of deferred tax asset in respect
  of losses in Australia
(182)
 
(21)
(161)
Other losses in period where no deferred
  tax asset recognised
(253)
(268)
 
(80)
(173)
(102)
Foreign profits taxed at other rates
(211)
(300)
 
(109)
(102)
(100)
UK tax rate change - deferred tax impact
(46)
(87)
 
(16)
(30)
Unrecognised timing differences
14 
(10)
 
14 
(15)
Items not allowed for tax
           
  - losses on strategic disposals and
     write-downs
(4)
(10)
 
(4)
(7)
  - UK bank levy
(37)
 
(19)
(18)
  - employee share schemes
(29)
(8)
 
(14)
(15)
(4)
  - other disallowable items
(80)
(102)
 
(29)
(51)
(66)
Non-taxable items
           
  - gain on sale of RBS Aviation Capital
27 
 
27 
  - gain on sale of Global Merchant Services
12 
 
  - other non-taxable items
26 
21 
 
24 
Taxable foreign exchange movements
(2)
 
(3)
(2)
Losses brought forward and utilised
11 
29 
 
(4)
15 
13 
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
(32)
51 
 
(63)
31 
56 
             
Actual tax charge
(429)
(645)
 
(290)
(139)
(222)

 
86

 
Notes (continued)

6. Tax (continued)
The high tax charge for the half year ended 30 June 2012 reflects profits in high tax regimes (principally US) and losses in low tax regimes (principally Ireland), losses in overseas subsidiaries for which a deferred tax asset has not been recognised (principally Ireland and the Netherlands) and the derecognition of deferred tax assets in respect of losses in Australia, following the strategic changes to the Markets and International Banking businesses announced in January 2012.
 
 
The combined effect of tax losses in Ireland and the Netherlands in the half year ended 30 June 2012 for which no deferred tax asset has been recognised and the derecognition of the deferred tax asset in respect of losses in Australia account for £502 million (63%) of the difference between the actual tax charge and the tax credit derived from applying the standard UK Corporation Tax rate to the results for the period.

The Group has recognised a deferred tax asset at 30 June 2012 of £3,502 million (31 March 2012 - £3,849 million; 31 December 2011 - £3,878 million) of which £3,029 million (31 March 2012 - £3,134 million; 31 December 2011 - £2,933 million) relates to carried forward trading losses in the UK. Under UK tax legislation, these UK losses can be carried forward indefinitely to be utilised against profits arising in the future. The Group has considered the carrying value of this asset as at 30 June 2012 and concluded that it is recoverable based on future profit projections.

7. (Loss)/profit attributable to non-controlling interests

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
RBS Sempra Commodities JV
(5)
 
RFS Holdings BV Consortium Members
(35)
24 
 
(16)
(19)
14 
Other
12 
(2)
 
             
(Loss)/profit attributable to non-controlling
  interests
(19)
17 
 
(5)
(14)
18 

 
87

 
Notes (continued)

8. Dividends
On 26 November 2009, RBS entered into a State Aid Commitment Deed with HM Treasury containing commitments and undertakings that were designed to ensure that HM Treasury was able to comply with the commitments to be given by it to the European Commission for the purposes of obtaining approval for the State aid provided to RBS. As part of these commitments and undertakings, RBS agreed not to pay discretionary coupons and dividends on its existing hybrid capital instruments for a period of two years. This period commenced on 30 April 2010 for RBS Group instruments (the two year deferral period for RBS Holdings N.V. instruments commenced on 1 April 2011). On 30 April 2012 this period ended for RBS Group instruments.

On 4 May 2012, RBS determined that it was in a position to recommence payments on RBS Group instruments. The Core Tier 1 capital impact of discretionary amounts that will be payable over the remainder of 2012 on RBSG instruments on which payments have previously been stopped is c.£340 million. In the context of recent macro-prudential policy discussions, the Board of RBS decided to neutralise any impact on Core Tier 1 capital through equity issuance. Approximately 65% of this is ascribed to equity funding of employee incentive awards through the sale of surplus shares held by the Group’s Employee Benefit Trust, which is now complete. The remaining 35% will be raised through the issue of new ordinary shares, which is expected to take place during the remainder of 2012.

In May 2012, the Directors declared the discretionary dividends on certain non-cumulative dollar preference shares which were payable on 30 June 2012, and announced that the discretionary distributions on certain RBSG innovative securities which were payable in June 2012 would also be paid. Future coupons and dividends on RBSG hybrid capital instruments will only be paid subject to, and in accordance with, the terms of the relevant instruments.

9. Share consolidation
Following approval at the Group’s Annual General Meeting on 30 May 2012, the sub-division and consolidation of the Group’s ordinary shares on a one-for-ten basis took effect on 6 June 2012. There was a corresponding change in the Group’s share price to reflect this.

The Board believes that the consolidation will result in a more appropriate share price for a company of the Group’s size in the UK market. It may also help reduce volatility, thereby enabling a more consistent valuation of the Group.

 
88

 
Notes (continued)

10. Earnings per ordinary and B share
Earnings per ordinary and B share have been calculated based on the following:

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
             
Earnings
           
Loss from continuing operations attributable to
  ordinary and B shareholders (£m)
(1,987)
(1,429)
 
(463)
(1,524)
(899)
             
(Loss)/profit from discontinued operations
  attributable to ordinary and B shareholders (£m)
(3)
 
(3)
             
Ordinary shares in issue during the period
  (millions)
5,812 
5,689 
 
5,854 
5,770 
5,697 
Effect of convertible B shares in issue during
  the period (millions)
5,100 
5,100 
 
5,100 
5,100 
5,100 
             
Weighted average number of ordinary shares
  and effect of convertible B shares in issue
  during the period (millions)
10,912 
10,789 
 
10,954 
10,870 
10,797 
             
Basic and diluted loss per ordinary and B share from
  continuing operations
(18.2p)
(13.2p)
 
(4.2p)
(14.0p)
(8.3p)

Prior period data have been adjusted for the sub-division and one-for-ten consolidation of ordinary shares, which took effect in June 2012.


 
89

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis
In January 2012, the Group announced the reorganisation of its wholesale businesses into 'Markets' and 'International Banking'. Divisional results have been presented based on the new organisational structure. The Group has also revised its allocation of funding and liquidity costs and capital for the new divisional structure as well as for a new methodology. In addition, the Group had previously included movements in the fair value of own derivative liabilities within the Markets operating segment. These movements have now been combined with movements in the fair value of own debt in a single measure, ‘own credit adjustments’ and presented as a reconciling item. Refer to ‘presentation of information’ on page 5 for further details. Comparatives have been restated accordingly.

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss)
The following tables provide an analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) by main income statement captions.

 
Net 
interest 
income 
Non- 
interest 
income 
 
Total 
income 
 
Operating 
expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
losses 
 
Operating 
profit/(loss)
Half year ended 30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,989 
508 
2,497 
(1,288)
(295)
914 
UK Corporate
1,528 
884 
2,412 
(1,051)
(357)
1,004 
Wealth
357 
236 
593 
(462)
(22)
109 
International Banking
485 
618 
1,103 
(777)
(62)
264 
Ulster Bank
325 
95 
420 
(258)
(717)
(555)
US Retail & Commercial
988 
583 
1,571 
(1,193)
(47)
331 
Markets
48 
2,752 
2,800 
(1,704)
(21)
1,075 
Direct Line Group
152 
1,748 
1,900 
(456)
(1,225)
219 
Central items
(4)
(147)
(32)
(176)
               
Core
5,868 
7,431 
13,299 
(7,336)
(1,225)
(1,553)
3,185 
Non-Core
112 
158 
270 
(525)
(1,096)
(1,351)
               
Managed basis
5,980 
7,589 
13,569 
(7,861)
(1,225)
(2,649)
1,834 
Reconciling items
             
Own credit adjustments (1)
(2,974)
(2,974)
(2,974)
Asset Protection Scheme (2)
(45)
(45)
(45)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(260)
(260)
Amortisation of purchased intangible
  assets
(99)
(99)
Integration and restructuring costs
(673)
(673)
Gain on redemption of own debt
577 
577 
577 
Strategic disposals
152 
152 
152 
RFS Holdings minority interest
(10)
(6)
(16)
(1)
(17)
               
Statutory basis
5,970 
5,293 
11,263 
(8,894)
(1,225)
(2,649)
(1,505)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £1,280 million loss included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £1,694 million loss included in ‘Other operating income’.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’.
 
 
90

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
income 
Non- 
interest 
income 
 
Total 
income 
 
Operating 
expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
losses 
 
Operating 
profit/(loss)
Half year ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
2,184 
637 
2,821 
(1,366)
(402)
1,053 
UK Corporate
1,581 
899 
2,480 
(1,064)
(327)
1,089 
Wealth
325 
229 
554 
(416)
(8)
130 
International Banking
583 
729 
1,312 
(839)
(98)
375 
Ulster Bank
363 
102 
465 
(278)
(730)
(543)
US Retail & Commercial
922 
554 
1,476 
(1,063)
(176)
237 
Markets
56 
3,220 
3,276 
(1,934)
14 
1,356 
Direct Line Group
177 
1,939 
2,116 
(422)
(1,488)
206 
Central items
(76)
70 
(6)
27 
24 
               
Core
6,115 
8,379 
14,494 
(7,355)
(1,487)
(1,725)
3,927 
Non-Core
420 
981 
1,401 
(658)
(218)
(2,486)
(1,961)
               
Managed basis
6,535 
9,360 
15,895 
(8,013)
(1,705)
(4,211)
1,966 
Reconciling items
             
Own credit adjustments (1)
(236)
(236)
(236)
Asset Protection Scheme (2)
(637)
(637)
(637)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(850)
(850)
Sovereign debt impairment
(733)
(733)
Interest rate hedge adjustments on
  impaired available-for-sale sovereign
  debt
(109)
(109)
Amortisation of purchased intangible
  assets
(100)
(100)
Integration and restructuring costs
(2)
(3)
(5)
(348)
(353)
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
255 
255 
Strategic disposals
27 
27 
27 
Bonus tax
(22)
(22)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(5)
(3)
(2)
               
Statutory basis
6,528 
8,768 
15,296 
(9,332)
(1,705)
(5,053)
(794)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £170 million loss included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £66 million loss included in ‘Other operating income’ on a statutory basis.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’ on a statutory basis.
 

 
 
91

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
income 
Non- 
interest 
income 
 
Total 
income 
 
Operating 
expenses 
Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
losses 
 
Operating 
profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
988 
242 
1,230 
(653)
(140)
437 
UK Corporate
772 
439 
1,211 
(518)
(181)
512 
Wealth
178 
125 
303 
(227)
(12)
64 
International Banking
234 
327 
561 
(367)
(27)
167 
Ulster Bank
160 
46 
206 
(128)
(323)
(245)
US Retail & Commercial
492 
323 
815 
(558)
(28)
229 
Markets
32 
1,034 
1,066 
(796)
(19)
251 
Direct Line Group
68 
866 
934 
(223)
(576)
135 
Central items
110 
111 
(145)
(32)
               
Core
2,925 
3,512 
6,437 
(3,615)
(576)
(728)
1,518 
Non-Core
48 
(47)
(262)
(607)
(868)
               
Managed basis
2,973 
3,465 
6,438 
(3,877)
(576)
(1,335)
650 
Reconciling items
             
Own credit adjustments (1)
(518)
(518)
(518)
Asset Protection Scheme (2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(135)
(135)
Amortisation of purchased intangible
  assets
(51)
(51)
Integration and restructuring costs
(213)
(213)
Strategic disposals
160 
160 
160 
RFS Holdings minority interest
(2)
11 
(1)
               
Statutory basis
2,971 
3,116 
6,087 
(4,277)
(576)
(1,335)
(101)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £271 million loss included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £247 million loss included in ‘Other operating income’ on a statutory basis.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’ on a statutory basis.
 

 
 
92

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
income 
Non- 
interest 
income 
 
Total 
income 
 
Operating 
expenses 
Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
losses 
 
Operating 
profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 31 March 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,001 
266 
1,267 
(635)
(155)
477 
UK Corporate
756 
445 
1,201 
(533)
(176)
492 
Wealth
179 
111 
290 
(235)
(10)
45 
International Banking
251 
291 
542 
(410)
(35)
97 
Ulster Bank
165 
49 
214 
(130)
(394)
(310)
US Retail & Commercial
496 
260 
756 
(635)
(19)
102 
Markets
16 
1,718 
1,734 
(908)
(2)
824 
Direct Line Group
84 
882 
966 
(233)
(649)
84 
Central items
(5)
(103)
(108)
(2)
(34)
(144)
               
Core
2,943 
3,919 
6,862 
(3,721)
(649)
(825)
1,667 
Non-Core
64 
205 
269 
(263)
(489)
(483)
               
Managed basis
3,007 
4,124 
7,131 
(3,984)
(649)
(1,314)
1,184 
Reconciling items
             
Own credit adjustments (1)
(2,456)
(2,456)
(2,456)
Asset Protection Scheme (2)
(43)
(43)
(43)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(125)
(125)
Amortisation of purchased intangible
  assets
(48)
(48)
Integration and restructuring costs
(460)
(460)
Gain on redemption of own debt
577 
577 
577 
Strategic disposals
(8)
(8)
(8)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(8)
(17)
(25)
(25)
               
Statutory basis
2,999 
2,177 
5,176 
(4,617)
(649)
(1,314)
(1,404)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £1,009 million loss included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £1,447 million loss included in ‘Other operating income’ on a statutory basis.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’ on a statutory basis.

 
93

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
income 
Non- 
interest 
income 
 
Total 
income 
 
Operating 
expenses 
Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
losses 
 
Operating 
profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,098 
333 
1,431 
(688)
(208)
535 
UK Corporate
770 
448 
1,218 
(526)
(220)
472 
Wealth
168 
115 
283 
(220)
(3)
60 
International Banking
290 
375 
665 
(412)
(104)
149 
Ulster Bank
182 
51 
233 
(142)
(269)
(178)
US Retail & Commercial
470 
279 
749 
(541)
(65)
143 
Markets
1,165 
1,168 
(855)
14 
327 
Direct Line Group
89 
957 
1,046 
(203)
(704)
139 
Central items
(58)
81 
23 
30 
1
56 
               
Core
3,012 
3,804 
6,816 
(3,557)
(703)
(853)
1,703 
Non-Core
221 
745 
966 
(335)
(90)
(1,411)
(870)
               
Managed basis
3,233 
4,549 
7,782 
(3,892)
(793)
(2,264)
833 
Reconciling items
             
Own credit adjustments (1)
324 
324 
324 
Asset Protection Scheme (2)
(168)
(168)
(168)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(850)
(850)
Sovereign debt impairment
(733)
(733)
Interest rate hedge adjustments on
  impaired available-for-sale sovereign
  debt
(109)
(109)
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(56)
(56)
Integration and restructuring costs
(209)
(208)
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
255 
255 
Strategic disposals
50 
50 
50 
Bonus tax
(11)
(11)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(6)
(6)
(5)
               
Statutory basis
3,227 
5,011 
8,238 
(5,017)
(793)
(3,106)
(678)

Notes:
(1)
Comprises £96 million gain included in ‘Income from trading activities’ and £228 million gain included in ‘Other operating income’ on a statutory basis.
(2)
Included in ‘Income from trading activities’ on a statutory basis.
 

 
 
94

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis (continued)

Total revenue by division

 
Half year ended
30 June 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
Total revenue
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
3,277 
320 
3,597 
 
3,440 
204 
3,644 
UK Corporate
2,541 
40 
2,581 
 
2,532 
39 
2,571 
Wealth
526 
401 
927 
 
501 
353 
854 
International Banking
1,409 
189 
1,598 
 
1,609 
204 
1,813 
Ulster Bank
557 
(8)
549 
 
636 
638 
US Retail & Commercial
1,755 
68 
1,823 
 
1,715 
108 
1,823 
Markets
3,199 
2,805 
6,004 
 
3,850 
3,589 
7,439 
Direct Line Group
2,296 
2,301 
 
2,386 
2,390 
Central items
1,270 
8,379 
9,649 
 
1,459 
6,032 
7,491 
               
Core
16,830 
12,199 
29,029 
 
18,128 
10,535 
28,663 
Non-Core
1,322 
498 
1,820 
 
2,754 
171 
2,925 
               
Managed basis
18,152 
12,697 
30,849 
 
20,882 
10,706 
31,588 
Reconciling items
             
Own credit adjustments
(2,974)
(2,974)
 
(236)
 
(236)
Asset Protection Scheme
(45)
(45)
 
(637)
(637)
Integration and restructuring costs
 
(5)
(5)
Gain on redemption of own debt
577 
577 
 
255 
255 
Strategic disposals
152 
152 
 
27 
27 
RFS Holdings minority interest
(4)
(4)
 
(3)
(3)
Elimination of intra-group transactions
(12,697)
(12,697)
 
(10,706)
(10,706)
               
Statutory basis
15,858 
15,858 
 
20,283 
20,283 
 
 

 
 
95

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis (continued)

Total revenue by division (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
 
External 
Inter 
 segment 
Total 
 
External 
Inter 
segment 
Total 
Total revenue
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
UK Retail
1,627 
178 
1,805 
 
1,650 
142 
1,792 
 
1,744 
88 
1,832 
UK Corporate
1,262 
22 
1,284 
 
1,279 
18 
1,297 
 
1,249 
18 
1,267 
Wealth
266 
190 
456 
 
260 
211 
471 
 
253 
185 
438 
International Banking
709 
89 
798 
 
700 
100 
800 
 
833 
113 
946 
Ulster Bank
267 
(2)
265 
 
290 
(6)
284 
 
309 
311 
US Retail & Commercial
900 
32 
932 
 
855 
36 
891 
 
861 
52 
913 
Markets
1,265 
1,294 
2,559 
 
1,934 
1,511 
3,445 
 
1,517 
1,879 
3,396 
Direct Line Group
1,138 
1,140 
 
1,158 
1,161 
 
1,187 
1,189 
Central items
701 
4,478 
5,179 
 
569 
3,901 
4,470 
 
762 
3,063 
3,825 
                       
Core
8,135 
6,283 
14,418 
 
8,695 
5,916 
14,611 
 
8,715 
5,402 
14,117 
Non-Core
502 
350 
852 
 
820 
148 
968 
 
1,632 
116 
1,748 
                       
Managed basis
8,637 
6,633 
15,270 
 
9,515 
6,064 
15,579 
 
10,347 
5,518 
15,865 
Reconciling items
                     
Own credit adjustments
(518)
(518)
 
(2,456)
 
(2,456)
 
324 
324 
Asset Protection Scheme
(2)
(2)
 
(43)
 
(43)
 
(168)
(168)
Integration and restructuring
  costs
 
 
Gain on redemption of
  own debt
-
 
577 
577 
 
255 
255 
Strategic disposals
160 
160 
 
(8)
(8)
 
50 
50 
RFS Holdings minority
  interest
13 
13 
 
(17)
(17)
 
(6)
(6)
Elimination of intra-group
  transactions
(6,633)
(6,633)
 
(6,064)
(6,064)
 
(5,518)
(5,518)
                       
Statutory basis
8,290 
8,290 
 
7,568 
7,568 
 
10,803 
10,803 
 

 
 
96

 
Notes (continued)

11. Segmental analysis (continued)

Total assets by division
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
Total assets
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
UK Retail
116,849 
116,255 
114,469 
UK Corporate
113,655 
113,140 
114,237 
Wealth
21,285 
21,325 
21,718 
International Banking
61,480 
63,719 
69,987 
Ulster Bank
33,293 
33,614 
34,810 
US Retail & Commercial
75,084 
73,693 
75,791 
Markets
774,443 
740,332 
826,947 
Direct Line Group
13,559 
13,430 
12,912 
Central items
124,120 
134,780 
130,466 
       
Core
1,333,768 
1,310,288 
1,401,337 
Non-Core
80,590 
91,823 
104,726 
       
 
1,414,358 
1,402,111 
1,506,063 
RFS Holdings minority interest
831 
910 
804 
       
 
1,415,189 
1,403,021 
1,506,867 

12. Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups

(a) Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Discontinued operations
           
Total income
16 
17 
 
Operating expenses
(2)
(1)
 
(1)
(1)
Impairment losses
11 
 
11 
             
Profit before tax
14 
27 
 
20 
Tax
(5)
(7)
 
(2)
(3)
(4)
             
Profit after tax
20 
 
16 
Businesses acquired exclusively with a
  view to disposal
           
(Loss)/profit after tax
(8)
11 
 
(9)
             
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations,
  net of tax
31 
 
(4)
21 

Discontinued operations reflect the results of RFS Holdings attributable to the State of the Netherlands and Santander following the legal separation of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. on 1 April 2010.

 
97

 
Notes (continued)

12. Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups (continued)

(b) Assets and liabilities of disposal groups
 
30 June 2012
31 March 
2012 
£m 
31 December 
2011 
£m 
 
UK branch 
based 
businesses 
Other 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Assets of disposal groups
         
Cash and balances at central banks
90 
50 
140 
87 
127 
Loans and advances to banks
88 
88 
112 
87 
Loans and advances to customers
18,608 
1,092 
19,700 
19,264 
19,405 
Debt securities and equity shares
36 
36 
Derivatives
372 
376 
368 
439 
Intangible assets
15 
15 
Settlement balances
14 
Property, plant and equipment
114 
115 
4,609 
4,749 
Other assets
441 
445 
438 
456 
           
Discontinued operations and other disposal groups
19,188 
1,714 
20,902 
24,902 
25,297 
Assets acquired exclusively with a view to disposal
167 
167 
158 
153 
           
 
19,188 
1,881 
21,069 
25,060 
25,450 
           
Liabilities of disposal groups
         
Deposits by banks
83 
Customer accounts
21,729 
802 
22,531 
22,281 
22,610 
Derivatives
56 
61 
49 
126 
Settlement balances
Other liabilities
15 
446 
461 
1,239 
1,233 
           
Discontinued operations and other disposal groups
21,801 
1,253 
23,054 
23,652 
23,978 
Liabilities acquired exclusively with a view to disposal
10 
10 
12 
17 
           
 
21,801 
1,263 
23,064 
23,664 
23,995 

The assets and liabilities of disposal groups at 30 June 2012 primarily comprise the RBS England and Wales and NatWest Scotland branch-based businesses (“UK branch-based businesses”).

UK branch-based businesses
Gross loans, Risk elements in lending (REIL) and impairment provisions at 30 June 2012 relating to the Group's UK branch-based businesses are set out below.

 
Gross 
loans 
REIL 
Impairment 
 provisions 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Residential mortgages
5,849 
197 
34 
Personal lending
1,782 
325 
267 
Property
5,519 
422 
136 
Construction
562 
160 
60 
Service industries and business activities
4,824 
286 
153 
Other
839 
43 
42 
Latent
75 
       
Total
19,375 
1,433 
767 
 

 
 
98

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments

Classification
The following tables analyse the Group’s financial assets and liabilities in accordance with the categories of financial instruments in IAS 39 with assets and liabilities outside the scope of IAS 39 shown separately. There have been no reclassifications during H1 2012.
 
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at central
  banks
78,647 
     
78,647 
Loans and advances to banks
               
  - reverse repos
37,165 
540 
     
37,705 
  - other
18,857 
20,579 
     
39,436 
Loans and advances to
  customers
               
  - reverse repos
59,680 
516 
     
60,196 
  - other
24,542 
206 
402,355 
 
7,862 
 
434,965 
Debt securities
92,194 
873 
89,336 
5,223 
     
187,626 
Equity shares
11,019 
640 
1,432 
     
13,091 
Settlement balances
15,312 
     
15,312 
Derivatives (5)
486,432 
           
486,432 
Intangible assets
           
14,888 
14,888 
Property, plant and equipment
           
11,337 
11,337 
Deferred tax
           
3,502 
3,502 
Prepayments, accrued
  income and other assets
1,490 
   
9,493 
10,983 
Assets of disposal groups
           
21,069 
21,069 
                 
 
729,889 
1,719 
90,768 
524,662 
 
7,862 
60,289 
1,415,189 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
33,077 
   
6,048 
   
39,125 
  - other
33,615 
   
34,004 
   
67,619 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
83,463 
   
5,487 
   
88,950 
  - other
14,356 
5,752 
   
392,661 
   
412,769 
Debt securities in issue
10,780 
30,355 
   
78,720 
   
119,855 
Settlement balances
   
15,126 
   
15,126 
Short positions
38,376 
         
38,376 
Derivatives (5)
480,745 
           
480,745 
Accruals, deferred income
  and other liabilities
   
1,748 
16 
17,056 
18,820 
Retirement benefit liabilities
           
1,791 
1,791 
Deferred tax
           
1,815 
1,815 
Insurance liabilities
           
6,322 
6,322 
Subordinated liabilities
923 
   
24,673 
   
25,596 
Liabilities of disposal groups
           
23,064 
23,064 
                 
 
694,412 
37,030 
   
558,467 
16 
50,048 
1,339,973 
                 
Equity
             
75,216 
                 
               
1,415,189 
For the notes to this table refer to page 101.

 
99

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Classification (continued)
 
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
 financial 
 instruments 
(amortised 
 cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
31 March 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at central banks
82,363 
     
82,363 
Loans and advances to banks
               
  - reverse repos
32,232 
2,394 
     
34,626 
  - other
17,055 
19,009 
     
36,064 
Loans and advances to
  customers
               
  - reverse repos
50,039 
6,464 
     
56,503 
  - other
24,142 
254 
408,031 
 
7,979 
 
440,406 
Debt securities
92,250 
818 
97,381 
5,482 
     
195,931 
Equity shares
14,903 
784 
1,916 
     
17,603 
Settlement balances
20,970 
     
20,970 
Derivatives (5)
453,354 
           
453,354 
Intangible assets
           
14,771 
14,771 
Property, plant and equipment
           
11,442 
11,442 
Deferred tax
           
3,849 
3,849 
Prepayments, accrued
  income and other assets
1,341 
   
8,738 
10,079 
Assets of disposal groups
           
25,060 
25,060 
                 
 
683,975 
1,856 
99,297 
546,054 
 
7,979 
63,860 
1,403,021 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
26,926 
   
14,489 
   
41,415 
  - other
30,967 
   
34,768 
   
65,735 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
68,308 
   
18,995 
   
87,303 
  - other
13,957 
5,755 
   
390,495 
   
410,207 
Debt securities in issue
10,692 
33,317 
   
98,934 
   
142,943 
Settlement balances
   
17,597 
   
17,597 
Short positions
37,322 
         
37,322 
Derivatives (5)
446,534 
           
446,534 
Accruals, deferred income
  and other liabilities
   
1,672 
17 
18,589 
20,278 
Retirement benefit liabilities
           
1,840 
1,840 
Deferred tax
           
1,788 
1,788 
Insurance liabilities
           
6,251 
6,251 
Subordinated liabilities
1,006 
   
24,507 
   
25,513 
Liabilities of disposal groups
           
23,664 
23,664 
                 
 
634,706 
40,078 
   
601,457 
17 
52,132 
1,328,390 
                 
Equity
             
74,631 
                 
               
1,403,021 

For the notes to this table refer to page 101.

 
100

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Classification (continued)
 
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
 financial 
 instruments 
(amortised 
 cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at central banks
79,269 
     
79,269 
Loans and advances to banks
               
  - reverse repos
34,659 
4,781 
     
39,440 
  - other
20,317 
23,553 
     
43,870 
Loans and advances to
  customers
               
  - reverse repos
53,584 
7,910 
     
61,494 
  - other
25,322 
476 
419,895 
 
8,419 
 
454,112 
Debt securities
95,076 
647 
107,298 
6,059 
     
209,080 
Equity shares
12,433 
774 
1,976 
     
15,183 
Settlement balances
7,771 
     
7,771 
Derivatives (5)
529,618 
           
529,618 
Intangible assets
           
14,858 
14,858 
Property, plant and equipment
           
11,868 
11,868 
Deferred tax
           
3,878 
3,878 
Prepayments, accrued
  income and other assets
1,309 
   
9,667 
10,976 
Assets of disposal groups
           
25,450 
25,450 
                 
 
771,009 
1,897 
109,274 
550,547 
 
8,419 
65,721 
1,506,867 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
23,342 
   
16,349 
   
39,691 
  - other
34,172 
   
34,941 
   
69,113 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
65,526 
   
23,286 
   
88,812 
  - other
14,286 
5,627 
   
394,230 
   
414,143 
Debt securities in issue
11,492 
35,747 
   
115,382 
   
162,621 
Settlement balances
   
7,477 
   
7,477 
Short positions
41,039 
         
41,039 
Derivatives (5)
523,983 
           
523,983 
Accruals, deferred income
  and other liabilities
   
1,683 
19 
21,423 
23,125 
Retirement benefit liabilities
           
2,239 
2,239 
Deferred tax
           
1,945 
1,945 
Insurance liabilities
           
6,312 
6,312 
Subordinated liabilities
903 
   
25,416 
   
26,319 
Liabilities of disposal groups
           
23,995 
23,995 
                 
 
713,840 
42,277 
   
618,764 
19 
55,914 
1,430,814 
                 
Equity
             
76,053 
                 
               
1,506,867 
Notes:
(1)
Held-for-trading.
(2)
Designated as at fair value.
(3)
Available-for-sale.
(4)
Loans and receivables.
(5)
Held-for-trading derivatives include hedging derivatives.
 

 
 
101

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation reserves
Credit valuation adjustments (CVA) represent an estimate of the adjustment to fair value that a market participant would make to incorporate the credit risk inherent in counterparty derivative exposures. Certain credit derivative product companies (CDPC) exposures were restructured during the first half of the year and the CVA methodology applied to these exposures was updated to reflect the revised risk mitigation strategy that is now in place. There were no changes to other valuation methodologies.

When valuing financial instruments in the trading book, adjustments are made to mid-market valuations to cover bid-offer spread, liquidity and credit risk.

The following table shows credit valuation adjustments and other reserves.

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
CVA
     
  - Monoline insurers
481 
991 
1,198 
  - Credit derivative product companies
479 
624 
1,034 
  - Other counterparties
2,334 
2,014 
2,254 
       
 
3,294 
3,629 
4,486 
Bid-offer, liquidity and other reserves
2,207 
2,228 
2,704 
       
Valuation reserves
5,501 
5,857 
7,190 

Key points

30 June 2012 compared with 31 December 2011
·
The gross exposure to monolines reduced in the first half of the year from £1.9 billion to £0.9 billion primarily due to trade restructurings and unwinds and an increase in underlying asset prices. The CVA decreased on a total basis reflecting the lower exposure, and also on a relative basis (from 63% to 51%) due to the impact of restructurings and unwinds as well as tighter credit spreads.
   
·
The exposure to CDPCs decreased from £1.9 billion to £1.1 billion. This was primarily driven by tighter credit spreads of underlying reference instruments, together with the impact of restructuring certain exposures. The CVA decreased on an absolute basis in line with the decrease in exposure and also on a relative basis (from 55% to 42%) due to the restructuring of certain exposures.
   
·
The CVA held against exposure to other counterparties increased primarily due to counterparty rating downgrades and increased weighted average life assumptions, partially offset by tighter credit spreads.
   
·
Within other reserves, bid-offer reserves decreased due to risk reduction and the impact of Greek government debt restructuring. Other reserves were also lower across a range of businesses and products.


 
102

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Key points (continued)

30 June 2012 compared with 31 March 2012
 
·
The gross exposure to monolines reduced from £1.6 billion to £0.9 billion primarily due to trade restructurings and unwinds. The CVA decreased on a total basis reflecting the lower exposure, and also on a relative basis (from 60% to 51%) due to the impact of trade restructurings and unwinds.
·
The exposure to CDPCs was stable as the impact of restructuring certain exposures was offset by wider credit spreads. The CVA decreased on a total basis and also on a relative basis (from 56% to 42%) due to restructuring of certain exposures.
·
Other counterparty CVA increased primarily due to counterparty rating downgrades, increased weighted average life assumptions and wider credit spreads.
 

Own credit
The following table shows the cumulative own credit adjustment recorded on securities classified as fair value through profit or loss and derivative liabilities. There have been some refinements to methodologies during the first half of the year, but they did not have a material overall impact on cumulative own credit adjustment.
Cumulative own credit adjustment (1)
 
Debt securities in issue (2)
Subordinated 
liabilities 
DFV 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Derivatives 
£m 
Total (3)
£m 
HFT 
£m 
DFV 
£m 
Total 
£m 
               
30 June 2012
(323)
1,040 
717 
572 
1,289 
452 
1,741 
31 March 2012
91 
1,207 
1,298 
520 
1,818 
466 
2,284 
31 December 2011
882 
2,647 
3,529 
679 
4,208 
602 
4,810 
               
Carrying values of underlying liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
   
               
30 June 2012
10.8 
30.3 
41.1 
0.9 
42.0 
   
31 March 2012
10.7 
33.3 
44.0 
1.0 
45.0 
   
31 December 2011
11.5 
35.7 
47.2 
0.9 
48.1 
   

Notes:
(1)
The own credit fair value adjustment does not alter cash flows and is not used for performance management. It is disregarded for regulatory capital reporting purposes and will reverse over time as the liabilities mature.
(2)
Consists of wholesale and retail note issuances.
(3)
The reserve movement between periods will not equate to the reported profit or loss for own credit. The balance sheet reserves are stated by conversion of underlying currency balances at spot rates for each period, whereas the income statement includes intra-period foreign exchange sell-offs.

Key points
·
The total own credit adjustment decreased significantly during the first half of the year reflecting tightening of credit spreads.
·
Senior issued debt valuation adjustments are determined with reference to secondary debt issuance spreads. At 30 June 2012, the five year level tightened to 246 basis points from 451 basis points at the year end, reflecting strengthened investor perceptions.
·
Significant tightening of credit spreads, buy-backs exceeding issuances and the impact of buying back certain securities at lower spreads than at issuance, resulted in overall negative own credit adjustment in respect of HFT debt securities at 30 June 2012.
·
Derivative liability own credit adjustment decreased as credit default swaps spreads tightened.
 


 
103

 
Notes (continued)


13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy
The following tables show financial instruments carried at fair value on the Group’s balance sheet by valuation hierarchy - level 1, level 2 and level 3.

A detailed explanation of the valuation techniques and sensitivity analysis methodology are set out in the Group’s 2011 Annual Report on pages 304 to 317.

 
30 June 2012
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Loans and advances to banks
             
  - reverse repos
37.2 
37.2 
 
  - collateral
18.3 
18.3 
 
  - other
0.2 
0.4 
0.6 
 
30 
(50)
               
 
55.7 
0.4 
56.1 
 
30 
(50)
               
Loans and advances to customers
             
  - reverse repos
59.7 
59.7 
 
  - collateral
22.2 
22.2 
 
  - other
2.2 
0.3 
2.5 
 
80 
(20)
               
 
84.1 
0.3 
84.4 
 
80 
(20)
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
18.3 
18.3 
 
  - US government
33.6 
6.1 
39.7 
 
  - other government
43.0 
11.2 
54.2 
 
  - corporate
4.8 
0.2 
5.0 
 
20 
(20)
  - other financial institutions
1.8 
57.8 
5.6 
65.2 
 
370 
(220)
               
 
96.7 
79.9 
5.8 
182.4 
 
390 
(240)
               
Equity shares
10.6 
1.5 
1.0 
13.1 
 
140 
(150)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
60.4 
1.4 
61.8 
 
170 
(70)
  - interest rate
0.1 
399.7 
0.7 
400.5 
 
50 
(50)
  - equities and commodities
5.5 
0.2 
5.7 
 
  - credit
15.6 
2.8 
18.4 
 
490 
(330)
               
 
0.1 
481.2 
5.1 
486.4 
 
710 
(450)
               
 
107.4 
702.4 
12.6 
822.4 
 
1,350 
(910)
               
Proportion
13.1% 
85.4% 
1.5% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
107.0 
693.0 
5.7 
805.7 
     
Non-Core
0.4 
9.4 
6.9 
16.7 
     
               
 
107.4 
702.4 
12.6 
822.4 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 110.

 
104

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 March 2012
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Loans and advances to banks
             
  - reverse repos
32.2 
 - 
32.2 
 
  - collateral
16.4 
16.4 
 
  - other
0.3 
0.4 
0.7 
 
30 
(50)
               
 
48.9 
0.4 
49.3 
 
30 
(50)
               
Loans and advances to customers
             
  - reverse repos
50.0 
50.0 
 
  - collateral
21.2 
21.2 
 
  - other
2.9 
0.3 
3.2 
 
80 
(20)
               
 
74.1 
0.3 
74.4 
 
80 
(20)
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
18.7 
18.7 
 
  - US government
32.8 
4.8 
37.6 
 
  - other government
49.4 
8.3 
57.7 
 
  - corporate
5.0 
0.3 
5.3 
 
20 
(20)
  - other financial institutions
2.0 
63.6 
5.5 
71.1 
 
450 
(130)
               
 
102.9 
81.7 
5.8 
190.4 
 
470 
(150)
               
Equity shares
14.7 
2.0 
0.9 
17.6 
 
130 
(140)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
61.5 
1.8 
63.3 
 
120 
(120)
  - interest rate
0.2 
364.5 
0.9 
365.6 
 
70 
(90)
  - equities and commodities
0.1 
5.8 
0.2 
6.1 
 
  - credit
15.5 
2.9 
18.4 
 
540 
(280)
               
 
0.3 
447.3 
5.8 
453.4 
 
730 
(490)
               
 
117.9 
654.0 
13.2 
785.1 
 
1,440 
(850)
               
Proportion
15.0% 
83.3% 
1.7% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
117.4 
643.2 
6.2 
766.8 
     
Non-Core
0.5 
10.8 
7.0 
18.3 
     
               
 
117.9 
654.0 
13.2 
785.1 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 110.

 
105

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 December 2011
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Loans and advances to banks
             
  - reverse repos
34.7 
34.7 
 
  - collateral
19.7 
19.7 
 
  - other
0.2 
0.4 
0.6 
 
40 
(50)
               
 
54.6 
0.4 
55.0 
 
40 
(50)
               
Loans and advances to customers
             
  - reverse repos
53.6 
53.6 
 
  - collateral
22.0 
22.0 
 
  - other
3.4 
0.4 
3.8 
 
80 
(20)
               
 
79.0 
0.4 
79.4 
 
80 
(20)
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
22.4 
22.4 
 
  - US government
35.5 
5.0 
40.5 
 
  - other government
53.9 
8.7 
62.6 
 
  - corporate
5.0 
0.5 
5.5 
 
30 
(30)
  - other financial institutions
3.0 
61.6 
7.4 
72.0 
 
560 
(180)
               
 
114.8 
80.3 
7.9 
203.0 
 
590 
(210)
               
Equity shares
12.4 
1.8 
1.0 
15.2 
 
140 
(130)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
72.9 
1.6 
74.5 
 
100 
(100)
  - interest rate
0.2 
420.8 
1.1 
422.1 
 
80 
(80)
  - equities and commodities
5.9 
0.2 
6.1 
 
  - credit
23.1 
3.8 
26.9 
 
680 
(400)
               
 
0.2 
522.7 
6.7 
529.6 
 
860 
(580)
               
 
127.4 
738.4 
16.4 
882.2 
 
1,710 
(990)
               
Proportion
14.4% 
83.7% 
1.9% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
126.9 
724.5 
7.2 
858.6 
     
Non-Core
0.5 
13.9 
9.2 
23.6 
     
               
 
127.4 
738.4 
16.4 
882.2 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 110.

 
106

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)
The following tables detail AFS assets included within debt securities and equity shares on pages 99 to 101.
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
30 June 2012
             
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
11.9 
11.9 
 
  - US government
17.3 
2.8 
20.1 
 
  - other government
12.3 
5.2 
17.5 
 
  - corporate
2.5 
0.1 
2.6 
 
10 
(10)
  - other financial institutions
0.2 
33.3 
3.7 
37.2 
 
210 
(100)
               
 
41.7 
43.8 
3.8 
89.3 
 
220 
(110)
Equity shares
0.2 
0.7 
0.5 
1.4 
 
90 
(90)
               
 
41.9 
44.5 
4.3 
90.7 
 
310 
(200)
               
Of which
             
Core
41.9 
43.0 
0.7 
85.6 
     
Non-Core
1.5 
3.6 
5.1 
     
               
 
41.9 
44.5 
4.3 
90.7 
     
               
31 March 2012
             
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
11.9 
11.9 
 
  - US government
18.0 
2.6 
20.6 
 
  - other government
16.4 
3.6 
20.0 
 
  - corporate
2.1 
0.1 
2.2 
 
10 
(10)
  - other financial institutions
0.1 
38.4 
4.2 
42.7 
 
260 
(30)
               
 
46.4 
46.7 
4.3 
97.4 
 
270 
(40)
Equity shares
0.3 
1.2 
0.4 
1.9 
 
70 
(80)
               
 
46.7 
47.9 
4.7 
99.3 
 
340 
(120)
               
Of which
             
Core
46.6 
45.8 
0.6 
93.0 
     
Non-Core
0.1 
2.1 
4.1 
6.3 
     
               
 
46.7 
47.9 
4.7 
99.3 
     
               
31 December 2011
             
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
13.4 
13.4 
 
  - US government
18.1 
2.7 
20.8 
 
  - other government
21.6 
4.0 
25.6 
 
  - corporate
2.3 
0.2 
2.5 
 
10 
(10)
  - other financial institutions
0.2 
39.3 
5.5 
45.0 
 
310 
(50)
               
 
53.3 
48.3 
5.7 
107.3 
 
320 
(60)
Equity shares
0.3 
1.3 
0.4 
2.0 
 
70 
(70)
               
 
53.6 
49.6 
6.1 
109.3 
 
390 
(130)
               
Of which
             
Core
53.6 
46.9 
0.6 
101.1 
     
Non-Core
2.7 
5.5 
8.2 
     
               
 
53.6 
49.6 
6.1 
109.3 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 110.

 
107

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
30 June 2012
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Deposits by banks
             
  - repos
33.1 
33.1 
 
  - collateral
31.9 
31.9 
 
  - other
1.6 
0.1 
1.7 
 
(90)
               
 
66.6 
0.1 
66.7 
 
(90)
               
Customer accounts
             
  - repos
83.5 
83.5 
 
  - collateral
9.8 
9.8 
 
  - other
10.3 
10.3 
 
20 
(20)
               
 
103.6 
103.6 
 
20 
(20)
               
Debt securities in issue
38.3 
2.8 
41.1 
 
70 
(70)
               
Short positions
32.4 
5.9 
0.1 
38.4 
 
20 
(20)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
70.1 
0.7 
70.8 
 
110 
(30)
  - interest rate
0.2 
382.4 
0.5 
383.1 
 
40 
(40)
  - equities and commodities
8.5 
0.8 
9.3 
 
10 
(10)
  - credit
16.4 
1.1 
17.5 
 
50 
(80)
               
 
0.2 
477.4 
3.1 
480.7 
 
210 
(160)
               
Subordinated liabilities
0.9 
0.9 
 
               
 
32.6 
692.7 
6.1 
731.4 
 
320 
(360)
               
Proportion
4.5% 
94.7% 
0.8% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
32.6 
688.4 
5.8 
726.8 
     
Non-Core
4.3 
0.3 
4.6 
     
               
 
32.6 
692.7 
6.1 
731.4 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 110.

 
108

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 March 2012
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Deposits by banks
             
  - repos
26.9 
26.9 
 
  - collateral
29.4 
29.4 
 
  - other
1.6 
1.6 
 
(70)
               
 
57.9 
57.9 
 
(70)
               
Customer accounts
             
  - repos
68.3 
68.3 
 
  - collateral
8.8 
8.8 
 
  - other
10.9 
10.9 
 
30 
(30)
               
 
88.0 
88.0 
 
30 
(30)
               
Debt securities in issue
41.8 
2.2 
44.0 
 
60 
(60)
               
Short positions
31.4 
5.7 
0.2 
37.3 
 
(30)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
68.6 
1.0 
69.6 
 
50 
(50)
  - interest rate
0.2 
348.7 
0.7 
349.6 
 
70 
(60)
  - equities and commodities
8.9 
0.8 
9.7 
 
10 
(10)
  - credit - APS (2)
0.1 
0.1 
 
50 
  - credit - other
16.4 
1.2 
17.6 
 
60 
(90)
               
 
0.2 
442.6 
3.8 
446.6 
 
240 
(210)
               
Subordinated liabilities
1.0 
1.0 
 
               
 
31.6 
637.0 
6.2 
674.8 
 
330 
(400)
               
Proportion
4.7% 
94.4% 
0.9% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
31.6 
632.7 
5.8 
670.1 
     
Non-Core
4.3 
0.4 
4.7 
     
               
 
31.6 
637.0 
6.2 
674.8 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 110.

 
109

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 December 2011
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Deposits by banks
             
  - repos
23.3 
23.3 
 
  - collateral
31.8 
31.8 
 
  - other
2.4 
2.4 
 
               
 
57.5 
57.5 
 
               
Customer accounts
             
  - repos
65.5 
65.5 
 
  - collateral
9.2 
9.2 
 
  - other
10.8 
10.8 
 
20 
(20)
               
 
85.5 
85.5 
 
20 
(20)
               
Debt securities in issue
45.0 
2.2 
47.2 
 
80 
(60)
               
Short positions
34.4 
6.3 
0.3 
41.0 
 
10 
(100)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
80.5 
0.4 
80.9 
 
30 
(20)
  - interest rate
0.4 
405.5 
1.1 
407.0 
 
80 
(90)
  - equities and commodities
8.9 
0.5 
9.4 
 
10 
(10)
  - credit - APS (2)
0.2 
0.2 
 
300 
(40)
  - credit - other
24.9 
1.6 
26.5 
 
80 
(130)
               
 
0.4 
519.8 
3.8 
524.0 
 
500 
(290)
               
Subordinated liabilities
0.9 
0.9 
 
               
 
34.8 
715.0 
6.3 
756.1 
 
610 
(470)
               
Proportion
4.6% 
94.6% 
0.8% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
34.8 
708.9 
5.7 
749.4 
     
Non-Core
6.1 
0.6 
6.7 
     
               
 
34.8 
715.0 
6.3 
756.1 
     

Notes:
(1)
Sensitivity represents the favourable and unfavourable effect respectively on the income statement or the statement of comprehensive income due to reasonably possible changes to valuations using reasonably possible alternative inputs to the Group’s valuation techniques or models. Level 3 sensitivities are calculated at a sub-portfolio level and hence these aggregated figures do not reflect the correlation between some of the sensitivities. In particular, for some of the portfolios, the sensitivities may be negatively correlated where a downward movement in one asset would produce an upward movement in another, but due to the additive presentation above, this correlation cannot be observed.
(2)
Asset Protection Scheme.
 

 
 
110

 
Notes (continued)

13. Financial instruments (continued)

Movement in level 3 portfolios

 
1 January 
2012 
(Losses)/ 
gains 
 
Purchases 
and issues 
Sales and 
settlements 
FX (2)
30 June 
2012 
 
Gains/(losses)
recorded in 
the income 
statement 
relating to 
instruments 
held at 
30 June 
2012 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 3 transfers
In 
Out 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
                     
Assets
                   
Fair value through
  profit or loss:
                   
Loans and
  advances
760 
(1)
(16)
69 
(82)
(3)
732 
 
(5)
Debt securities
2,243 
181 
546 
(86)
367 
(1,301)
(4)
1,946 
 
43 
Equity shares
573 
33 
(27)
134 
(193)
(6)
522 
 
Derivatives
6,732 
(933)
26 
(259)
372 
(772)
(26)
5,140 
 
(1,002)
                     
 
10,308 
(745)
610 
(388)
942 
(2,348)
(39)
8,340 
 
(960)
                     
AFS:
                   
Debt securities
5,697 
106 
86 
(410)
(1,637)
3,843 
 
(67)
Equity shares
395 
63 
20 
(12)
(8)
467 
 
                     
 
6,092 
169 
106 
(410)
(1,649)
(7)
4,310 
 
(60)
                     
 
16,400 
(576)
716 
(798)
951 
(3,997)
(46)
12,650 
 
(1,020)
                     
Liabilities
                   
Deposits
22 
49 
(1)
70 
 
(7)
Debt securities
  in issue
2,199 
34 
107 
(79)
827 
(328)
(9)
2,751 
 
34 
Short positions
291 
(155)
33 
(21)
149 
 
90 
Derivatives
3,811 
(437)
92 
(206)
390 
(542)
(18)
3,090 
 
(668)
Other
 
                     
 
6,323 
(509)
199 
(285)
1,250 
(891)
(27)
6,060 
 
(551)
                     
Net losses (1)
 
(67)
             
(469)

Notes:
(1)
Losses of £176 million and gains of £109 million were recognised in the income statement and statement of comprehensive income during the first half of 2012.
(2)
Foreign exchange movements.

 
111

 
Notes (continued)

 
14. Available-for-sale reserve

 
Half year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
30 June 
2011 
Available-for-sale reserve
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
At beginning of period
(957)
(2,037)
 
(439)
(957)
(2,063)
Unrealised losses on Greek sovereign debt
(842)
 
(842)
Impairment of Greek sovereign debt
842 
 
842 
Other unrealised net gains
1,152 
1,785 
 
428 
724 
1,623 
Realised net gains
(582)
(413)
 
(370)
(212)
(216)
Tax
(63)
(361)
 
(69)
(370)
             
At end of period
(450)
(1,026)
 
(450)
(439)
(1,026)

The H1 2012 movement in available-for-sale reserve primarily reflects unrealised net gains on securities of £1,158 million, largely as yields tightened on German, US and UK sovereign bonds.

In Q2 2011, as a result of the deterioration in Greece’s fiscal position and the announcement of proposals to restructure Greek government debt, the Group concluded that the Greek sovereign debt was impaired. Accordingly, £733 million of unrealised losses recognised in available-for-sale reserves together with £109 million related interest rate hedge adjustments were recycled to the income statement. Further losses of £224 million were recorded in Q4 2011.

Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain are facing less acute fiscal difficulties and the Group’s sovereign exposures to these countries were not considered impaired at 30 June 2012.

15. Contingent liabilities and commitments

 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Contingent liabilities
                     
Guarantees and assets pledged
  as collateral security
21,706 
802 
22,508 
 
22,660 
921 
23,581 
 
23,702 
1,330 
25,032 
Other contingent liabilities
11,234 
232 
11,466 
 
11,582 
223 
11,805 
 
10,667 
245 
10,912 
                       
 
32,940 
1,034 
33,974 
 
34,242 
1,144 
35,386 
 
34,369 
1,575 
35,944 
                       
Commitments
                     
Undrawn formal standby
  facilities, credit lines and
  other commitments to lend
221,091 
6,941 
228,032 
 
225,237 
11,575 
236,812 
 
227,419 
12,544 
239,963 
Other commitments
1,303 
70 
1,373 
 
666 
1,919 
2,585 
 
301 
2,611 
2,912 
                       
 
222,394 
7,011 
229,405 
 
225,903 
13,494 
239,397 
 
227,720 
15,155 
242,875 
                       
Total contingent liabilities
  and commitments
255,334 
8,045 
263,379 
 
260,145 
14,638 
274,783 
 
262,089 
16,730 
278,819 

Additional contingent liabilities arise in the normal course of the Group’s business. It is not anticipated that any material loss will arise from these transactions.

 
112

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews
The Group and certain Group members are party to legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory matters in the United Kingdom, the United States and other jurisdictions, arising out of their normal business operations. All such matters are periodically reassessed with the assistance of external professional advisers, where appropriate, to determine the likelihood of the Group incurring a liability. The Group recognises a provision for a liability in relation to these matters when it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle an obligation which has arisen as a result of past events, and for which a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.

In many proceedings, it is not possible to determine whether any loss is probable or to estimate the amount of any loss. Numerous legal and factual issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings in question, before a liability can be reasonably estimated for any claim. The Group cannot predict if, how, or when such claims will be resolved or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, may be, particularly for claims that are at an early stage in their development or where claimants seek substantial or indeterminate damages.

While the outcome of the legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory matters in which the Group is involved is inherently uncertain, management believes that, based on the information available to it, appropriate provisions have been made in respect of legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory matters as at 30 June 2012.

Other than as set out in the following sub-sections of this Note entitled ‘Litigation’ and ‘Investigations and reviews’, no member of the Group is or has been involved in any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings (including any such proceedings which are pending or threatened of which the Group is aware) during the 12 months prior to the date of this document which may have, or have had in the recent past, significant effects on the financial position or profitability of the Group.

In each of the material legal proceedings, investigations and reviews described below, unless specifically noted otherwise, it is not possible to reliably estimate with any certainty the liability, if any, or the effect these proceedings, investigations and reviews, and any related developments, may have on the Group. However, in the event that any such matters were resolved against the Group, these matters could, individually or in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Litigation
Set out below are descriptions of the material legal proceedings involving the Group.

Shareholder litigation
RBS and certain of its subsidiaries, together with certain current and former individual officers and directors have been named as defendants in purported class actions filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York involving holders of RBS preferred shares (the Preferred Shares litigation) and holders of American Depositary Receipts (the ADR claims).

 
113

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
In the Preferred Shares litigation, the consolidated amended complaint alleges certain false and misleading statements and omissions in public filings and other communications during the period 1 March 2007 to 19 January 2009, and variously asserts claims under Sections 11, 12 and 15 of the US Securities Act of 1933, as amended (Securities Act). The putative class is composed of all persons who purchased or otherwise acquired Group Series Q, R, S, T and/or U non-cumulative dollar preference shares issued pursuant or traceable to the 8 April 2005 US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) registration statement. Plaintiffs seek unquantified damages on behalf of the putative class. The defendants have moved to dismiss the complaint and briefing on the motions was completed in September 2011.

With respect to the ADR claims, a complaint was filed in January 2011 and a further complaint was filed in February 2011 asserting claims under Sections 10 and 20 of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (Exchange Act) on behalf of all persons who purchased or otherwise acquired the Group’s American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) between 1 March 2007 and 19 January 2009. On 18 August 2011, these two ADR cases were consolidated and lead plaintiff and lead counsel were appointed. On 1 November 2011, the lead plaintiff filed a consolidated amended complaint asserting ADR-related claims under Sections 10 and 20 of the Exchange Act and Sections 11, 12 and 15 of the Securities Act. The defendants moved to dismiss the complaint in January 2012 and briefing on the motions was completed in April 2012. The Court heard oral argument on the motions on 19 July 2012.

The Group has also received notification of similar prospective claims in the United Kingdom and elsewhere but no court proceedings have been commenced in relation to these claims. The Group recently submitted a detailed response to a letter before action from one purported plaintiff group in the United Kingdom.

The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to the remaining and prospective claims and will defend itself vigorously.

Other securitisation and securities related litigation in the United States
Recently, the level of litigation activity in the financial services industry focused on residential mortgage and credit crisis related matters has increased. As a result, the Group has become and expects that it may further be the subject of additional claims for damages and other relief regarding residential mortgages and related securities in the future.

Group companies have been named as defendants in their various roles as issuer, depositor and/or underwriter in a number of claims in the United States that relate to the securitisation and securities underwriting businesses. These cases include actions by individual purchasers of securities and purported class action suits. Together, the individual and class action cases involve the issuance of more than US$85 billion of mortgage-backed securities (MBS) issued primarily from 2005 to 2007. Although the allegations vary by claim, in general, plaintiffs in these actions claim that certain disclosures made in connection with the relevant offerings contained materially false or misleading statements and/or omissions regarding the underwriting standards pursuant to which the mortgage loans underlying the securities were issued. Group companies have been named as defendants in more than 30 lawsuits brought by purchasers of MBS, including five purported class actions. Among the lawsuits are six cases filed on 2 September 2011 by the US Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA) as conservator for the Federal National Mortgage Association (Fannie Mae) and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (Freddie Mac).

 
114

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
The primary FHFA lawsuit pending in the federal court in Connecticut relates to approximately US$32 billion of MBS for which Group entities acted as sponsor/depositor and/or lead underwriter or co-lead underwriter.

FHFA has also filed five separate lawsuits (against Ally Financial Group, Countrywide Financial Corporation, JP Morgan, Morgan Stanley and Nomura respectively) in which RBS Securities Inc. is named as a defendant by virtue of the fact that it was an underwriter of some of the securities at issue.

Other lawsuits against Group companies include two cases filed by the National Credit Union Administration Board (on behalf of US Central Federal Credit Union and Western Corporate Federal Credit Union) and eight cases filed by the Federal Home Loan Banks of Boston, Chicago, Indianapolis, Seattle and San Francisco.

The purported MBS class actions in which Group companies are defendants include New Jersey Carpenters Vacation Fund et al. v. The Royal Bank of Scotland plc et al.; New Jersey Carpenters Health Fund v. Novastar Mortgage Inc. et al.; In re IndyMac Mortgage-Backed Securities Litigation; Genesee County Employees’ Retirement System et al. v. Thornburg Mortgage Securities Trust 2006-3, et al.; and Luther v. Countrywide Financial Corp. et al. and related cases.

Certain other institutional investors have threatened to bring claims against the Group in connection with various mortgage-related offerings. The Group cannot predict with any certainty whether any of these individual investors will pursue these threatened claims (or their outcome), but expects that several may. If such claims are asserted and were successful, the amounts involved may be material. In many of these actions, the Group has or will have contractual claims to indemnification from the issuers of the securities (where a Group company is underwriter) and/or the underlying mortgage originator (where a Group company is issuer). The amount and extent of any recovery on an indemnification claim, however, is uncertain and subject to a number of factors, including the ongoing creditworthiness of the indemnifying party.

With respect to the current claims described above, the Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these claims and will continue to defend itself vigorously.

London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR)
Certain members of the Group have been named as defendants in a number of class actions and individual claims filed in the US with respect to the setting of LIBOR. The complaints are substantially similar and allege that certain members of the Group and other panel banks individually and collectively violated US commodities and antitrust laws and state common law by manipulating LIBOR and prices of LIBOR-based derivatives in various markets through various means. The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these and prospective claims. It is possible that further claims may be threatened or brought in the US or elsewhere relating to the setting of interest rates or interest rate-related trading.

Details of LIBOR investigations affecting the Group are set out under 'Investigations and reviews' on page 117.

 
115

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)

Madoff
In December 2010, Irving Picard, as trustee for the bankruptcy estates of Bernard L. Madoff and Bernard L. Madoff Investment Securities LLC filed a claim against RBS N.V. for approximately US$271 million. This is a clawback action similar to claims filed against six other institutions in December 2010. RBS N.V. (or its subsidiaries) invested in Madoff funds through feeder funds. The Trustee alleges that RBS N.V. received US$71 million in redemptions from the feeder funds and US$200 million from its swap counterparties while RBS N.V. ‘knew or should have known of Madoff’s possible fraud’. The Trustee alleges that those transfers were preferences or fraudulent conveyances under the US bankruptcy code and New York law and he asserts the purported right to claw them back for the benefit of Madoff’s estate. A further claim, for US$21.8 million, was filed in October 2011. The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these claims and intends to defend itself vigorously.

Unarranged overdraft charges
RBS Citizens Financial Group, Inc (RBS Citizens) and its affiliates were among more than thirty banks named as defendants in US class action lawsuits alleging that the manner in which defendant banks posted transactions to consumer accounts caused customers to incur excessive overdraft fees. The complaints against RBS Citizens, which concern the period between 2002 and 2010 and were consolidated into one case, alleged that this conduct violated its duty of good faith and fair dealing, was unconscionable and constituted an unfair trade practice and a conversion of customers' funds. RBS Citizens has agreed to settle this matter for US$137.5 million and, as a result, the matter has been stayed. The Group has made a provision for the settlement although payment has not yet been made, pending court approval. If the settlement is given final approval by the United States District Court for the Southern District of Florida, consumers who do not opt out of the settlement will be deemed to have released any claims related to the allegations in the lawsuits.

Summary of other disputes, legal proceedings and litigation
In addition to the matters described above, members of the Group are engaged in other legal proceedings in the United Kingdom and a number of overseas jurisdictions, including the United States, involving claims by and against them arising in the ordinary course of business. The Group has reviewed these other actual, threatened and known potential claims and proceedings and, after consulting with its legal advisers, does not expect that the outcome of any of these other claims and proceedings will have a significant effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

 
116

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)

Investigations and reviews
The Group’s businesses and financial condition can be affected by the fiscal or other policies and actions of various governmental and regulatory authorities in the United Kingdom, the European Union, the United States and elsewhere. The Group has engaged, and will continue to engage, in discussions with relevant government and regulatory authorities, including in the United Kingdom and the United States, on an ongoing and regular basis regarding operational, systems and control evaluations and issues including those related to compliance with applicable anti-bribery, anti-money laundering and sanctions regimes. It is possible that any matters discussed or identified may result in investigatory or other action being taken by governmental and regulatory authorities, increased costs being incurred by the Group, remediation of systems and controls, public or private censure, restriction of the Group’s business activities or fines. Any of these events or circumstances could have a significant effect on the Group, its business, authorisations and licences, reputation, results of operations or the price of securities issued by it.

Political and regulatory scrutiny of the operation of retail banking and consumer credit industries in the United Kingdom, United States and elsewhere continues. The nature and impact of future changes in policies and regulatory action are not predictable and are beyond the Group’s control but could have a significant effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

The Group is co-operating fully with the investigations, reviews and proceedings described below.

LIBOR
The Group continues to co-operate fully with investigations by various governmental and regulatory authorities into its submissions, communications and procedures relating to the setting of LIBOR and other interest rates. The relevant authorities include, amongst others, the US Commodity Futures Trading Commission, the US Department of Justice (Fraud Division), the FSA and the Japanese Financial Services Agency. The Group has dismissed a number of employees for misconduct as a result of its investigations into these matters.

The Group is also under investigation by competition authorities in a number of jurisdictions, including the European Commission, Department of Justice (Antitrust Division) and Canadian Competition Bureau, stemming from the actions of certain individuals in the setting of LIBOR and other interest rates, as well as interest rate-related trading. The Group is also co-operating fully with these investigations.

It is not possible to reliably measure what effect these investigations, any regulatory findings and any related developments may have on the Group, including the timing and amount of fines or settlements.

 
117

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)

Technology incident
On 19 June 2012, the Group was affected by a technology incident as a result of which the processing of certain customer accounts and payments were subject to considerable delay. The cause of the incident has been investigated by independent external counsel with the assistance of third party advisors. The Group has agreed to reimburse customers for any loss suffered as a result of the incident and has made a provision of £125 million in its Q2 2012 results for this matter. Additional costs may arise once all redress and business disruption items are clear and a further update will be given in Q3.

The incident, the Group's handling of the incident and the systems and controls surrounding the processes affected, are the subject of regulatory enquiries (both from the UK and Ireland) and the Group could become a party to litigation. In particular, the Group could face legal claims from those whose accounts were affected and could itself have claims against third parties.

Interest rate hedging products
In June 2012, following an industry wide review, the FSA announced that the Group and other UK banks had agreed to a redress exercise and past business review in relation to the sale of interest rate hedging products to some small and medium sized businesses who were classified as retail clients under FSA rules.

The Group will provide fair and reasonable redress to non-sophisticated customers classified as retail clients, who were sold structured collars. The Group has made a provision of £50 million in its Q2 2012 results for the redress it expects to offer to these customers. As the actual amount that the Group will be required to pay will depend on the facts and circumstances of each case, there is no certainty as to the eventual costs of redress.

The Group will also write to non-sophisticated customers classified as retail clients sold other interest rate products (other than interest rate caps) on or after 1 December 2001 offering a review of their sale and, if it is appropriate in the individual circumstances, the Group will propose fair and reasonable redress on a case by case basis. Furthermore, non-sophisticated customers classified as retail clients who have purchased interest rate caps will be entitled to approach the Group and request a review. At this stage, the Group is not able to estimate reliably the cost of redress for these customers.

The redress exercise and the past business review will be scrutinised by an independent reviewer, who will review and agree any redress, and will be overseen by the FSA.

 
118

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)

Retail banking
In the European Union, regulatory actions included an inquiry into retail banking initiated on 13 June 2005 in all of the then 25 member states by the European Commission’s Directorate General for Competition. The inquiry examined retail banking in Europe generally. On 31 January 2007, the European Commission (EC) announced that barriers to competition in certain areas of retail banking, payment cards and payment systems in the European Union had been identified. The EC indicated that it will consider using its powers to address these barriers and will encourage national competition authorities to enforce European and national competition laws where appropriate. In addition, in late 2010, the EC launched an initiative pressing for increased transparency in respect of bank fees. The EC is currently proposing to legislate for the increased harmonisation of terminology across Member States, with proposals expected later in 2012. The Group cannot predict the outcome of these actions at this stage and is unable reliably to estimate the effect, if any, that these may have on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Multilateral interchange fees
In 2007, the EC issued a decision that, while interchange is not illegal per se, MasterCard’s current multilateral interchange fee (MIF) arrangements for cross border payment card transactions with MasterCard and Maestro branded consumer credit and debit cards in the European Union are in breach of competition law. MasterCard was required by the decision to withdraw the relevant cross-border MIF (i.e. set these fees to zero) by 21 June 2008.

MasterCard appealed against the decision to the European Court of First Instance (subsequently re-named the General Court) in March 2008, and the Group intervened in the appeal proceedings. In addition, in summer 2008, MasterCard announced various changes to its scheme arrangements. The EC was concerned that these changes might be used as a means of circumventing the requirements of the infringement decision. In April 2009, MasterCard agreed an interim settlement on the level of cross-border MIF with the EC pending the outcome of the appeal process and, as a result, the EC advised it would no longer investigate the non-compliance issue. The General Court heard MasterCard’s appeal in July 2011 and issued its judgment on 24 May 2012, upholding the EC’s original decision. The Group understands that MasterCard has appealed further and is considering the basis of MasterCard's appeal and whether the Group should intervene in the proceedings.

Visa’s cross-border MIFs were exempted in 2002 by the EC for a period of five years up to 31 December 2007 subject to certain conditions. In March 2008, the EC opened a formal inquiry into Visa’s current MIF arrangements for cross border payment card transactions with Visa branded debit and consumer credit cards in the European Union and in April 2009 the EC announced that it had issued Visa with a formal Statement of Objections. At the same time Visa announced changes to its interchange levels and introduced some changes to enhance transparency. There is no deadline for the closure of the inquiry. However, in April 2010 Visa announced it had reached an agreement with the EC as regards immediate cross border debit card MIF rates only and in December 2010 the commitments were finalised for a four year period commencing December 2010 under Article 9 of Regulation 1/2003. The EC is continuing its investigations into Visa’s cross border MIF arrangements for deferred debit and credit transactions. On 31 July 2012 the EC announced that it has issued a Supplementary Statement of Objections regarding consumer credit cards in the EEA. The EC's preliminary view is that these MIFs restrict competition between banks and infringe European antitrust rules.



 
119

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
In the UK, the Office of Fair Trading (OFT) has carried out investigations into Visa and MasterCard domestic credit card interchange rates. The decision by the OFT in the MasterCard interchange case was set aside by the Competition Appeal Tribunal (CAT) in June 2006. The OFT’s investigations in the Visa interchange case and a second MasterCard interchange case are ongoing. In February 2007, the OFT announced that it was expanding its investigation into domestic interchange rates to include debit cards. In January 2010 the OFT advised that it did not anticipate issuing a Statement of Objections prior to the General Court’s judgment. The OFT has advised that it is currently reviewing the implications of the European General Court judgment for its own investigations and that it will issue a project update in due course.

The outcome of these investigations is not known, but they may have a significant effect on the consumer credit industry in general and, therefore, on the Group’s business in this sector.

Payment Protection Insurance
In January 2009, the Competition Commission (CC) announced its intention to order a range of remedies in relation to Payment Protection Insurance (PPI), including a prohibition on actively selling PPI at point of sale of the credit product (and for 7 days thereafter), a ban on single premium policies and other measures to increase transparency (in order to improve customers’ ability to search and improve price competition). In October 2010, the CC published its final decision on remedies which confirmed the point of sale prohibition. In March 2011, the CC issued a final order setting out its remedies with a commencement date of 6 April 2011. The key remedies came into force in two parts, in October 2011 and April 2012.

The FSA conducted a broad industry thematic review of PPI sales practices and in September 2008, the FSA announced that it intended to escalate its level of regulatory intervention. Substantial numbers of customer complaints alleging the mis-selling of PPI policies have been made to banks and to the Financial Ombudsman Service (FOS) and many of these are being upheld by the FOS against the banks.

The FSA published a final policy statement in August 2010 imposing significant changes with respect to the handling of complaints about the mis-selling of PPI. In October 2010, the British Bankers’ Association (BBA) filed an application for judicial review of the FSA’s policy statement and of related guidance issued by the FOS. In April 2011 the High Court issued judgment in favour of the FSA and the FOS and in May 2011 the BBA announced that it would not appeal that judgment. The Group then recorded an additional provision of £850 million in respect of PPI. In the first half of 2012 an additional provision of £260 million was recorded, with an overall total of £1.3 billion accrued as at 30 June 2012. During 2011, the Group reached agreement with the FSA on a process for implementation of its policy statement and for the future handling of PPI complaints. Implementation of the agreed processes is currently under way.

Personal current accounts
On 16 July 2008, the OFT published the results of its market study into Personal Current Accounts (PCA) in the United Kingdom. The OFT found evidence of competition and several positive features in the PCA market but believed that the market as a whole was not working well for consumers and that the ability of the market to function well had become distorted.


 
120

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
On 7 October 2009, the OFT published a follow-up report summarising the initiatives agreed between the OFT and PCA providers to address the OFT’s concerns about transparency and switching, following its market study. PCA providers will take a number of steps to improve transparency, including providing customers with an annual summary of the cost of their account and making charges prominent on monthly statements. To improve the switching process, a number of steps are being introduced following work with Bacs, the payment processor, including measures to reduce the impact on consumers of any problems with transferring direct debits.

On 22 December 2009, the OFT published a further report in which it stated that it continued to have significant concerns about the operation of the PCA market in the United Kingdom, in particular in relation to unarranged overdrafts, and that it believed that fundamental changes are required for the market to work in the best interests of bank customers. The OFT stated that it would discuss these issues intensively with banks, consumer groups and other organisations, with the aim of reporting on progress by the end of March 2010. On 16 March 2010, the OFT announced that it had secured agreement from the banks on four industry-wide initiatives, namely minimum standards on the operation of opt-outs from unarranged overdrafts, new working groups on information sharing with customers, best practice for PCA customers in financial difficulties and incurring charges, and PCA providers to publish their policies on dealing with PCA customers in financial difficulties. The OFT also announced its plan to conduct six-monthly ongoing reviews, to review the market again fully in 2012 and to undertake a brief analysis on barriers to entry.

The first six-monthly ongoing review was completed in September 2010. The OFT noted progress in the areas of switching, transparency and unarranged overdrafts for the period March to September 2010, as well as highlighting further changes the OFT expected to see in the market. In March 2011, the OFT published its update report in relation to PCAs. This noted further progress in improving consumer control over the use of unarranged overdrafts. In particular, the Lending Standards Board had led on producing standards and guidance to be included in a revised Lending Code. The OFT stated it would continue to monitor the market and would consider the need for, and appropriate timing of, further update reports in light of other developments, in particular the work of the UK Government’s Independent Commission on Banking (ICB).

In May 2010, the OFT announced its review of barriers to entry. The review concerned retail banking for individuals and small and medium size enterprises (up to £25 million turnover) and looked at products which require a banking licence to sell mortgages, loan products and, where appropriate, other products such as insurance or credit cards where cross-selling may facilitate entry or expansion. The OFT published its report in November 2010. It advised that it expected its review to be relevant to the ICB, the FSA, HM Treasury and the Department for Business, Innovation and Skills and to the devolved governments in the United Kingdom. The OFT did not indicate whether it would undertake any further work. The report maintained that barriers to entry remain, in particular regarding switching, branch networks and brands. At this stage, it is not possible to estimate the effect of the OFT’s report and recommendations regarding barriers to entry upon the Group.

 
121

 

Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
On 13 July 2012, the OFT launched its planned review of the PCA market. The review will look at whether the initiatives agreed by the OFT with banks have been successful. The OFT has also announced a wider programme of work on retail banking and will consider the operation of the payment systems and the banking market for SMEs. The PCA review and wider programme of work are aimed at informing the OFT’s response to the Independent Commission on Banking’s recommendation that the OFT consider making a reference to the Competition Commission by 2015 if it had not already done so and if sufficient improvements in the market have not been made by that time.

Private motor insurance
In December 2011, the OFT launched a market study into private motor insurance, with a focus on the provision of third party vehicle repairs and credit hire replacement vehicles to claimants. The OFT issued its report on 31 May 2012 and has advised that it believes there are features of the market that potentially restrict, distort or prevent competition in the market and that would merit a referral to the Competition Commission (CC). The OFT’s particular focus is on credit hire replacement vehicles and third party vehicle repairs. Following publication of the consultation, which closed on 6 July 2012, the Group is awaiting the OFT’s decision on whether to refer the market to the CC. If a referral is made, this is likely to take place in the second half of 2012. At this stage, it is not possible to estimate with any certainty the effect the market study and any related developments may have on the Group.

Independent Commission on Banking
Following an interim report published on 11 April 2011, the ICB published its final report to the Cabinet Committee on Banking Reform on 12 September 2011 (Final Report). The Final Report makes a number of recommendations, including in relation to (i) the implementation of a ring-fence of retail banking operations, (ii) loss-absorbency (including bail-in) and (iii) competition.

On 19 December 2011, the UK Government published a response to the Final Report (the ‘Response’), reaffirming its intention to accept the majority of the ICB’s recommendations. The Government agreed that “vital banking services - in particular the taking of retail deposits - should only be provided by ‘ring-fenced banks’, and that these banks should be prohibited from undertaking certain investment banking activities.” It also broadly accepted the ICB’s recommendations on loss absorbency and on competition.

Following an extensive first consultation, the UK Government published a White Paper on 14 June 2012 (White Paper), setting out its more detailed proposals for implementing the ICB’s recommendations. Its intention remains to complete primary and secondary legislation before the end of the current Parliamentary term in May 2015 and for banks to comply with all the measures proposed in the paper by 2019, as the ICB recommended. The Government also reaffirmed its determination that changes to the account switching process should be completed by September 2013, as already scheduled. A further period of consultation has now been established, which runs until 6 September 2012.

The content of the White Paper was broadly in line with expectations following the Response, with ring-fencing to be implemented as set out in the ICB recommendations and loss-absorbency requirements also largely consistent.


 
122

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
With regard to the competition aspects, the White Paper supports the Payment Council proposals to increase competition by making account switching easier and confirms that the Bank of England and the FSA will publish reviews on how prudential standards and conduct requirements can be a barrier to market entry. The White Paper also urges the OFT to consider what further transparency measures would be appropriate during its review of the PCA market in the second half of this year and a consultation regarding the structure of UK Payments Council is recommended.

While the UK Government’s White Paper provides some additional detail, until the further consultation is concluded and significantly more is known on the precise detail of the legislative and regulatory framework it is not possible to estimate the potential impact of these measures with any level of precision.

The Group will continue to participate in the debate and to consult with the UK Government on the implementation of the proposals set out in the White Paper, the effects of which could have a negative impact on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Securitisation and collateralised debt obligation business
In the United States, the Group is involved in reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by federal and state governmental law enforcement and other agencies and self-regulatory organisations relating to, among other things, mortgage-backed securities, collateralised debt obligations (CDOs), and synthetic products. In connection with these inquiries, Group companies have received requests for information and subpoenas seeking information about, among other things, the structuring of CDOs, financing to loan originators, purchase of whole loans, sponsorship and underwriting of securitisations, due diligence, representations and warranties, communications with ratings agencies, disclosure to investors, document deficiencies, and repurchase requests.

In September and October 2010, the SEC requested voluntary production of information concerning residential mortgage-backed securities underwritten by subsidiaries of RBS during the period from September 2006 to July 2007 inclusive. In November 2010, the SEC commenced a formal investigation. The investigation is in its preliminary stages and it is not possible to predict any potential exposure that may result.

Also in October 2010, the SEC commenced an inquiry into document deficiencies and repurchase requests with respect to certain securitisations, and in January 2011, this was converted to a formal investigation. Among other matters, the investigation seeks information related to document deficiencies and remedial measures taken with respect to such deficiencies. The investigation also seeks information related to early payment defaults and loan repurchase requests.

In 2007, the New York State Attorney General issued subpoenas to a wide array of participants in the securitisation and securities industry, focusing on the information underwriters obtained from the independent firms hired to perform due diligence on mortgages. The Group completed its production of documents requested by the New York State Attorney General in 2008, principally producing documents related to loans that were pooled into one securitisation transaction. In May 2011, at the New York State Attorney General's request, representatives of the Group attended an informal meeting to provide additional information about the Group's mortgage securitisation business. The investigation is ongoing and the Group continues to provide requested information.

 
123

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
In September 2010, RBS subsidiaries received a request from the Nevada State Attorney General requesting information related to securitisations of mortgages issued by three specific originators. The investigation by the Nevada State Attorney General continues. It is not expected to have a material adverse effect on the Group’s net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

US mortgages - loan repurchase matters
The Group’s Markets & International Banking N.A. or M&IB N.A. business (formerly Global Banking & Markets N.A.) has been a purchaser of non-agency US residential mortgages in the secondary market, and an issuer and underwriter of non-agency residential mortgage-backed securities (RMBS). M&IB N.A. did not originate or service any US residential mortgages and it was not a significant seller of mortgage loans to government sponsored enterprises (GSEs) (e.g., the Federal National Mortgage Association and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Association).

In issuing RMBS, M&IB N.A. generally assigned certain representations and warranties regarding the characteristics of the underlying loans made by the originator of the residential mortgages; however, in some circumstances, M&IB N.A. made such representations and warranties itself. Where M&IB N.A. has given those or other representations and warranties (whether relating to underlying loans or otherwise), M&IB N.A. may be contractually required to repurchase such loans or indemnify certain parties against losses for certain breaches of such representations and warranties. In certain instances where it is required to repurchase loans or related securities, M&IB N.A. may be able to assert claims against third parties who provided representations or warranties to M&IB N.A. when selling loans to it; although the ability to recover against such parties is uncertain. Between the start of 2009 and the end of June 2012, M&IB N.A. received approximately US$512 million in repurchase demands in respect of loans made primarily from 2005 to 2008 and related securities sold where obligations in respect of contractual representations or warranties were undertaken by M&IB N.A..

However, repurchase demands presented to M&IB N.A. are subject to challenge and, to date, M&IB N.A. has rebutted a significant percentage of these claims.

RBS Citizens has not been an issuer or underwriter of non-agency RMBS. However, RBS Citizens is an originator and servicer of residential mortgages, and it routinely sells such mortgage loans in the secondary market and to GSEs. In the context of such sales, RBS Citizens makes certain representations and warranties regarding the characteristics of the underlying loans and, as a result, may be contractually required to repurchase such loans or indemnify certain parties against losses for certain breaches of the representations and warranties concerning the underlying loans. Between the start of 2009 and the end of June 2012, RBS Citizens received US$69.1 million in repurchase demands in respect of loans originated primarily since 2003. However, repurchase demands presented to RBS Citizens are subject to challenge and, to date, RBS Citizens has rebutted a significant percentage of these claims.

Although there has been disruption in the ability of certain financial institutions operating in the United States to complete foreclosure proceedings in respect of US mortgage loans in a timely manner (or at all) over the last year (including as a result of interventions by certain states and local governments), to date, RBS Citizens has not been materially impacted by such disruptions and the Group has not ceased making foreclosures.

 
124

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
The volume of repurchase demands is increasing and is expected to continue to increase, and the Group cannot currently estimate what the ultimate exposure of M&IB N.A. or RBS Citizens may be. Furthermore, the Group is unable to estimate the extent to which the matters described above will impact it, and future developments may have an adverse impact on the Group’s net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Other investigations
The Federal Reserve and state banking supervisors have been reviewing the Group's US operations and RBS and its subsidiaries have been required to make improvements with respect to various matters, including enterprise-wide governance, US Bank Secrecy Act and anti-money laundering compliance, risk management and asset quality. The Group is in the process of implementing measures for matters identified to date.

On 27 July 2011, the Group consented to the issuance of a Cease and Desist Order (the Order) setting forth measures required to address deficiencies related to governance, risk management and compliance systems and controls identified by the Federal Reserve and state banking supervisors during examinations of the RBS plc and RBS N.V. branches in 2010. The Order requires the Group to strengthen its US corporate governance structure, to develop an enterprise-wide risk management programme, and to develop and enhance its programmes to ensure compliance with US law, particularly the US Bank Secrecy Act and anti-money laundering laws, rules and regulations. The Group has established a strategic and remedial programme of change to address the identified concerns and is committed to working closely with the US bank regulators to implement the remedial measures required by the Order.

The Group’s operations include businesses outside the United States that are responsible for processing US dollar payments. The Group is conducting a review of its policies, procedures and practices in respect of such payments and has initiated discussions with UK and US authorities to discuss its historical compliance with applicable laws and regulations, including US economic sanctions regulations. Although the Group cannot currently determine when the review of its operations will be completed or what the outcome of its discussions with UK and US authorities will be, the investigation costs, remediation required or liability incurred could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

The Group may become subject to formal and informal supervisory actions and may be required by its US banking supervisors to take further actions and implement additional remedial measures with respect to these and additional matters. Any limitations or conditions placed on the Group's activities in the United States, as well as the terms of any supervisory action applicable to RBS and its subsidiaries, could have a material adverse effect on the Group's net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

In July 2010, the FSA notified the Group that it was commencing an investigation into the sale by Coutts & Co of the ALICO (American Life Insurance Company) Premier Access Bond Enhanced Variable Rate Fund (EVRF) to customers between 2001 and 2008 as well as its subsequent review of those sales. Subsequently, on 11 January 2011 the FSA revised the investigation start date to December 2003.

 
125

 
Notes (continued)

16. Litigation, investigations and reviews (continued)
On 8 November 2011, the FSA published its Final Notice having reached a settlement with Coutts & Co, under which Coutts & Co agreed to pay a fine of £6.3 million. The FSA did not make any findings on the suitability of advice given in individual cases. Nonetheless, Coutts & Co has agreed to undertake a past business review of its sales of the product. This review is being overseen by an independent third party and considers the advice given to customers invested in the EVRF as at the date of its suspension, 15 September 2008. For any sales which are found to be unsuitable, redress will be paid to the customers to ensure that they have not suffered financially.

On 26 March 2012, the FSA published a Final Notice that it had reached a settlement with Coutts & Co under which Coutts agreed to pay a fine of £8.75 million. This follows an investigation by the FSA into Coutts & Co’s anti-money laundering (AML) systems and controls in relation to high risk clients. The fine relates to historic activity undertaken between December 2007 and November 2010.

Coutts & Co has cooperated fully and openly with the FSA throughout the investigation. Coutts & Co has accepted the findings contained in the FSA's Final Notice regarding certain failures to meet the relevant regulatory standards between December 2007 and November 2010. Coutts & Co has found no evidence that money laundering took place during that time.

Since concerns were first identified by the FSA, Coutts & Co has enhanced its client relationship management process which included a review of its AML procedures, and is confident in its current processes and procedures.

On 18 January 2012, the FSA published its Final Notice having reached a settlement with U K Insurance Limited for breaches of Principle 2 by Direct Line and Churchill (the Firms), under which U K Insurance Limited agreed to pay a fine of £2.17 million. The Firms were found to have acted without due skill, care and diligence in the way that they responded to the FSA's request to provide it with a sample of their closed complaint files. The Firms' breaches of Principle 2 did not result in any customer detriment.

In March 2008, the Group was advised by the SEC that it had commenced a non-public, formal investigation relating to the Group’s United States sub-prime securities exposures and United States residential mortgage exposures. In December 2010, the SEC contacted the Group and indicated that it would also examine valuations of various RBS N.V. structured products, including CDOs. With respect to the latter inquiry, in March 2012, the SEC communicated to the Group that it had completed its investigation and that it did not, as of the date of that communication and based upon the information then in its possession, intend to recommend any enforcement action against RBS.

17. Other developments
Proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to The Royal Bank of Scotland plc (RBS plc)
On 19 April 2011, the Group announced its intention to transfer a substantial part of the business activities of The Royal Bank of Scotland N.V. (RBS N.V.) to RBS plc (the "Proposed Transfers"), subject, amongst other matters, to regulatory and other approvals, further tax and other analysis in respect of the assets and liabilities to be transferred and employee consultation procedures.

 
126

 
Notes (continued)

17. Other developments (continued)
It is expected that the Proposed Transfers will be implemented on a phased basis over a period ending 31 December 2013. The transfer of substantially all of the UK business was completed during Q4 2011. A large part of the remainder of the Proposed Transfers is expected to have taken place by the end of 2012.

On 26 March 2012, the Boards of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc (RBSG), RBS plc, RBS Holdings N.V., RBS N.V. and RBS II B.V. announced that (1) RBS N.V. (as the demerging company) and RBS II B.V. (as the acquiring company) filed a proposal with the Dutch Trade Register for a legal demerger and (2) following a preliminary hearing at the Court of Session in Scotland, RBS plc and RBS II B.V. made filings with Companies House in the UK and the Dutch Trade Register respectively for a proposed cross-border merger of RBS II B.V. into RBS plc (“the Dutch Scheme”).

Upon implementation of these proposals, a substantial part of the business conducted by RBS N.V. in the Netherlands as well as in certain EMEA branches of RBS N.V. will be transferred to RBS plc. Implementation will be by the demerger of the transferring businesses into RBS II B.V. by way of a Dutch statutory demerger followed by the merger of RBS II B.V. into RBS plc through a cross-border merger. RBS plc and RBS N.V. have discussed the transfer in detail with De Nederlandsche Bank and the Financial Services Authority.

On 18 June 2012, the Court of Session in Scotland made an order approving the completion of the Merger. This order fixed the effective date of the Merger and its effects as 9 July 2012.

On 4 July 2012, it was announced that RBSG, RBS plc, RBS Holdings N.V., RBS N.V. and RBS II B.V. had decided that, as a result of technology issues which affected the RBS Group in the UK and Ireland, it would be prudent to defer the implementation of the Dutch Scheme. On 20 July 2012, it was announced that the Dutch Scheme is now expected to be implemented on 10 September 2012, subject to (among other matters) regulatory approvals and the approval of the Court of Session in Scotland.

Rating agencies
On 15 February 2012, the rating agency Moody’s Investor Service (“Moody’s”) placed on review for possible downgrade, or extended reviews on, the ratings of 114 European banks and 17 firms with global capital markets activities. Included in the rating reviews were the ratings of RBS and certain subsidiaries. Moody’s cited three reasons for their reviews across all of the affected firms; (i) the adverse and prolonged impact of the euro area crisis; (ii) the deteriorating creditworthiness of euro area sovereigns; and (iii) the substantial challenges faced by banks and securities firms with significant capital market activities.

On 22 February 2012, Moody’s also placed on review for possible downgrade selected ratings of North American bank subsidiaries of European banks. Included in these rating actions were the ratings of RBS Citizens, N.A. and Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania.

 
127

 
Notes (continued)

17. Other developments (continued)
Moody’s completed its ratings review on the Group on 21 June 2012. As a result the agency downgraded RBS Group plc’s long-term ratings by one-notch (short-term ratings were affirmed unchanged) whilst downgrading ratings of RBS plc, NatWest Plc, RBS N.V., RBS Citizens, N.A. and Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania by one-notch: long term ratings and short term ratings. The long term ratings of Ulster Bank Ltd and Ulster Bank Ireland Ltd were downgraded by one-notch whilst the short-term ratings of these entities were affirmed as unchanged.

The outlook on RBS plc’s standalone rating is now stable reflecting Moody’s view that capital markets-related risk factors have now been fully incorporated into the bank’s standalone rating. The outlook on RBS plc’s long-term rating is negative (in line with other large UK banks) reflecting Moody’s’ view that government support for large UK banks may be lowered in the medium term.

There was very limited impact from these downgrades given the underlying robust improvement in the Group’s liquidity, funding and capital position.

On 17 July 2012, Fitch affirmed its ratings on the Group and its subsidiaries. Fitch’s ratings outlooks were also affirmed as unchanged at this time except for the outlook on Ulster Bank Ireland Ltd which was changed to Negative from Stable. This Negative outlook is in line with the outlook on the sovereign (Republic of Ireland).

No material rating actions have been undertaken on the Group or its subsidiaries by Standard & Poor’s since the start of the year.
 
 
128

 
Notes (continued)

18. Related party transactions
UK Government
The UK Government and bodies controlled or jointly controlled by the UK Government and bodies over which it has significant influence are related parties of the Group. The Group enters into transactions with many of these bodies on an arm’s length basis.

Asset Protection Scheme
The Group is party to the UK Government’s Asset Protection Scheme (APS). Under the APS the Group purchased credit protection over a portfolio of specified assets and exposures (covered assets) from Her Majesty’s Treasury. The contract is accounted for as a derivative financial instrument and recognised as a liability at a fair value of £25 million (31 December 2011 - £231 million). Changes in fair value of £45 million (2011 - £906 million) were charged to profit or loss (Income from trading activities).

Government credit and asset-backed securities guarantee schemes
Under these schemes the UK Government guarantees eligible debt issued by qualifying institutions for a fee. During the first half of 2012 the Group repaid all its borrowings under these schemes. At 31 December 2011, the amount outstanding was £21.3 billion.

Bank of England facilities
In the ordinary course of business, the Group may from time to time access market-wide facilities provided by the Bank of England.

National Loan Guarantee Scheme
Under the UK Government's National Loan Guarantee Scheme, launched on 20 March 2012, eligible customers receive a 1 per cent discount on their funding rate. Up to 30 June 2012, the Group had provided loans and asset finance facilities of £470 million under this scheme.
 
The Group’s other transactions with the UK Government include the payment of taxes, principally UK corporation tax and value added tax; national insurance contributions; local authority rates; and regulatory fees and levies (including the bank levy and FSCS levies).

Other related parties
(a) In their roles as providers of finance, Group companies provide development and other types of capital support to businesses. These investments are made in the normal course of business and on arm's length terms. In some instances, the investment may extend to ownership or control over 20% or more of the voting rights of the investee company. However, these investments are not considered to give rise to transactions of a materiality requiring disclosure under IAS 24.

(b) The Group recharges The Royal Bank of Scotland Group Pension Fund with the cost of administration services incurred by it. The amounts involved are not material to the Group.

Full details of the Group’s related party transactions for the year ended 31 December 2011 are included in the Group’s 2011 Annual Report.

 
129

 
Notes (continued)


19. Post balance sheet events
There have been no significant events between 30 June 2012 and the date of approval of this announcement which would require a change to or additional disclosure in the announcement.
 
20. Consolidating financial information
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc ('RBS plc') is a wholly owned subsidiary of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc ('RBSG plc') and is able to offer and sell certain securities in the US from time to time pursuant to a registration statement on Form F-3 filed with the SEC with a full and unconditional guarantee from RBSG plc. RBS plc utilises an exception provided in Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X, and therefore does not file its financial statements with the SEC. In accordance with the requirements to qualify for the exception, presented below is condensed consolidating financial information for:

-  
RBSG plc on a stand-alone basis as guarantor
-  
RBS plc on a stand-alone basis as issuer
-  
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries of RBSG Company and RBS Company on a combined basis ('Subsidiaries')
-  
Consolidation adjustments; and
-  
RBSG plc consolidated amounts ('RBSG Group').

Under IAS 27, RBSG plc and RBS plc account for investments in their subsidiary undertakings at cost less impairment. Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X requires a company to account for its investments in subsidiary undertakings using the equity method, which would increase/(decrease) the results for the period of RBSG plc and RBS plc in the information below by £(1,954) million and £(140) million respectively for the six months ended 30 June 2012 and by (£1,654) million and £(1,349) million for the six months ended 30 June 2011).

The net assets of RBSG plc and RBS plc in the information below would also be increased/(decreased) by £14,325 million and £6,014 million respectively at 30 June 2012 (£15,430 million and £6,389 million at 31 December 2011).

The amounts in the tables below do not include amounts attributable to non-controlling interests.

Income statement
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Net interest income
219 
1,885 
3,736 
130 
5,970 
Non-interest income
90 
2,654 
1,839 
(1,157)
3,426 
Insurance net premium income
1,867 
1,867 
Total income
309 
4,539 
7,442 
(1,027)
11,263 
           
Operating expenses
(1)
(4,193)
(4,778)
78 
(8,894)
Insurance net claims
(1,225)
(1,225)
Impairment losses
(196)
(842)
(1,729)
118 
(2,649)
Operating profit/(loss) before tax
112 
(496)
(290)
(831)
(1,505)
Tax
(72)
(88)
(378)
109 
(429)
Profit/(loss)from continuing operations
40 
(584)
(668)
(722)
(1,934)
Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax
Profit/(loss)for the period
40 
(584)
(667)
(722)
(1,933)

 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Net interest income
261 
2,131 
4,097 
39 
6,528 
Non-interest income
54 
4,527 
2,306 
(358)
6,529 
Insurance net premium income
2,239 
2,239 
Total income
315 
6,658 
8,642 
(319)
15,296 
           
Operating expenses
(4,302)
(5,159)
129 
(9,332)
Insurance net claims
(1,705)
(1,705)
Impairment losses
(571)
(4,384)
(98)
(5,053)
Operating profit/(loss) before tax
315 
1,785 
(2,606)
(288)
(794)
Tax
(86)
(563)
(100)
104 
(645)
Profit/(loss) from continuing operations
229 
1,222 
(2,706)
(184)
(1,439)
Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax
31 
31 
Profit/(loss) for the period
229 
1,222 
(2,675)
(184)
(1,408)
 
Statement of comprehensive income
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
Profit/(loss) for the period
40 
(584)
(667)
(722)
(1,933)
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
         
Available-for-sale financial assets
(270)
217 
644 
591 
Cash flow hedges
413 
86 
196 
695 
Currency translation
20 
(277)
(239)
(496)
Actuarial losses on defined benefit plans
(2)
Other comprehensive income/(loss) before tax
163 
24 
603 
790 
Tax credit/(charge)
(46)
(218)
(256)
Other comprehensive income/(loss) after tax
171 
(22)
385 
534 
Total comprehensive income/(loss) for the period
40 
(413)
(689)
(337)
(1,399)
           
           
Total comprehensive income/(loss) is attributable to:
         
Non-controlling interests
(28)
15
(13)
Preference shareholders
76 
36 
181 
(217)
76 
Ordinary and B shareholders
(36) 
(449)
(842)
(135)
(1,462)
 
40 
(413)
(689)
(337)
(1,399)

 
130

 
 
Statement of comprehensive income
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
Profit/(loss) for the period
229 
1,222
(2,675)
(184)
(1,408)
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
         
Available-for-sale financial assets
241 
1,013 
115 
1,369 
Cash flow hedges
121 
150 
90 
361 
Currency translation
(13)
(682)
394 
(301)
Actuarial losses on defined benefit plans
(3)
Other comprehensive income/(loss) before tax
349 
478 
602 
1,429 
Tax (charge)/credit
(97)
(599)
204 
(492)
Other comprehensive income/(loss) after tax
252 
(121)
806 
937 
Total comprehensive income/(loss) for the period
229 
1,474 
(2,796)
622 
(471)
           
           
Total comprehensive income/(loss) is attributable to:
         
Non-controlling interests
26 
(32)
(6)
Preference shareholders
37 
102 
(139)
Ordinary and B shareholders
229 
1,437 
(2,924)
793 
(465)
 
229 
1,474 
(2,796)
622 
(471)

Balance sheets
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
At 30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Assets
         
Cash and balances at central banks
61,072 
17,575 
78,647 
Loans and advances to banks
21,004 
106,719 
309,820 
(360,402)
77,141 
Loans and advances to customers
2,774 
335,957 
299,017 
(142,587)
495,161 
Debt securities
1,525 
139,956 
90,843 
(44,698)
187,626 
Equity shares
9,306 
4,560 
(775)
13,091 
Investments in Group undertakings
53,897 
33,236 
12,106 
(99,239)
Settlement balances
9,461 
5,834 
17 
15,312 
Derivatives
1,403 
496,196 
21,732 
(32,899)
486,432 
Intangible assets
986 
7,157 
6,745 
14,888 
Property, plant and equipment
2,323 
9,005 
11,337 
Deferred tax
2,542 
840 
119 
3,502 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
22 
4,555 
9,295 
(2,889)
10,983 
Assets of disposal groups
18,650 
2,419 
21,069 
Total assets
80,626 
1,220,959 
790,203 
(676,599)
1,415,189 
           
Liabilities
         
Deposits by banks
1,416 
248,121 
222,589 
(365,382)
106,744 
Customer accounts
694 
256,050 
372,571 
(127,596)
501,719 
Debt securities in issue
9,020 
82,465 
70,176 
(41,806)
119,855 
Settlement balances
9,544 
5,582 
15,126 
Short positions
22,377 
17,001 
(1,002)
38,376 
Derivatives
489,876 
23,772 
(32,909)
480,745 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
793 
6,699 
4,196 
7,132 
18,820 
Retirement benefit liabilities
25 
264 
1,502 
1,791 
Deferred tax
2,196 
(381)
1,815 
Insurance liabilities
6,357 
(35)
6,322 
Subordinated liabilities
9,006 
29,298 
9,640 
(22,348)
25,596 
Liabilities of disposal groups
20,525 
2,539 
23,064 
Total liabilities
20,935 
1,164,980 
736,883 
(582,825)
1,339,973 
Non-controlling interests
1,461 
(261)
1,200 
Equity owners
59,691 
55,979 
51,859 
(93,513)
74,016 
           
Total equity
59,691 
55,979 
53,320 
(93,774)
75,216 
           
Total liabilities and equity
80,626 
1,220,959 
790,203 
(676,599)
1,415,189 
 
 
131

 
 
Balance sheets
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
At 31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Assets
         
Cash and balances at central banks
64,261 
15,008 
79,269 
Loans and advances to banks
18,368 
109,040 
352,420 
(396,518)
83,310 
Loans and advances to customers
4,056 
351,123 
316,881 
(156,454)
515,606 
Debt securities
1,568 
181,460 
102,311 
(76,259)
209,080 
Equity shares
10,486 
5,478 
(781)
15,183 
Investments in Group undertakings
53,871 
32,164 
12,107 
(98,142)
Settlement balances
4,059 
3,713 
(1)
7,771 
Derivatives
1,502 
537,297 
24,781 
(33,962)
529,618 
Intangible assets
876 
7,251 
6,731 
14,858 
Property, plant and equipment
2,244 
9,629 
(5)
11,868 
Deferred tax
2,584 
1,115 
178 
3,878 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
24 
5,338 
8,046 
(2,432)
10,976 
Assets of disposal groups
18,715 
6,709 
26 
25,450 
Total assets
79,390 
1,319,647 
865,449 
(757,619)
1,506,867 
           
Liabilities
         
Deposits by banks
1,091 
234,297 
235,983 
(362,567)
108,804 
Customer accounts
977 
296,902 
376,643 
(171,567)
502,955 
Debt securities in issue
8,373 
114,524 
113,307 
(73,583)
162,621 
Settlement balances
3,517 
3,960 
7,477 
Short positions
24,858 
16,950 
(769)
41,039 
Derivatives
79 
530,855 
27,011 
(33,962)
523,983 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
704 
8,840 
14,862 
(1,281)
23,125 
Retirement benefit liabilities
25 
423 
1,791 
2,239 
Deferred tax
2,381 
(436)
1,945 
Insurance liabilities
6,347 
(35)
6,312 
Subordinated liabilities
8,777 
30,014 
9,393 
(21,865)
26,319 
Liabilities of disposal groups
20,478 
3,517 
23,995 
Total liabilities
20,001 
1,264,310 
810,777 
(664,274)
1,430,814 
Non-controlling interests
1,570 
(336)
1,234 
Equity owners
59,389 
55,337 
53,102 
(93,009)
74,819 
           
Total equity
59,389 
55,337 
54,672 
(93,345)
76,053 
           
Total liabilities and equity
79,390 
1,319,647 
865,449 
(757,619)
1,506,867 
 
 
132

 
 
Cash Flow Statements
 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Net cash flows from operating activities
1,907 
(29,366)
18,767 
(8,415)
(17,107)
Net cash flows from investing activities
(1,000)
34,388
(18,285)
3,594 
18,697 
Net cash flows from financing activities
46 
692 
3,776 
(4,554)
(40)
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
(59)
(2,491)
(1,425)
867 
(3,108)
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
894 
3,223 
2,833 
(8,508)
(1,558)
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the period
1,883 
125,332 
185,013 
(159,573)
152,655 
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period
2,777 
128,555 
187,846 
(168,081)
151,097 


 
RBSG 
plc 
RBS 
plc 
Subsidiaries 
Consolidation 
Adjustments 
RBSG 
Group 
For the six months ended 30 June 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Net cash flows from operating activities
(455)
3,899 
11,101 
(6,293)
8,252 
Net cash flows from investing activities
193 
(3,064)
(3,686)
2,195 
(4,362)
Net cash flows from financing activities
(453)
(870)
1,612 
(1,501)
(1,212)
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
58 
1,009 
(1,099)
514 
482 
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
(657)
974 
7,928 
(5,085)
3,160 
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the period
2,357 
114,379 
169,284 
(133,490)
152,530 
           
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period
1,700 
115,353 
177,212 
(138,575)
155,690 
 
 
133

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management

 
General overview
The following table defines the main types of risk managed by the Group and presents a summary of the key developments for each risk in the first half of 2012.

Risk type
Definition
H1 2012 summary
Capital risk
The risk that the Group has insufficient capital.
The Core tier 1 ratio was 11.1%, despite regulatory changes increasing risk-weightings on various asset categories, particularly commercial real estate. The Group reduced RWAs in Markets and successfully restructured a large derivative position in Non-Core. Refer to the Capital section.
Liquidity and funding risk
The risk that the Group is unable to meet its financial liabilities as they fall due.
The Group maintained its trajectory towards a more stable deposit-led balance sheet with the loan:deposit ratio improving from 108% at 31 December 2011 to 104% at 30 June 2012. Short-term wholesale funding declined significantly from £102 billion at 31 December 2011 to £62 billion, covered 2.5 times by the liquidity buffer which was maintained at £156 billion. Refer to the Liquidity and funding risk section.
Credit risk (including counterparty risk)
The risk that the Group will incur losses owing to the failure of a customer to meet its obligation to settle outstanding amounts.
The Group’s credit performance improved; the H1 2012 impairment charge of £2.7 billion was 34% lower than the H1 2011 charge. This was despite continued economic stress within the eurozone, including Ireland, and depressed markets elsewhere. Progress continued in reducing key credit concentration risks, with exposure to commercial real estate 7% lower than at 31 December 2011. Refer to the Credit risk section.
Country risk
The risk of material losses arising from significant country-specific events.
Sovereign risk continues to increase, resulting in further rating downgrades for a number of countries, including several eurozone members. Total eurozone exposures decreased by 8% to £218 billion in H1 2012 and within that exposures to the periphery, fell by 10% to £69 billion. The Group participated in the Greek sovereign bond restructuring in March 2012 and sold all resulting new Greek sovereign bonds as well as parts of its Spanish and Portuguese bond holdings. A number of further advanced countries were brought under limit control and exposure to a range of countries was further reduced. Refer to the Country risk section.
 
 
134

 

Risk and balance sheet management

 
General overview (continued)

Risk type
Definition
H1 2012 summary
Market risk
The risk arising from changes in interest rates, foreign currency, credit spreads, equity prices and risk related factors such as market volatilities.
During H1 2012, the Group continued to manage down its market risk exposure in Non-Core through the disposal of assets and unwinding of trades. Refer to the Market risk section.
Insurance risk
The risk of financial loss through fluctuations in the timing, frequency and/or severity of insured events, relative to the expectations at the time of underwriting.
Direct Line Group introduced enhanced claims management systems and processes, improving its ability to handle and understand insured events. In addition, improvements in the Group's insurance risk policy, associated minimum standards and key risk indicators were implemented.
Operational risk
The risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes, people, systems or from external events.
The Group continued to focus on tight management of operational risks, particularly with regard to risk and control assessment (including change risk assessment), scenario analysis and statistical modelling for capital requirements. The level of operational risk remains high due to the continued scale of structural change occurring across the Group, the pace of regulatory change, the economic downturn and other external threats, such as e-crime.
 
During June 2012, the Group’s technology incident led to significant payment system disruption. A detailed investigation is underway into the root cause of the problem.
Compliance
risk
The risk arising from non-compliance with national and international laws, rules and regulations.
The Group agreed its conduct risk appetite and made significant progress towards finalising and embedding the associated policy framework and governance. In addition, Group-wide implementation of its Anti Money Laundering Change Programme continued.

 
135

 

Risk and balance sheet management

 
General overview (continued)

Risk type
Definition
H1 2012 summary
Reputational risk
The risk of brand damage arising from financial and non-financial events arising from the failure to meet stakeholders’ expectations of the Group’s performance and behaviour.
The Group Sustainability Committee oversaw further development of the Group's policies for environmental, social and ethical risks focusing on the power generation and gambling sectors. As part of the Group’s commitment to stakeholder engagement, the Group Sustainability Committee also met with key non-governmental organisations to discuss concerns over high profile issues including tax, oil and gas investment, corporate transparency and agricultural commodity trading.
 
The disruption experienced by customers due to the Group's recent technology incident has presented reputational risks. The Group has informed customers that they will not suffer financially as a result and is undertaking an independent review of the incident.
Business risk
The risk of lower-than-expected revenues and/or higher-than-expected operating costs.
Business risk is fully incorporated within the Group’s stress testing process through an analysis of the potential movement in revenues and operating costs under stress scenarios.
Pension risk
The risk that the Group will have to make additional contributions to its defined benefit pension schemes.
The Group continued to focus on improving pension risk management systems and modelling. This included the development of a policy setting out the governance framework for managing the Group’s risk as sponsor of its defined pension schemes.

 
136

 

Risk and balance sheet management

 
Balance sheet management

Capital
The Group aims to maintain an appropriate level of capital to meet its business needs and regulatory requirements. Capital adequacy and risk management are closely aligned. The Group’s risk-weighted assets and risk asset ratios, calculated in accordance with Financial Services Authority (FSA) definitions, are set out below.

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
Risk-weighted assets (RWAs) by risk
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Credit risk
334.8 
332.9 
344.3 
Counterparty risk
53.0 
56.8 
61.9 
Market risk
54.0 
61.0 
64.0 
Operational risk
45.8 
45.8 
37.9 
       
 
487.6 
496.5 
508.1 
Asset Protection Scheme relief
(52.9)
(62.2)
(69.1)
       
 
434.7 
434.3 
439.0 

Risk asset ratios
       
Core Tier 1
11.1 
10.8 
10.6 
Tier 1
13.4 
13.2 
13.0 
Total
14.6 
14.0 
13.8 

Key points
·
The Core Tier 1 ratio improved to 11.1% reflecting reductions in RWAs and capital deductions. Gross RWAs decreased by £20.5 billion in H1 2012, 4%, primarily in Markets and Non-Core.
   
·
Non-Core RWAs decreased by £10.6 billion as a result of sales, run-off, market risk movements and the impact of restructuring a large derivative exposure to a highly leveraged counterparty, which was partly offset by increases to regulatory risk-weightings.
   
·
In Markets, less market risk and a smaller balance sheet led to lower RWAs.
   
·
Market risk RWAs decreased by £10.0 billion in the first half of 2012 and £7.0 billion in Q2 2012 reflecting de-risking of the Non-Core portfolio and a reduction in trading VaR in both Markets and Non-Core.
   
·
The Asset Protection Scheme relief decreased by £16.2 billion in the first half of 2012, £9.3 billion in Q2 2012. This results from the £19.6 billion (Q2 2012 - £8.6 billion) drop in covered assets to £112.2 billion at 30 June 2012.

 
137

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Capital (continued)
The Group’s regulatory capital resources in accordance with FSA definitions were as follows:

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Shareholders’ equity (excluding non-controlling interests)
     
 Shareholders’ equity per balance sheet
74,016 
73,416 
74,819 
 Preference shares - equity
(4,313)
(4,313)
(4,313)
 Other equity instruments
(431)
(431)
(431)
 
69,272 
68,672 
70,075 
       
Non-controlling interests
     
 Non-controlling interests per balance sheet
1,200 
1,215 
1,234 
 Non-controlling preference shares
(548)
(548)
(548)
 Other adjustments to non-controlling interests for regulatory purposes
(259)
(259)
(259)
 
393 
408 
427 
       
Regulatory adjustments and deductions
     
 Own credit
(402)
(845)
(2,634)
 Unrealised losses on AFS debt securities
520 
547 
1,065 
 Unrealised gains on AFS equity shares
(70)
(108)
(108)
 Cash flow hedging reserve
(1,399)
(921)
(879)
 Other adjustments for regulatory purposes
637 
630 
571 
 Goodwill and other intangible assets
(14,888)
(14,771)
(14,858)
 50% excess of expected losses over impairment provisions (net of tax)
(2,329)
(2,791)
(2,536)
 50% of securitisation positions
(1,461)
(1,530)
(2,019)
 50% of APS first loss
(2,118)
(2,489)
(2,763)
 
(21,510)
(22,278)
(24,161)
       
Core Tier 1 capital
48,155 
46,802 
46,341 
       
Other Tier 1 capital
     
 Preference shares - equity
4,313 
4,313 
4,313 
 Preference shares - debt
1,082 
1,064 
1,094 
 Innovative/hybrid Tier 1 securities
4,466 
4,557 
4,667 
 
9,861 
9,934 
10,074 
       
Tier 1 deductions
     
 50% of material holdings
(313)
(300)
(340)
 Tax on excess of expected losses over impairment provisions
756 
906 
915 
 
443 
606 
575 
       
Total Tier 1 capital
58,459 
57,342 
56,990 
       
Qualifying Tier 2 capital
     
 Undated subordinated debt
1,958 
1,817 
1,838 
 Dated subordinated debt - net of amortisation
13,346 
13,561 
14,527 
 Unrealised gains on AFS equity shares
70 
108 
108 
 Collectively assessed impairment provisions
552 
571 
635 
 Non-controlling Tier 2 capital
11 
11 
11 
 
15,937 
16,068 
17,119 
       
Tier 2 deductions
     
 50% of securitisation positions
(1,461)
(1,530)
(2,019)
 50% excess of expected losses over impairment provisions
(3,085)
(3,697)
(3,451)
 50% of material holdings
(313)
(300)
(340)
 50% of APS first loss
(2,118)
(2,489)
(2,763)
 
(6,977)
(8,016)
(8,573)
       
Total Tier 2 capital
8,960 
8,052 
8,546 
 
 
138

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Balance sheet management: Capital (continued)

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Supervisory deductions
     
 Unconsolidated Investments
     
   - Direct Line Group
(3,642)
(4,130)
(4,354)
   - Other investments
(141)
(248)
(239)
 Other deductions
(197)
(212)
(235)
       
 
(3,980)
(4,590)
(4,828)
       
Total regulatory capital
63,439 
60,804 
60,708 

Movement in Core Tier 1 capital
£m 
   
At 1 January 2012
46,341 
Attributable profit net of movements in fair value of own debt
242 
Share capital and reserve movements in respect of employee benefits
659 
Foreign currency reserves
(461)
Decrease in non-controlling interests
(34)
Decrease in capital deductions including APS first loss
1,410 
Decrease in goodwill and intangibles
(30)
Other movements
28 
   
At 30 June 2012
48,155 

Risk-weighted assets by division
Risk-weighted assets by risk category and division are set out below.

 
Credit 
risk 
Counterparty 
risk 
Market 
risk 
Operational 
risk 
Gross 
RWAs 
30 June 2012
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
           
UK Retail
39.6 
7.8 
47.4 
UK Corporate
70.8 
8.6 
79.4 
Wealth
10.3 
0.1 
1.9 
12.3 
International Banking
41.2 
4.8 
46.0 
Ulster Bank
34.7 
0.9 
0.1 
1.7 
37.4 
US Retail & Commercial
52.5 
1.1 
4.9 
58.5 
           
Retail & Commercial
249.1 
2.0 
0.2 
29.7 
281.0 
Markets
15.7 
33.4 
43.1 
15.7 
107.9 
Other
10.5 
0.2 
0.2 
1.8 
12.7 
           
Core
275.3 
35.6 
43.5 
47.2 
401.6 
Non-Core
56.4 
17.4 
10.5 
(1.6)
82.7 
           
Group before RFS Holdings MI
331.7 
53.0 
54.0 
45.6 
484.3 
RFS Holdings MI
3.1 
0.2 
3.3 
           
Group
334.8 
53.0 
54.0 
45.8 
487.6 
APS relief
(46.2)
(6.7)
(52.9)
           
Net RWAs
288.6 
46.3 
54.0 
45.8 
434.7 

 
139

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Capital: Risk-weighted assets by division (continued)

 
Credit 
risk 
Counterparty 
risk 
Market 
risk 
Operational 
risk 
Gross 
RWAs 
31 March 2012
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
           
UK Retail
40.4 
7.8 
48.2 
UK Corporate
68.3 
8.6 
76.9 
Wealth
10.9 
0.1 
1.9 
12.9 
International Banking
37.0 
4.8 
41.8 
Ulster Bank
35.9 
0.7 
0.1 
1.7 
38.4 
US Retail & Commercial
52.8 
0.9 
4.9 
58.6 
           
Retail & Commercial
245.3 
1.6 
0.2 
29.7 
276.8 
Markets
15.0 
36.5 
48.4 
15.7 
115.6 
Other
9.0 
0.2 
1.8 
11.0 
           
Core
269.3 
38.3 
48.6 
47.2 
403.4 
Non-Core
60.6 
18.5 
12.4 
(1.6)
89.9 
           
Group before RFS Holdings MI
329.9 
56.8 
61.0 
45.6 
493.3 
RFS Holdings MI
3.0 
0.2 
3.2 
           
Group
332.9 
56.8 
61.0 
45.8 
496.5 
APS relief
(53.9)
(8.3)
(62.2)
           
Net RWAs
279.0 
48.5 
61.0 
45.8 
434.3 
           
31 December 2011
         
           
UK Retail
41.1 
7.3 
48.4 
UK Corporate
71.2 
8.1 
79.3 
Wealth
10.9 
0.1 
1.9 
12.9 
International Banking
38.9 
4.3 
43.2 
Ulster Bank
33.6 
0.6 
0.3 
1.8 
36.3 
US Retail & Commercial
53.6 
1.0 
4.7 
59.3 
           
Retail & Commercial
249.3 
1.6 
0.4 
28.1 
279.4 
Markets
16.7 
39.9 
50.6 
13.1 
120.3 
Other
9.8 
0.2 
2.0 
12.0 
           
Core
275.8 
41.7 
51.0 
43.2 
411.7 
Non-Core
65.6 
20.2 
13.0 
(5.5)
93.3 
           
Group before RFS Holdings MI
341.4 
61.9 
64.0 
37.7 
505.0 
RFS Holdings MI
2.9 
0.2 
3.1 
           
Group
344.3 
61.9 
64.0 
37.9 
508.1 
APS relief
(59.6)
(9.5)
(69.1)
           
Net RWAs
284.7 
52.4 
64.0 
37.9 
439.0 

Regulatory developments
The regulatory change agenda remains intense, although we are now seeing a change of emphasis. At a global level, the G20 financial sector reform action plan, first developed in 2008, has mostly been addressed, with focus at that forum now shifting to growth and other issues. The G20 is expected to endorse policy proposals on ‘shadow banking’ by the end of 2012 but its regulation agenda is increasingly geared towards the implementation of agreed standards. Although policy initiation at the G20 level is drawing to an end, there remains a substantial pipeline of policy development, particularly in the EU and US, and RBS does not anticipate any easing of this for some time.

 
140

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Regulatory capital developments (continued)
In the H1 2012, there were new regulatory proposals in Europe for data protection and crisis management as well as initial discussions on a banking union and the launch of the Liikanen Group to look at a structural reform of the industry. Negotiations, which are still incomplete, continued throughout the period on the adoption of the Basel III enhanced capital and liquidity standards in Europe. The European Banking Authority published several draft technical standards in anticipation of final agreement.

Basel III capital proposals were also issued in the US, as well as final rules for Basel 2.5. These were drawn up to be consistent with the Dodd-Frank Act and several other proposed and final rules were issued under the auspices of that legislation during the period. Significant activity took place in both Europe and the US to finalise rules requiring central clearing, where possible, and other reforms of over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives, as the end of 2012 deadline set by the G20 approaches. Additionally, work continued on the finalisation of recovery and resolution planning frameworks for Europe and the UK.

In the UK, the Financial Services Bill to introduce the ‘twin peaks’ model of financial regulation was published as the FSA continued to alter its structure in anticipation of its formal split into the Prudential Regulation Authority and the Financial Conduct Authority in 2013. The government also published its White Paper on the implementation of the Vickers Report. The Group is evaluating the impact of these developments.

CRD IV impacts
The Group, in conjunction with the FSA, continues to evaluate its models for the assessment of RWAs ascribed to credit risk across various classes. This together with the changes introduced by CRD IV relating primarily to counterparty risk, is expected to increase RWA requirements by the end of 2013 by £50 billion to £65 billion. These estimates are still subject to change; a degree of uncertainty remains around implementation details as the guidelines are not finalised and must still be enacted into EU law. There could be other future changes and associated impacts from these model reviews. See page 73 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report on background on Basel III and related proposals. The Group is also in the process of implementing changes to the RWA requirements for commercial real estate portfolios consistent with revised industry guidance from the FSA. This is projected to increase RWA requirements by circa £20 billion by the end of 2013, of which circa £10 billion will apply in 2012. Certain of the changes referred to above have been implemented, adding circa £15 billion to RWAs as of 30 June 2012.

The reported Core Tier 1 ratio following the implementation of the above changes is currently projected(1) to be 10.3% at 31 December 2013, while the fully loaded Basel III Core Tier 1 ratio at that date is estimated at 9.0% - 9.5%.

CRD IV legislation implementing Basel III proposals was due to be finalised in early July for implementation by 1 January 2013. However there are a number of areas still under consideration. On 1 August 2012, the FSA issued a statement indicating that it was unlikely that the legislation will be adopted earlier than autumn 2012 and enter into force on the envisaged implementation date of 1 January 2013. No alternative implementation date has yet been communicated by the EU institutions.

(1)
Projected using consensus earnings and company balance sheet forecasts.

 
141

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Balance sheet management

Liquidity and funding risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group is unable to meet its obligations, including financing maturities as they fall due. Liquidity risk is heavily influenced by the maturity profile and mix of the Group’s funding base, as well as the quality and liquidity value of its liquidity portfolio.

Overview
The Group continues to improve the structure and composition of its balance sheet through persistently difficult market conditions.

·
The second quarter saw the final maturity of the Group’s government guaranteed debt and robust liquidity management through a series of major market-wide credit rating actions. Short-term wholesale funding continued its downward trend to £62 billion and the liquidity coverage of this funding remains strong at 2.5 times. Short-term wholesale funding at 30 June 2012 was 7% of the funded balance sheet and 34% of wholesale funding, compared with 10% and 45% at 31 December 2011.
   
·
Short-term wholesale funding excluding derivative collateral declined by £40.1 billion in H1 2012 (Q2 2012 - £17.4 billion), reflecting the continued downsizing of the Markets balance sheet.
   
·
The Group’s customer deposits, excluding derivative collateral, increased by £1.4 billion in the quarter despite headwinds from a credit rating downgrade reflecting the strength of the Group’s Retail & Commercial franchise. Deposits now account for 67% of the Group’s primary funding sources.
   
·
The deleveraging process being driven by Non-Core and Markets continued, allowing the Group to further reduce wholesale funding requirements. During the second quarter of 2012 the Group did not access the public markets for senior term debt (secured or unsecured).
   
·
Progress against the goals of the Group’s strategic plan has resulted in a balance sheet structure which is broadly matched. At 30 June 2012 the Group’s loan:deposit ratio improved to 104% with a Core ratio of 92%.
   
·
The Core funding surplus increased from £27 billion at the end of 2011 to £34 billion at 30 June 2012, spread evenly across the first two quarters.

 
142

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Funding sources
The table below shows the Group’s primary funding sources including deposits in disposal groups and excluding repurchase agreements.

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Deposits by banks
     
 derivative cash collateral
32,001 
29,390 
31,807 
 other deposits
35,619 
36,428 
37,307 
       
 
67,620 
65,818 
69,114 
       
Debt securities in issue
     
 conduit asset-backed commercial paper (ABCP)
4,246 
9,354 
11,164 
 other commercial paper (CP)
1,985 
3,253 
5,310 
 certificates of deposits (CDs)
10,397 
14,575 
16,367 
 medium-term notes (MTNs)
81,229 
90,674 
105,709 
 covered bonds
9,987 
10,107 
9,107 
 securitisations
12,011 
14,980 
14,964 
       
 
119,855 
142,943 
162,621 
Subordinated liabilities
25,596 
25,513 
26,319 
       
Notes issued
145,451 
168,456 
188,940 
       
Wholesale funding
213,071 
234,274 
258,054 
       
Customer deposits
     
 cash collateral
10,269 
8,829 
9,242 
 other deposits
425,031 
423,659 
427,511 
       
Total customer deposits
435,300 
432,488 
436,753 
       
Total funding
648,371 
666,762 
694,807 
       
Disposal group deposits included above
     
 banks
83 
 customers
22,531 
22,281 
22,610 
       
 
22,532 
22,364 
22,611 


The table below shows the Group’s wholesale funding source metrics.

 
Short-term wholesale
funding (1)
 
Total wholesale
funding
 
Net inter-bank
funding (2)
 
Excluding 
 derivative 
collateral 
Including 
 derivative 
 collateral 
 
Excluding 
 derivative 
collateral 
Including 
 derivative 
 collateral 
 
Deposits 
Loans 
Net 
 interbank 
 funding 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
                   
30 June 2012
62.3 
94.3 
 
181.1 
213.1 
 
35.6 
(22.3)
13.3 
31 March 2012
79.7 
109.1 
 
204.9 
234.3 
 
36.4 
(19.7)
16.7 
31 December 2011
102.4 
134.2 
 
226.2 
258.1 
 
37.3 
(24.3)
13.0 
30 September 2011
141.6 
174.1 
 
267.0 
299.4 
 
46.2 
(33.0)
13.2 
30 June 2011
148.1 
173.6 
 
286.2 
311.7 
 
46.1 
(33.6)
12.5 

Notes:
(1)
Short-term balances denote those with a residual maturity of less than one year and includes longer-term issuances.
(2)
Excludes derivative collateral.
 
 
143

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Funding sources (continued)

Notes issued
The table below shows the Group’s debt securities in issue and subordinated liabilities by remaining maturity.
 
Debt securities in issue
     
 
Conduit 
ABCP 
Other 
CP and 
CDs 
MTNs 
Covered 
bonds 
Securit- 
isations 
Total 
Subordinated 
liabilities 
Total 
notes 
issued 
Total 
notes 
issued 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Less than 1 year
4,246 
12,083 
16,845 
1,020 
69 
34,263 
1,631 
35,894 
25 
1-3 years
293 
24,452 
1,681 
1,263 
27,689 
5,401 
33,090 
23 
3-5 years
16,620 
3,619 
20,240 
2,667 
22,907 
15 
More than 5 years
23,312 
3,667 
10,679 
37,663 
15,897 
53,560 
37 
                   
 
4,246 
12,382 
81,229 
9,987 
12,011 
119,855 
25,596 
145,451 
100 
                   
31 March 2012
                 
                   
Less than 1 year
9,354 
17,532 
19,686 
22 
46,594 
454 
47,048 
28 
1-3 years
290 
30,795 
2,787 
1,231 
35,103 
4,693 
39,796 
24 
3-5 years
16,416 
3,666 
20,083 
4,998 
25,081 
15 
More than 5 years
23,777 
3,654 
13,727 
41,163 
15,368 
56,531 
33 
                   
 
9,354 
17,828 
90,674 
10,107 
14,980 
142,943 
25,513 
168,456 
100 
                   
31 December 2011
                 
                   
Less than 1 year
11,164 
21,396 
36,302 
27 
68,889 
624 
69,513 
37 
1-3 years
278 
26,595 
2,760 
479 
30,112 
3,338 
33,450 
18 
3-5 years
16,627 
3,673 
20,302 
7,232 
27,534 
14 
More than 5 years
26,185 
2,674 
14,458 
43,318 
15,125 
58,443 
31 
                   
 
11,164 
21,677 
105,709 
9,107 
14,964 
162,621 
26,319 
188,940 
100 

Key point
·
Short-term debt securities in issue declined by £34.6 billion (Q2 2012 - £12.3 billion) primarily due to the final tranches of notes issued under the Credit Guarantee Scheme maturing (£21.3 billion in H1 2012 and £5.7 billion in Q2 2012) and the reduction of commercial paper in issue of £10.2 billion (Q2 2012 - £6.4 billion) in line with the Group’s strategy.

Deposit and repo funding
The table below shows the composition of the Group’s deposits excluding repos and repo funding including disposal groups.
 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Deposits 
Repos 
 
Deposits 
Repos 
 
Deposits 
Repos 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                 
Financial institutions
               
 - central and other banks
67,620 
39,125 
 
65,818 
41,415 
 
69,114 
39,691 
 - other financial institutions
65,563 
87,789 
 
61,552 
84,743 
 
66,009 
86,032 
Personal and corporate deposits
369,737 
1,161 
 
370,936 
2,560 
 
370,744 
2,780 
                 
 
502,920 
128,075 
 
498,306 
128,718 
 
505,867 
128,503 

Key points
·
The central and other bank balances include €10 billion in relation to funding accessed through the European Central Banks long-term refinancing operation facility.
   
·
Of the deposits above, about a third are insured through the UK Financial Services Compensation Scheme, US Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and similar schemes.
 
 
144

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Funding sources (continued)

Customer loan to deposit ratio and funding gap
The table below shows the Group’s divisional customer loan:deposit ratio (LDR) and customer funding gap.
 
Loans (1)
Deposits (2)
LDR (3)
Funding 
 surplus/ 
(gap) (3)
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
         
UK Retail
110,318 
106,571 
104 
(3,747)
UK Corporate
107,775 
127,446 
85 
19,671 
Wealth
16,888 
38,462 
44 
21,574 
International Banking (4)
43,190 
42,238 
102 
(952)
Ulster Bank
29,701 
20,593 
144 
(9,108)
US Retail & Commercial
51,634 
59,229 
87 
7,595 
Conduits (4)
6,295 
(6,295)
         
Retail & Commercial
365,801 
394,539 
93 
28,738 
Markets
30,191 
34,257 
88 
4,066 
Direct Line Group and other
1,320 
2,999 
44 
1,679 
         
Core
397,312 
431,795 
92 
34,483 
Non-Core
57,398 
3,505 
1,638 
(53,893)
         
Group
454,710 
435,300 
104 
(19,410)

31 March 2012
       
         
UK Retail
109,852 
104,247 
105 
(5,605)
UK Corporate
107,583 
124,256 
87 
16,673 
Wealth
16,881 
38,278 
44 
21,397 
International Banking (4)
42,713 
45,041 
95 
2,328 
Ulster Bank
30,831 
20,981 
147 
(9,850)
US Retail & Commercial
50,298 
58,735 
86 
8,437 
Conduits (4)
9,544 
(9,544)
         
Retail & Commercial
367,702 
391,538 
94 
23,836 
Markets
28,628 
34,638 
83 
6,010 
Direct Line Group and other
1,468 
2,573 
57 
1,105 
         
Core
397,798 
428,749 
93 
30,951 
Non-Core
61,872 
3,739 
1,655 
(58,133)
         
Group
459,670 
432,488 
106 
(27,182)

For the notes to this table refer to the following page.
 
 
145

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Funding sources (continued)

Customer loan to deposit ratio and funding gap (continued)
 
Loans (1)
Deposits (2)
LDR (3)
Funding 
 surplus/ 
(gap) (3)
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
         
UK Retail
107,983 
101,878 
106 
(6,105)
UK Corporate
108,668 
126,309 
86 
17,641 
Wealth
16,834 
38,164 
44 
21,330 
International Banking (4)
46,417 
45,051 
103 
(1,366)
Ulster Bank
31,303 
21,814 
143 
(9,489)
US Retail & Commercial
50,842 
59,984 
85 
9,142 
Conduits (4)
10,504 
(10,504)
         
Retail & Commercial
372,551 
393,200 
95 
20,649 
Markets
31,254 
36,776 
85 
5,522 
Direct Line Group and other
1,196 
2,496 
48 
1,300 
         
Core
405,001 
432,472 
94 
27,471 
Non-Core
68,516 
4,281 
1,600 
(64,235)
         
Group
473,517 
436,753 
108 
(36,764)

Notes:
(1)
Loans and advances to customers excluding reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing but including disposal groups.
(2)
Excluding repurchase agreements and stock lending but including disposal groups.
(3)
Based on loans and advances to customers net of provisions and customer deposits as shown.
(4)
All conduits relate to International Banking and have been extracted and shown separately.

Key point
·
The Group’s customer loan:deposit ratio improved by 400 basis points in the first half 2012 (Q2 2012 - 200 basis points) despite a credit rating downgrade in June 2012, reflecting the growth of Core Retail & Commercial deposits and the ongoing contraction of Non-Core loans.

Long-term debt issuance
The table below shows debt securities issued by the Group in the period with an original maturity of one year or more. The Group also executes other long-term funding arrangements (predominantly term repurchase agreements) which are not reflected in the following tables.

 
Half year ended
 
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
30 June 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Public
     
  - unsecured
5,085 
  - secured
1,784 
4,944 
4,863 
Private
     
  - unsecured
2,585 
4,166 
8,248 
  - secured
500 
       
Gross issuance
4,369 
9,610 
18,196 
Buy backs
(2,859)
(3,656)
(3,236)
       
Net issuance
1,510 
5,954 
14,960 

Key point
·
Issuance in 2012 has been modest, demonstrating reduced reliance on capital markets for funding.
 
 
146

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Securitisations and asset transfers

Secured funding
The Group has access to secured funding markets through own-asset securitisation and covered bond funding programme. This complements existing wholesale funding programmes and access to the repo markets. The Group monitors and manages encumbrance levels related to these secured funding programmes including the potential encumbrance of Group assets that could be used in own-asset securitisations and/or covered bonds that could be used as contingent liquidity.

Own-asset securitisations
The Group has a programme of own-asset securitisations where assets are transferred to bankruptcy remote special purpose entities (SPEs) funded by the issue of debt securities. The majority of the risks and rewards of the portfolio are retained by the Group and these SPEs are consolidated with all of the transferred assets retained on the Group’s balance sheet. In some own-asset securitisations, the Group may purchase all the issued securities which are available to be pledged as collateral for repurchase agreements with major central banks.

Covered bond programme
Certain loans and advances to customers have been assigned to bankruptcy remote limited liability partnerships to provide security for issues of covered bonds by the Group. The Group retains all of the risks and rewards of these loans, the partnerships are consolidated, the loans retained on the Group’s balance sheet and the related covered bonds included within debt securities in issue.

The following table shows:
(i)
the asset categories that have been pledged to secured funding structures, including assets backing publicly issued own-asset securitisations and covered bonds; and
   
(ii)
any currently unencumbered assets that could be substituted into those portfolios or used to collateralise debt securities which may be retained by the Group for contingent liquidity purposes.

     
Debt securities in issue
Asset type (1)
Assets (1)
£m 
 
Held by third 
parties (2)
£m 
Held by the 
Group (3)
£m 
Total 
£m 
           
30 June 2012
         
Mortgages
         
  - UK (RMBS)
21,492 
 
7,461 
16,797 
24,258 
  - UK (covered bonds)
17,303 
 
9,987 
9,987 
  - Irish
11,953 
 
3,278 
8,204 
11,482 
UK credit cards
3,827 
 
1,265 
282 
1,547 
UK personal loans
4,823 
 
4,406 
4,406 
Other
18,730 
 
20,398 
20,405 
           
 
78,128 
 
21,998 
50,087 
72,085 
Cash deposits (4)
5,210 
       
           
 
83,338 
       

For the notes relating to this table refer to the following page.
 
 
147

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Securitisations and asset transfers (continued)

     
Debt securities in issue
31 March 2012
Assets (1)
£m 
 
Held by third 
parties (2)
£m 
Held by the 
Group (3)
£m 
Total 
£m 
           
Mortgages
         
  - UK (RMBS)
48,674 
 
10,303 
45,320 
55,623 
  - UK (covered bonds)
17,773 
 
10,107 
10,107 
  - Irish
12,496 
 
3,419 
8,532 
11,951 
UK credit cards
3,869 
 
1,251 
282 
1,533 
UK personal loans
4,948 
 
4,543 
4,543 
Other
18,505 
 
18,462 
18,469 
           
 
106,265 
 
25,087 
77,139 
102,226 
Cash deposits (4)
11,198 
       
           
 
117,463 
       

31 December 2011
         
           
Mortgages
         
  - UK (RMBS)
49,549 
 
10,988 
47,324 
58,312 
  - UK (covered bonds)
15,441 
 
9,107 
9,107 
  - Irish
12,660 
 
3,472 
8,670 
12,142 
UK credit cards
4,037 
 
500 
110 
610 
UK personal loans
5,168 
 
4,706 
4,706 
Other
19,778 
 
20,577 
20,581 
           
 
106,633 
 
24,071 
81,387 
105,458 
Cash deposits (4)
11,998 
       
           
 
118,631 
       

Notes:
(1)
Assets that have been pledged to the SPEs which itself is a subset of the total portfolio of eligible assets within a collateral pool.
(2)
Debt securities that have been sold to third party investors and represents a source of external wholesale funding.
(3)
Debt securities issued pursuant to own-asset securitisations where the debt securities are retained by the Group as a source of contingent liquidity where those securities can be used in repurchase agreements with central banks.
(4)
Cash deposits comprise £4.4 billion (31 March 2012 - £10.4 billion; 31 December 2011 - £11.2 billion) from mortgage repayments and £0.8 billion (31 March 2012 and 31 December 2011 - £0.8 billion) from other loan repayments held in the SPEs, to repay debt securities issued by the own-asset securitisation vehicles.

Key point
·
The Group unwound a number of own-asset securitisations as part of its strategy on assets used for the Bank of England discount window facility. At 30 June 2012 the Group had £37.1 billion of pre-positioned whole loans in relation to this facility in addition to the balances above.

 
148

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Securitisations and asset transfers (continued)

Securities repurchase agreements
The Group enters into securities repurchase agreements and securities lending transactions (repos) under which it transfers securities in accordance with normal market practice. Generally, the agreements require additional collateral to be provided if the value of the securities falls below a predetermined level. Under standard terms for repurchase transactions in the UK and US markets, the recipient of collateral has an unrestricted right to sell or repledge it, subject to returning equivalent securities on settlement of the transaction.

Securities sold under repurchase transactions are not derecognised if the Group retains substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership. The fair value (which is equivalent to the carrying value) of securities transferred under such repurchase transactions included within securities on the balance sheet is set out below. All of these securities could be sold or repledged by the holder.

Assets pledged against repos
30 June 
2012 
£m 
31 March 
2012 
£m 
31 December 
2011 
£m 
       
Debt securities
81,871 
80,010 
79,480 
Equity shares
5,069 
3,390 
6,534 

 
149

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Conduits
The Group sponsors and administers a number of asset-backed commercial paper conduits. The liquidity commitments from the Group to each conduit exceeds the nominal amount of assets funded by a conduit as liquidity commitments are sized to cover the cost of the related assets. Refer to pages 83 to 84 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report for more information.

The total assets and other aspects relating to the Group’s consolidated conduits are set out below.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Core 
£m 
Non-Core 
£m 
Total 
£m 
 
Core 
£m 
Non-Core 
£m 
Total 
£m 
               
Total assets held by the conduits
6,672 
1,575 
8,247 
 
11,208 
1,893 
13,101 
Commercial paper issued (1)
5,361 
96 
5,457 
 
10,590 
859 
11,449 
               
Liquidity and credit enhancements
             
Deal specific liquidity
             
  - drawn
752 
1,493 
2,245 
 
321 
1,051 
1,372 
  - undrawn
9,104 
366 
9,470 
 
15,324 
1,144 
16,468 
PWCE (2)
417 
155 
572 
 
795 
193 
988 
               
 
10,273 
2,014 
12,287 
 
16,440 
2,388 
18,828 
               
Maximum exposure to loss (3)
9,856 
1,859 
11,715 
 
15,646 
2,194 
17,840 

Notes:
(1)
Includes £1.3 billion of asset backed commercial paper issued to RBS plc (31 December 2011 - £0.3 billion).
(2)
Programme-wide credit enhancement (PWCE) is an additional programme-wide credit support which would absorb the first loss on transactions where liquidity support is provided by a third party.
(3)
Maximum exposure to loss quantifies the Group’s exposure to its sponsored conduits. It is determined as the Group’s liquidity commitment to its sponsored conduits and additional PWCE which would absorb the first loss on transactions where liquidity support is provided by third parties. Historically, PWCE has been greater than third party liquidity. Therefore the maximum exposure to loss is total deal specific liquidity.
(4)
Liquidity commitments from the Group to the conduit exceed the nominal amount of assets funded by the conduit given that liquidity commitments are sized to cover the accrued funding cost of the related assets.

Key points
·
During the half year, conduit assets decreased by £4.9 billion reflecting the accelerated run-off of the portfolio in line with Group strategy
   
·
The Group drawn liquidity increased by £0.9 billion to £2.2 billion as the rating downgrade resulted in a number of conduits being unable to issue commercial paper.

 
150

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Liquidity portfolio
The table below shows the composition of the Group’s liquidity portfolio (at estimated liquidity value). All assets within the liquidity portfolio are unencumbered.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Quarterly 
average 
Period 
 end 
 
Quarterly 
average 
Period 
end 
 
Quarterly 
average 
Period 
 end 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                 
Cash and balances at central banks
87,114 
71,890 
 
91,287 
69,489 
 
89,377 
69,932 
Central and local government bonds (1)
               
 AAA rated governments and US agencies
20,163 
26,315 
 
19,085 
29,639 
 
30,421 
29,632 
 AA- to AA+ rated governments (2)
10,739 
14,449 
 
8,924 
14,903 
 
5,056 
14,102 
 governments rated below AA
609 
519 
 
797 
544 
 
1,011 
955 
 local government
2,546 
1,872 
 
3,980 
2,933 
 
4,517 
4,302 
 
34,057 
43,155 
 
32,786 
48,019 
 
41,005 
48,991 
Treasury bills
 
 
444 
                 
 
121,171 
115,045 
 
124,073 
117,508 
 
130,826 
118,923 
                 
Other assets (3)
               
 AAA rated
22,505 
10,712 
 
26,435 
24,243 
 
25,083 
25,202 
 below AAA rated and other high quality assets
13,789 
30,244 
 
9,194 
10,972 
 
11,400 
11,205 
                 
 
36,294 
40,956 
 
35,629 
35,215 
 
36,483 
36,407 
                 
Total liquidity portfolio
157,465 
156,001 
 
159,702 
152,723 
 
167,309 
155,330 

Notes:
(1)
Includes FSA eligible government bonds of £29.7 billion (31 March 2012 - £30.5 billion; 31 December 2011 - £36.7 billion).
(2)
Includes US government guaranteed and US government sponsored agencies.
(3)
Other assets are a diversified pool of unencumbered assets that would be accepted as collateral by central banks as part of open market operations.

Key points
·
The liquidity portfolio was maintained at £156 billion representing 17% of the funded balance sheet and covers short-term wholesale funding 2.5 times.
   
·
AAA rated government and US agencies bonds held decreased by £3.3 billion in the first half of 2012, mainly in the second quarter, tracking the reducing short-term wholesale funding balances.
 
 
151

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Net stable funding ratio
The table below shows the composition of the Group’s net stable funding ratio (NSFR) (this represents a non-GAAP measure as described on page 4, estimated by applying the Basel III guidance issued in December 2010. The Group’s NSFR will also continue to be refined over time in line with regulatory developments and related interpretations. It may also be calculated on a basis that may differ from other financial institutions. The Group has disclosed that this information will continue to be refined over time in line with regulatory developments and may not be calculated on a basis that is consistency with other financial institutions.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
31 December 2011
   
   
ASF (1)
   
ASF (1)
   
ASF (1)
 
Weighting 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
                     
Equity
75 
75 
 
75 
75 
 
76 
76 
 
100 
Wholesale funding  > 1 year
119 
119 
 
125 
125 
 
124 
124 
 
100 
Wholesale funding < 1 year
94 
 
109 
 
134 
 
Derivatives
481 
 
447 
 
524 
 
Repurchase agreements
128 
 
129 
 
129 
 
Deposits
                   
  - Retail and SME - more stable
235 
212 
 
230 
207 
 
227 
204 
 
90 
  - Retail and SME - less stable
29 
23 
 
30 
24 
 
31 
25 
 
80 
  - Other
171 
86 
 
173 
87 
 
179 
89 
 
50 
Other (2)
83 
 
85 
 
83 
 
                     
Total liabilities and equity
1,415 
515 
 
1,403 
518 
 
1,507 
518 
   
                     
Cash
79 
 
82 
 
79 
 
Inter-bank lending
39 
 
36 
 
44 
 
Debt securities > 1 year
                   
  - governments AAA to AA-
70 
 
70 
 
77 
 
  - other eligible bonds
60 
12 
 
64 
13 
 
73 
15 
 
20 
  - other bonds
20 
20 
 
20 
20 
 
14 
14 
 
100 
Debt securities < 1 year
38 
 
42 
 
45 
 
Derivatives
486 
 
453 
 
530 
 
Reverse repurchase agreements
98 
 
91 
 
101 
 
Customer loans and advances > 1 year
                   
  - residential mortgages
146 
95 
 
145 
94 
 
145 
94 
 
65 
  - other
151 
151 
 
167 
167 
 
173 
173 
 
100 
Customer loans and advances < 1 year
                   
  - retail loans
18 
15 
 
19 
16 
 
19 
16 
 
85 
  - other
140 
70 
 
129 
65 
 
137 
69 
 
50 
Other (3)
70 
70 
 
85 
85 
 
70 
70 
 
100 
                     
Total assets
1,415 
437 
 
1,403 
463 
 
1,507 
455 
   
Undrawn commitments
228 
11 
 
237 
12 
 
240 
12 
 
                     
Total assets and undrawn commitments
1,643 
448 
 
1,640 
475 
 
1,747 
467 
   
                     
Net stable funding ratio
 
115% 
   
109% 
   
111% 
   

Notes:
(1)
Available stable funding.
(2)
Deferred tax, insurance liabilities and other liabilities.
(3)
Prepayments, accrued income, deferred tax, settlement balances and other assets.

 
152

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Net stable funding ratio (continued)

Key points
·
The NSFR improved by 400 basis points in H1 2012 (Q2 2012 - 600 basis points) to 115%. Long-term funding decreased by £3 billion all in Q2 2012 with £5 billion (Q2 2012 - £6 billion) in term wholesale funding. This was partly offset by a £3 billion net increase in customer deposits in ASF terms all in Q1 2012 and predominately in more stable deposits (Retail & Commercial increased by £8 billion).
   
·
The funding requirement in relation to lending decreased £19 billion in H1 2012 (Q2 2012 - £27 billion) reflects derisking, sales and repayments in Non-Core and capital management led loan portfolio reductions in International Banking.


Non-traded interest rate risk
Non-traded interest rate risk impacts earnings arising from the Group’s banking activities. This excludes positions in financial instruments or commodities which are deemed to be held-for-trading or hedging items that are held-for-trading.

The Group provides a range of financial products to meet a variety of customer requirements. These products differ with regard to repricing frequency, tenor, indexation, prepayments, optionality and other features. When aggregated, they form portfolios of assets and liabilities with varying degrees of sensitivity to changes in market rates.

Mismatches in these sensitivities give rise to net interest income volatility as interest rates rise and fall. For example, a bank with a floating rate loan portfolio and largely fixed rate deposits will see its net interest income rise as interest rates rise and fall as rates decline.

The Group policy is to manage interest rate sensitivity in banking book portfolios within defined risk limits. Interest rate risk is transferred from the banking divisions to Group Treasury. Aggregate positions are then hedged externally using cash and derivative instruments, primarily interest rate swaps, to manage exposures within Group Asset and Liability Management Committee (GALCO) approved limits.

The Group assesses interest rate risk in the banking book (IRRBB) using a set of standards to define, measure and report the risk. These standards incorporate the expected divergence between contractual terms and the actual behaviour of fixed rate loan portfolios due to refinancing incentives and the risks associated with structural hedges of interest rate insensitive balances.

Key measures used to evaluate IRRBB are subject to approval by divisional Asset and Liability Management Committees (ALCOs) and GALCO. Limits on IRRBB are proposed by the Group Treasurer for approval by the Executive Risk Forum annually. Residual risk positions are reported on a regular basis to divisional ALCOs and monthly to the Group Balance Sheet Management Committee, GALCO, the Group Board and the Executive Risk Forum.

 
153

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Non-traded interest rate risk (continued)
The Group uses a variety of approaches to quantify its interest rate risk encompassing both earnings and value metrics. IRRBB is measured using a version of the same VaR methodology that is used for the Group’s trading portfolios. Net interest income exposures are measured in terms of earnings sensitivity over time against movements in interest rates.

VaR metrics are based on interest rate repricing gap reports as at the reporting date. These incorporate customer products and associated funding and hedging transactions as well as non-financial assets and liabilities such as property, equipment, capital and reserves. Behavioural assumptions are applied as appropriate.

The VaR does not provide a dynamic measurement of interest rate risk since static underlying repricing gap positions are assumed. Changes in customer behaviour under varying interest rate scenarios are captured by way of earnings risk measures.

Interest rate risk

Value-at-risk
IRRBB VaR for the Group’s retail and commercial banking activities at 99% confidence level and currency analysis of period end VaR were as follows:

 
Average 
Period end 
 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
30 June 2012
56 
55 
 
65 
51 
31 December 2011
63 
51 
 
80 
44 
 
 
30 June 
2012 
£m 
31 December 
2011 
£m 
     
Euro
21 
26 
Sterling
43 
57 
US dollar
62 
61 
Other

Sensitivity of net interest income
Earnings sensitivity to rate movements is derived from a central forecast over a twelve month period. Market implied forward rates and new business volume, mix and pricing consistent with business assumptions are used to generate a base case earnings forecast. The rates used to calculate this forecast are then shifted up and down by 100 basis points and the earnings recalculated. New business assumptions and the behavioural maturity profile of existing business may vary under the different rate scenarios.

 
154

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Interest rate risk (continued)
The following table shows the sensitivity of net interest income, over the next twelve months, to an immediate upward or downward change of 100 basis points to all interest rates. In addition, the table includes the impact of a gradual 400 basis point steepening and a gradual 300 basis point flattening of the yield curve at tenors greater than a year.
 
Euro 
Sterling 
US dollar 
Other 
Total 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
+ 100 basis points shift in yield curves
14 
214 
90 
26 
344 
- 100 basis points shift in yield curves
20 
(273)
(25)
(36)
(314)
Bear steepener
       
237 
Bull flattener
       
(161)
           
31 December 2011
         
           
+ 100 basis points shift in yield curves
(19)
190 
59 
14 
244 
- 100 basis points shift in yield curves
25 
(188)
(4)
(16)
(183)
Bear steepener
       
443 
Bull flattener
       
(146)

Key points
·
The Group remains slightly asset sensitive, largely as a consequence of the current low interest rate environment. An increase in rates would be positive for both deposit margins and the reinvestment of structural hedges. Conversely, falling rates would result in a further deposit margin compression and the reinvestment of structural hedges at lower levels than forecast.
   
·
Steepening and flattening scenarios which impact the long end of the yield curve serve to emphasise the impact of reinvesting structural hedges and the extent of any customer optionality.

Structural hedges
Banks generally have the benefit of a significant pool of stable, non and low interest bearing liabilities, principally comprising equity and money transmission accounts. These balances are usually invested in longer-term fixed rate assets, either directly or by the use of interest rate swaps, in order to minimise earnings volatility and to provide a consistent and predictable revenue stream.

The Group targets a weighted average life for these economic hedges. This is accomplished using a continuous rolling maturity programme to achieve the desired profile and is primarily managed by Group Treasury.

It is estimated that this programme, encompassing both equity and product structural hedges, contributed an additional £750 million to the Group’s net interest income over the half year 2012 relative to base rate. The maturity profile of the hedge aims to reduce the potential sensitivity of income to rate movements and residual sensitivity is estimated at £50 to £75 million for a 100 basis point adverse movement in rates over a twelve month horizon.

Fixed rate returns on liability structural hedges are expected to decline over the next twelve months as projected market rates continue to trend below historic averages. However, the portfolio maturity profile continues to moderate this impact and the Group expects the net contribution from these hedges to remain broadly stable.

 
155

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

 
Balance sheet management: Structural foreign currency exposures
The Group does not maintain material non-trading open currency positions, other than the structural foreign currency translation exposures arising from its investments in foreign subsidiaries and associated undertakings and their related currency funding.

The table below shows the Group’s structural foreign currency exposures.

30 June 2012
Net 
assets of 
overseas 
operations 
RFS 
MI 
Net 
investments 
in foreign 
operations 
Net 
investment 
hedges 
Structural 
foreign 
currency 
exposures 
pre-economic 
hedges 
Economic 
hedges (1)
Residual 
structural 
foreign 
currency 
exposures 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
US dollar
17,518 
17,517 
(2,394)
15,123 
(4,014)
11,109 
Euro
8,975 
(1)
8,976 
(831)
8,145 
(2,159)
5,986 
Other non-sterling
4,751 
268 
4,483 
(3,631)
852 
852 
               
 
31,244 
268 
30,976 
(6,856)
24,120 
(6,173)
17,947 
               
31 December 2011
             
               
US dollar
17,570 
17,569 
(2,049)
15,520 
(4,071)
11,449 
Euro
8,428 
(3)
8,431 
(621)
7,810 
(2,236)
5,574 
Other non-sterling
5,224 
272 
4,952 
(4,100)
852 
852 
               
 
31,222 
270 
30,952 
(6,770)
24,182 
(6,307)
17,875 

Note:
(1)
The economic hedges represents US and EU preference shares in issue that are treated as equity under IFRS and do not qualify as hedges for accounting purposes.

Key points
·
The Group’s structural foreign currency exposure at 30 June 2012 was £24.1 billion and £17.9 billion before and after economic hedges respectively, broadly unchanged from the end of 2011 position.
   
·
Changes in foreign currency exchange rates will affect equity in proportion to structural foreign currency exposure. A 5% strengthening in foreign currencies against sterling would result in a gain of £1.2 billion (2011 - £1.2 billion) in equity, while a 5% weakening would result in a loss of £1.1 billion (2011 - £1.2 billion) in equity.

 
156

 


Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss due to the failure of a customer to meet its obligation to settle outstanding amounts. The quantum and nature of credit risk assumed across the Group’s different businesses vary considerably, while the overall credit risk outcome usually exhibits a high degree of correlation with the macroeconomic environment.

Financial assets
The table below sets out the Group’s financial asset exposures by caption, both gross and net of offset and netting arrangements.

 
Gross 
exposure 
IFRS 
offset (1)
Balance 
sheet value 
Other 
offset (2)
Net 
exposure 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Cash balances at central banks
78,647 
78,647 
78,647 
Reverse repos
144,465 
(46,564)
97,901 
(13,212)
84,689 
Lending
474,401 
474,401 
(41,151)
433,250 
Debt securities
187,626 
187,626 
187,626 
Equity shares
13,091 
13,091 
13,091 
Derivatives
910,996 
(424,564)
486,432 
(445,980)
40,452 
Settlement balances
21,644 
(6,332)
15,312 
(3,090)
12,222 
Other financial assets
1,490 
1,490 
1,490 
           
Total excluding disposal groups
1,832,360 
(477,460)
1,354,900 
(503,433)
851,467 
           
Total including disposal groups
1,852,702 
(477,460)
1,375,242 
(503,433)
871,809 
Short positions
(38,376)
(38,376)
(38,376)
           
Net of short positions
1,814,326 
(477,460)
1,336,866 
(503,433)
833,433 
           
31 December 2011
         
           
Cash balances at central banks
79,269 
79,269 
79,269 
Reverse repos
138,539 
(37,605)
100,934 
(15,246)
85,688 
Lending
497,982 
497,982 
(41,129)
456,853 
Debt securities
209,080 
209,080 
209,080 
Equity shares
15,183 
15,183 
15,183 
Derivatives
1,074,109 
(544,491)
529,618 
(478,848)
50,770 
Settlement balances
9,130 
(1,359)
7,771 
(2,221)
5,550 
Other financial assets
1,309 
1,309 
1,309 
           
Total excluding disposal groups
2,024,601 
(583,455)
1,441,146 
(537,444)
903,702 
           
Total including disposal groups
2,044,678 
(583,455)
1,461,223 
(537,444)
923,779 
Short positions
(41,039)
(41,039)
(41,039)
           
Net of short positions
2,003,639 
(583,455)
1,420,184 
(537,444)
882,740

Notes:
(1)
Relates to offset arrangements that comply with IFRS criteria.
(2)
This reflects the amounts by which the Group’s credit risk is reduced through arrangements such as master netting agreements and current account pooling. In addition the Group holds collateral in respect of individual loans and advances. This collateral includes mortgages over property (both personal and commercial); charges over business assets such as plant, inventories and trade debtors; and guarantees of lending from parties other than the borrower. The Group obtains collateral in the form of securities in reverse repo and derivative transactions.
 
 
 
157

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Key points
·
Financial asset net exposures excluding disposal groups decreased by £52 billion or 6% to £851 billion, reflecting the Group’s focus on reducing its funded balance sheet, primarily in Non-Core, Markets and International Banking.
   
·
Reductions in lending (£24 billion), debt securities (£21 billion) and derivatives (£10 billion) were partially offset by higher seasonal settlement balances (£7 billion).
   
·
Exposures to central and local governments decreased by £15 billion principally in debt securities. This was driven by Markets de-risking its balance sheet, management of the Group Treasury liquidity portfolio as well as overall risk reduction in respect of eurozone exposures.
   
·
Exposure to financial institutions was £14 billion lower, across securities, loans and derivatives.
   
·
Within lending:
 
UK Retail increased its lending to homeowners, including first-time buyers, whilst unsecured lending balances fell.
 
UK Corporate reduced its Core commercial real estate lending by £1.8 billion, contributing to the decrease in Core property and construction exposure.
 
Non-Core continued to make significant progress on its balance sheet strategy and lending declined across all sectors, principally property and construction, where commercial real estate lending decreased by £3.9 billion, reflecting repayments and asset sales.
 
 
 
158

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Sector concentration
The table below analyses balance sheet financial assets on the balance sheet by sector.

 
Reverse 
repos 
Lending
 
Securities
Derivatives 
Other 
Balance 
sheet value 
Offset 
Total net 
exposure 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Debt 
Equities 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                         
Government (1)
1,025 
9,278 
1,384 
10,662 
 
112,176 
326 
6,024 
1,462 
131,675 
2,983 
128,692 
Finance
- banks
37,705 
39,152 
403 
39,555 
 
12,091 
360,323 
78,647 
528,321 
374,497 
153,824 
 
- other
58,798 
43,123 
2,994 
46,117 
 
57,156 
5,362 
97,218 
14,980 
279,631 
115,590 
164,041 
Personal
- mortgages
140,814 
3,537 
144,351 
 
144,354 
144,353 
 
- unsecured
30,416 
1,223 
31,639 
 
56 
31,702 
16 
31,686 
Property and construction
43,315 
36,390 
79,705 
 
1,077 
541 
4,692 
86,016 
2,803 
83,213 
Manufacturing
322 
21,928 
3,839 
25,767 
 
744 
789 
3,230 
56 
30,908 
2,415 
28,493 
Finance leases (2)
8,834 
5,262 
14,096 
 
13 
43 
14,154 
14,154 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
20,080 
1,869 
21,949 
 
436 
1,203 
983 
12 
24,583 
1,515 
23,068 
Transport and storage
15,384 
4,065 
19,449 
 
592 
186 
3,732 
23,959 
482 
23,477 
Health, education and leisure
12,936 
969 
13,905 
 
291 
299 
892 
15,393 
930 
14,463 
Hotels and restaurants
6,900 
1,017 
7,917 
 
191 
29 
483 
8,620 
381 
8,239 
Utilities
6,382 
1,676 
8,058 
 
1,411 
479 
3,403 
13,359 
935 
12,424 
Other
45 
28,100 
3,428 
31,528 
 
2,564 
4,005 
5,399 
227 
43,768 
885 
42,883 
                         
Total gross of provisions
97,901 
426,642 
68,056 
494,698 
 
188,742 
13,221 
486,432 
95,449 
1,376,443 
503,433 
873,010 
Provisions
(8,944)
(11,353)
(20,297)
 
(1,116)
(130)
(21,543)
n/a
(21,543)
                         
Total excluding disposal groups
97,901 
417,698 
56,703 
474,401 
 
187,626 
13,091 
486,432 
95,449 
1,354,900 
503,433 
851,467 
Disposal groups
18,609 
1,179 
19,788 
 
36 
376 
142 
20,342 
20,342 
                         
Total including disposal groups
97,901 
436,307 
57,882 
494,189 
 
187,626 
13,127 
486,808 
95,591 
1,375,242 
503,433 
871,809 

For the notes to this table refer to the following page.
 
 
 
159

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Sector concentration (continued)

 
Reverse 
repos 
Lending
 
Securities
Derivatives 
Other 
Balance 
sheet value 
Offset 
Total net 
exposure 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Debt 
Equities 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                         
Government (1)
2,247 
8,359 
1,383 
9,742 
 
126,604 
328 
5,541 
641 
145,103 
1,098 
144,005 
Finance
- banks
39,345 
43,374 
619 
43,993 
 
16,940 
400,261 
79,269 
579,808 
407,457 
172,351 
 
- other
58,478 
46,452 
3,229 
49,681 
 
60,453 
5,618 
97,732 
7,437 
279,399 
119,717 
159,682 
Personal
- mortgages
138,509 
5,102 
143,611 
 
48 
143,659 
143,659 
 
- unsecured
31,067 
1,556 
32,623 
 
52 
52 
32,727 
32,720 
Property and construction
45,485 
40,736 
86,221 
 
623 
228 
5,545 
92,618 
2,413 
90,205 
Manufacturing
254 
23,201 
4,931 
28,132 
 
664 
1,938 
3,786 
306 
35,080 
2,214 
32,866 
Finance leases (2)
8,440 
6,059 
14,499 
 
145 
75 
14,721 
16 
14,705 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
21,314 
2,339 
23,653 
 
645 
2,652 
1,134 
18 
28,102 
1,671 
26,431 
Transport and storage
436 
16,454 
5,477 
21,931 
 
539 
74 
3,759 
26,739 
241 
26,498 
Health, education and leisure
13,273 
1,419 
14,692 
 
310 
21 
885 
15,908 
973 
14,935 
Hotels and restaurants
7,143 
1,161 
8,304 
 
116 
671 
9,096 
184 
8,912 
Utilities
6,543 
1,849 
8,392 
 
1,530 
554 
3,708 
30 
14,214 
450 
13,764 
Other
174 
28,374 
4,017 
32,391 
 
2,899 
3,904 
6,421 
595 
46,384 
1,003 
45,381 
                         
Total gross of provisions
100,934 
437,988 
79,877 
517,865 
 
211,468 
15,324 
529,618 
88,349 
1,463,558 
537,444 
926,114 
Provisions
(8,414)
(11,469)
(19,883)
 
(2,388)
(141)
(22,412)
n/a 
(22,412)
                         
Total excluding disposal groups
100,934 
429,574 
68,408 
497,982 
 
209,080 
15,183 
529,618 
88,349 
1,441,146 
537,444 
903,702 
Disposal groups
18,677 
815 
19,492 
 
439 
597 
20,533 
20,533 
                         
Total including disposal groups
100,934 
448,251 
69,223 
517,474 
 
209,080 
15,188 
530,057 
88,946 
1,461,679 
537,444 
924,235 

Notes:
(1)
Government comprises central and local government.
(2)
Includes instalment credit.
 
 
 
 
160

 

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Asset quality
The following table analyses the Group’s financial assets excluding debt securities and off-balance sheet exposures by internal asset quality ratings. For further details on internal asset quality ratings refer to page 130 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report. Debt securities are analysed by external ratings and are therefore excluded from the table below and are set out on page 166.

 
Cash and 
balances 
at central 
 banks 
   
Settlement 
balances 
Derivatives 
Other 
financial 
instruments 
Commit- 
ments 
Contingent 
liabilities 
Total 
Loans and advances
Banks (1)
Customers 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Total
                 
AQ1
78,237 
66,190 
117,859 
9,484 
441,743 
789 
69,359 
12,228 
795,889 
AQ2
155 
2,282 
13,375 
457 
8,174 
22,739 
3,459 
50,641 
AQ3
153 
2,630 
27,806 
858 
8,725 
17 
22,571 
4,210 
66,970 
AQ4
31 
1,778 
99,384 
2,650 
15,846 
39,065 
6,089 
164,843 
AQ5
64 
1,538 
98,231 
540 
5,712 
26 
34,170 
3,534 
143,815 
AQ6
168 
40,548 
97 
1,776 
16,136 
1,685 
60,413 
AQ7
151 
37,035 
2,037 
16,605 
1,214 
57,048 
AQ8
140 
14,811 
76 
834 
4,474 
248 
20,584 
AQ9
379 
17,672 
164 
984 
274 
2,938 
1,116 
23,528 
AQ10
1,006 
601 
1,348 
191 
3,149 
Past due
9,848 
979 
10,827 
Impaired
138 
37,764 
414 
38,316 
Impairment provision
(119)
(20,178)
(30)
(20,327)
                   
 
78,647 
75,275 
495,161 
15,312 
486,432 
1,490 
229,405 
33,974 
1,415,696 
                   
31 December 2011
               
                   
AQ1
78,592 
74,192 
113,437 
4,582 
481,622 
556 
75,356 
14,076 
842,413 
AQ2
342 
1,881 
15,622 
93 
8,177 
24,269 
3,154 
53,538 
AQ3
196 
1,981 
32,830 
546 
10,819 
23,471 
4,427 
74,270 
AQ4
19 
1,612 
103,617 
760 
14,421 
40,071 
5,847 
166,347 
AQ5
90 
1,261 
112,537 
79 
6,516 
45 
34,593 
4,301 
159,422 
AQ6
188 
47,892 
46 
2,221 
17,153 
1,662 
69,171 
AQ7
432 
31,379 
13 
2,393 
19,163 
1,037 
54,425 
AQ8
30 
11,871 
19 
1,252 
4,159 
276 
17,614 
AQ9
83 
16,006 
1,150 
320 
2,286 
943 
20,797 
AQ10
164 
570 
1,047 
2,354 
221 
4,363 
Past due
10,995 
1,623 
12,620 
Impaired
137 
38,610 
414 
39,161 
Impairment provision
(123)
(19,760)
(26)
(19,909)
                   
 
79,269 
81,840 
515,606 
7,771 
529,618 
1,309 
242,875 
35,944 
1,494,232 

For the note to this table refer to page 163.
 
 
 
161

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Asset quality (continued)

 
Cash and 
balances 
at central 
 banks 
   
Settlement 
balances 
Derivatives 
Other 
financial 
instruments 
Commit- 
ments 
Contingent 
liabilities 
Total 
Loans and advances
Banks (1)
Customers 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Core
                 
AQ1
78,173 
65,926 
107,587 
9,465 
438,643 
789 
67,957 
11,887 
780,427 
AQ2
154 
2,259 
12,041 
457 
7,526 
22,458 
3,434 
48,329 
AQ3
2,630 
23,042 
858 
8,445 
17 
22,112 
4,113 
61,225 
AQ4
29 
1,778 
93,999 
2,645 
14,656 
38,479 
5,992 
157,578 
AQ5
63 
1,538 
92,594 
521 
4,911 
26 
33,409 
3,335 
136,397 
AQ6
167 
37,404 
97 
1,165 
15,158 
1,635 
55,629 
AQ7
105 
31,642 
1,078 
15,417 
1,151 
49,399 
AQ8
140 
11,082 
76 
694 
4,397 
172 
16,562 
AQ9
310 
13,830 
164 
438 
274 
2,219 
1,067 
18,303 
AQ10
598 
415 
788 
154 
1,958 
Past due
8,773 
979 
9,752 
Impaired
137 
15,005 
414 
15,556 
Impairment
  provision
(118)
(8,826)
(30)
(8,974)
                   
 
78,434 
74,872 
438,771 
15,269 
477,971 
1,490 
222,394 
32,940 
1,342,141 
                   
31 December 2011
               
                   
AQ1
78,534 
73,689 
94,704 
4,566 
477,746 
468 
69,220 
13,247 
812,174 
AQ2
342 
1,877 
13,970 
91 
7,500 
23,404 
3,122 
50,306 
AQ3
56 
1,967 
30,082 
546 
10,360 
22,319 
4,354 
69,684 
AQ4
18 
1,557 
97,001 
759 
13,475 
38,808 
5,655 
157,273 
AQ5
90 
1,256 
105,392 
79 
5,087 
45 
33,226 
4,092 
149,267 
AQ6
140 
41,476 
46 
1,987 
16,118 
1,634 
61,410 
AQ7
432 
27,114 
13 
796 
17,514 
949 
46,826 
AQ8
20 
9,857 
19 
666 
4,068 
236 
14,873 
AQ9
83 
11,515 
592 
272 
1,769 
898 
15,138 
AQ10
164 
264 
339 
1,274 
180 
2,228 
Past due
9,451 
1,623 
11,076 
Impaired
136 
15,170 
413 
15,719 
Impairment
  provision
(122)
(8,292)
(25)
(8,439)
                   
 
79,070 
81,201 
447,704 
7,752 
518,548 
1,173 
227,720 
34,367 
1,397,535 

For the note to this table refer to page 163.
 
 
162

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Asset quality (continued)

 
Cash and 
balances 
at central 
 banks 
   
Settlement 
balances 
Derivatives 
Other 
financial 
instruments 
Commit- 
ments 
Contingent 
liabilities 
Total 
Loans and advances
Banks (1)
Customers 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Non-Core
                 
AQ1
64 
264 
10,272 
19 
3,100 
1,402 
341 
15,462 
AQ2
23 
1,334 
648 
281 
25 
2,312 
AQ3
145 
4,764 
280 
459 
97 
5,745 
AQ4
5,385 
1,190 
586 
97 
7,265 
AQ5
5,637 
19 
801 
761 
199 
7,418 
AQ6
3,144 
611 
978 
50 
4,784 
AQ7
46 
5,393 
959 
1,188 
63 
7,649 
AQ8
3,729 
140 
77 
76 
4,022 
AQ9
69 
3,842 
546 
719 
49 
5,225 
AQ10
408 
186 
560 
37 
1,191 
Past due
1,075 
1,075 
Impaired
22,759 
22,760 
Impairment
  provision
(1)
(11,352)
(11,353)
                   
 
213 
403 
56,390 
43 
8,461 
7,011 
1,034 
73,555 
                   
31 December 2011
               
                   
AQ1
58 
503 
18,733 
16 
3,876 
88 
6,136 
829 
30,239 
AQ2
1,652 
677 
865 
32 
3,232 
AQ3
140 
14 
2,748 
459 
1,152 
73 
4,586 
AQ4
55 
6,616 
946 
1,263 
192 
9,074 
AQ5
7,145 
1,429 
1,367 
209 
10,155 
AQ6
48 
6,416 
234 
1,035 
28 
7,761 
AQ7
4,265 
1,597 
1,649 
88 
7,599 
AQ8
10 
2,014 
586 
91 
40 
2,741 
AQ9
4,491 
558 
48 
517 
45 
5,659 
AQ10
306 
708 
1,080 
41 
2,135 
Past due
1,544 
1,544 
Impaired
23,440 
23,442 
Impairment
  provision
(1)
(11,468)
(1)
(11,470)
                   
 
199 
639 
67,902 
19 
11,070 
136 
15,155 
1,577 
96,697 

Note:
(1)
Excludes items in the course of collection from other banks of £1,866 million (31 December 2011 - £1,470 million).

Key points
·
Overall the asset quality of the Group’s exposures was broadly maintained despite the difficult external conditions in the UK and ongoing eurozone concerns.
   
·
The high proportion of AQ1 exposures in Core included reverse repos and derivatives, most of which are transacted with investment-grade market counterparties.
   
·
Impaired and past due assets comprise more than 30% of Non-Core balances. Continued weakness in commercial real estate market overall and difficult conditions in Ireland were significant contributors to this.
 
 
 
163

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets: Debt securities
The table analyses debt securities by issuer and IFRS measurement classifications.
 
 
Central and local government
         
 
UK 
US 
Other 
Banks 
Other 
financial 
institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
Of which 
ABS 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Held-for-trading
6,378 
19,583 
36,622 
2,478 
24,701 
2,432 
92,194 
23,298 
Designated as at fair value
125 
77 
661 
 9 
873 
558 
Available-for-sale
11,888 
20,077 
17,489 
9,290 
27,989 
2,603 
89,336 
34,344 
Loans and receivables
246 
4,505 
459 
5,223 
4,501 
                 
Long positions
18,276 
39,660 
54,240 
12,091 
57,856 
5,503 
187,626 
62,701 
                 
Of which US agencies
5,982 
27,421 
33,403 
31,748 
                 
Short positions (HFT)
(2,265)
(10,706)
(17,644)
(2,452)
(2,100)
(1,165)
(36,332)
(3,620)
                 
Available-for-sale
               
Gross unrealised gains
1,353 
1,306 
1,110 
76 
682 
121 
4,648 
694 
Gross unrealised losses
(1)
(77)
(694)
(1,589)
(15)
(2,376)
(2,257)
                 
31 December 2011
               
                 
Held-for-trading
9,004 
19,636 
36,928 
3,400 
23,160 
2,948 
95,076 
20,816 
Designated as at fair value
127 
53 
457 
647 
558 
Available-for-sale
13,436 
20,848 
25,552 
13,175 
31,752 
2,535 
107,298 
40,735 
Loans and receivables
10 
312 
5,259 
477 
6,059 
5,200 
                 
Long positions
22,451 
40,484 
62,608 
16,940 
60,628 
5,969 
209,080 
67,309 
                 
Of which US agencies
4,896 
25,924 
30,820 
28,558 
                 
Short positions (HFT)
(3,098)
(10,661)
(19,136)
(2,556)
(2,854)
(754)
(39,059)
(352)
                 
Available-for-sale
               
Gross unrealised gains
1,428 
1,311 
1,180 
52 
913 
94 
4,978 
1,001 
Gross unrealised losses
(171)
(838)
(2,386)
(13)
(3,408)
(3,158)
 
 
 
164

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets: Debt securities (continued)
The table below analyses available-for-sale debt securities and related reserves, gross of tax.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
UK 
US 
Other (1)
Total 
 
UK 
US 
Other (1)
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Central and local government
11,888 
20,077 
17,489 
49,454 
 
13,436 
20,848 
25,552 
59,836 
Banks
1,072 
338 
7,880 
9,290 
 
1,391 
376 
11,408 
13,175 
Other financial institutions
2,975 
14,338 
10,676 
27,989 
 
3,100 
17,453 
11,199 
31,752 
Corporate
1,151 
443 
1,009 
2,603 
 
1,105 
131 
1,299 
2,535 
                   
Total
17,086 
35,196 
37,054 
89,336 
 
19,032 
38,808 
49,458 
107,298 
                   
Of which ABS
3,676 
17,245 
13,423 
34,344 
 
3,659 
20,256 
16,820 
40,735 
                   
AFS reserves (gross)
916 
756 
(1,516)
156 
 
845 
486 
(1,815)
(484)

Note:
(1)
Includes eurozone countries as detailed in the Country risk section of this report.

Key points
·
Debt securities decreased by £21.5 billion or 10% in H1 2012, £18.0 billion in AFS across the Group and £2.9 billion of HFT positions in Markets reflecting a combination of de-risking strategies and balance sheet management.
   
·
HFT: the £2.9 billion decrease comprised £3.0 billion of government, £0.9 billion of banks and £0.5 billion of corporate bonds, partially offset by a £1.5 billion increase in bonds issued by other financial institutions. Disposals of UK government bonds of £2.6 billion in Markets, reflected balance sheet management strategy. Danish and German positions increased by £1.3 billion respectively, whilst French bond holdings reduced by £2.6 billion. The increase in US financial institution bonds of £0.9 billion related to RMBS G10 bonds, reflecting the purchase of high demand mortgage pools.
   
·
AFS: decreased by £18.0 billion, comprising £10.4 billion relating to central and local government, £3.9 billion relating to banks and £3.8 billion of other financial institution bonds. UK government bonds fell by £1.5 billion due to disposals and a change in the Direct Line Group investment strategy in Q1 2012. Disposals from the Group Treasury liquidity portfolio resulted in lower government bonds, primarily German and French (£4.9 billion). Japanese government bonds fell by £2.2 billion reflecting a reduced collateral requirement following a change in clearing status from direct (self-clearing) to agency. Bank bonds decreased by £3.9 billion of which £1.8 billion related to Spanish covered bonds in Group Treasury and lower positions in Australian and German securities reflected the close out of positions and maturities respectively. Non-Core disposals led to a £2.1 billion reduction in ABS issued by SPVs.
 
 
 
165

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets: Debt securities (continued)
The table below analyses debt securities by issuer and external ratings. Ratings are based on the lowest of Standard and Poor’s, Moody’s and Fitch.
 
 
Central and local government
           
30 June 2012
UK 
US 
Other 
Banks 
Other 
financial 
institutions 
Corporate 
Total 
 
Of which 
ABS 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
% of 
total 
£m 
                   
AAA
18,276 
43 
20,423 
2,389 
12,136 
170 
53,437 
29 
11,183 
AA to AA+
39,597 
8,833 
1,461 
32,061 
653 
82,605 
44 
36,498 
A to AA-
18 
17,168 
3,292 
3,795 
1,722 
25,995 
14 
3,521 
BBB- to A-
7,070 
4,209 
4,390 
1,423 
17,092 
7,457 
Non-investment grade
732 
395 
3,978 
908 
6,013 
3,231 
Unrated
14 
345 
1,496 
627 
2,484 
811 
                   
 
18,276 
39,660 
54,240 
12,091 
57,856 
5,503 
187,626 
100 
62,701 
                   
31 December 2011
                 
                   
AAA
22,451 
45 
32,522 
5,155 
15,908 
452 
76,533 
37 
17,156 
AA to AA+
40,435 
2,000 
2,497 
30,403 
639 
75,974 
36 
33,615 
A to AA-
24,966 
6,387 
4,979 
1,746 
38,079 
18 
6,331 
BBB- to A-
2,194 
2,287 
2,916 
1,446 
8,843 
4,480 
Non-investment grade
924 
575 
5,042 
1,275 
7,816 
4,492 
Unrated
39 
1,380 
411 
1,835 
1,235 
                   
 
22,451 
40,484 
62,608 
16,940 
60,628 
5,969 
209,080 
100 
67,309 

Key points
·
AAA rated debt securities decreased as France and Austria were downgraded to AA+ and the Group reduced its holdings of UK government bonds. Additionally, certain Spanish covered bonds and the Dutch bond portfolio were downgraded during the half year.
   
·
The decrease in A to AA- debt securities related to further downgrades of Italy and Spain to BBB+ and A- respectively and a downgrade of selected bank ratings.
   
·
Non-investment grade and unrated debt securities accounted for 4% of the portfolio at 30 June 2012.
 
 
 
166

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets: Debt securities (continued)

Asset-backed securities
The table below summarises the rating levels of ABS carrying values.

 
RMBS (1)
             
 
Government 
sponsored 
or similar (2)
Prime 
Non- 
conforming 
Sub-prime 
MBS 
covered 
bond 
 
CMBS (3)
CDOs (4)
CLOs (5)
ABS 
covered 
bonds 
ABS 
other 
Total 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
AAA
2,530 
3,030 
1,472 
41 
875 
372 
119 
1,457 
153 
1,134 
11,183 
AA to AA+
31,978 
746 
88 
42 
201 
1,191 
1,362 
329 
555 
36,498 
A to AA-
191 
443 
317 
46 
162 
1,020 
86 
259 
997 
3,521 
BBB- to A-
1,157 
46 
94 
115 
4,360 
305 
51 
268 
1,053 
7,457 
Non-investment grade
20 
610 
495 
356 
63 
510 
469 
168 
540 
3,231 
Unrated
142 
57 
34 
96 
225 
250 
811 
                       
 
35,876 
5,017 
2,473 
657 
5,661 
3,432 
827 
3,739 
490 
4,529 
62,701 
                       
Of which in Non-Core
722 
407 
166 
843 
602 
3,104 
1,541 
7,385 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
AAA
4,169 
3,599 
1,488 
105 
2,595 
647 
135 
2,171 
625 
1,622 
17,156 
AA to AA+
29,252 
669 
106 
60 
379 
710 
35 
1,533 
321 
550 
33,615 
A to AA-
131 
506 
110 
104 
2,567 
1,230 
161 
697 
100 
725 
6,331 
BBB- to A-
39 
288 
93 
1,979 
333 
86 
341 
1,321 
4,480 
Non-investment grade
21 
784 
658 
396 
415 
1,370 
176 
672 
4,492 
Unrated
148 
29 
146 
56 
170 
423 
263 
1,235 
                       
 
33,573 
5,745 
2,679 
904 
7,520 
3,391 
1,957 
5,341 
1,046 
5,153 
67,309 
                       
Of which in Non-Core
837 
477 
308 
830 
1,656 
4,227 
1,861 
10,196 

Notes:
(1)
Residential mortgage-backed securities.
(2)
Includes US agency and Dutch government guaranteed securities.
(3)
Commercial mortgage-backed securities.
(4)
Collateralised debt obligations.
(5)
Collateralised loan obligations.
 
 
 
167

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Derivatives
The table below analyses the fair value of the Group’s derivatives by type of contract. Master netting arrangements in respect of mark-to-market (mtm) positions and collateral shown below do not result in a net presentation in the Group’s balance sheet under IFRS.

 
30 June 2012
   
 
Notional
     
31 December 2011
 
GBP 
USD 
Euro 
Other 
Total 
Assets 
Liabilities 
 
Notional 
Assets 
Liabilities 
Contract type
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£m 
£m 
 
£bn 
£m 
£m 
                       
Interest rate (1)
5,196 
12,619 
10,343 
6,938 
35,096 
400,528 
383,108 
 
38,722 
422,156 
406,709 
Exchange rate
388 
1,947 
813 
1,887 
5,035 
61,768 
70,794 
 
4,479 
74,492 
80,980 
Credit
118 
432 
261 
18 
829 
18,475 
17,477 
 
1,054 
26,836 
26,743 
Other (2)
15 
47 
40 
34 
136 
5,661 
9,366 
 
123 
6,134 
9,551 
                       
           
486,432 
480,745 
   
529,618 
523,983 
Counterparty mtm netting
     
(408,500)
(408,500)
   
(441,626)
(441,626)
Cash collateral
         
(37,480)
(29,935)
   
(37,222)
(31,368)
Securities collateral
       
(4,277)
(7,243)
   
(5,312)
(8,585)
                       
           
36,175 
35,067 
   
45,458 
42,404 
 
Notes:
(1)
Interest rate notional includes £15,436 billion (31 December 2011 - £16,377 billion) relating to contracts with central clearing houses.
(2)
Other comprises equity and commodity derivatives.

Key points
·
Net exposure, after taking account of position and collateral netting arrangements, decreased by 20% (liabilities decreased by 17%) due to lower derivative fair values, driven by market movements, including foreign exchange rates and increased use of compression trades.
   
·
Interest rate contracts decreased due to the increased use of compression trades reflecting a greater number of market participants and hence trade-matching and the effect of exchange rate movements. This was partially offset by a decrease in clearing house netting.
   
·
The decrease in exchange rate contracts reflected the impact of exchange rate movements, partially offset by higher trade volumes.
   
·
Credit derivative fair values and notionals decreased due to a managed risk reduction in particular in Non-Core and an increase in compression trades. Refer to the table that follows for additional analysis on bought and sold credit derivatives.
 
 
 
168

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Financial assets (continued)

Credit derivatives
The Group trades credit derivatives as part of its client led business and to mitigate credit risk. The Group’s credit derivative exposures relating to proprietary trading are minimal. The table below analyses the Group’s bought and sold protection.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional
 
Fair value
 
Notional
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
Group
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
                       
Client-led trading & residual risk
298.4 
285.5 
 
9.0 
8.5 
 
401.0 
390.5 
 
17.0 
16.5 
Credit hedging - banking
  book (1)
9.5 
1.0 
 
0.1 
 
15.6 
4.7 
 
0.1 
0.1 
Credit hedging - trading book
                     
  - rates
18.8 
16.1 
 
1.0 
1.1 
 
21.2 
17.1 
 
0.9 
1.7 
  - credit and mortgage markets
47.3 
37.5 
 
2.0 
1.6 
 
42.9 
28.4 
 
2.3 
1.7 
  - other
1.2 
0.2 
 
0.1 
 
0.9 
0.1 
 
                       
Total excluding APS
375.2 
340.3 
 
12.2 
11.2 
 
481.6 
440.8 
 
20.3 
20.0 
APS
113.1 
 
 
131.8 
 
(0.2)
                       
 
488.3 
340.3 
 
12.2 
11.2 
 
613.4 
440.8 
 
20.1 
20.0 

Core
                     
                       
Client-led trading
275.4 
271.2 
 
7.9 
7.6 
 
371.0 
369.4 
 
14.6 
14.0 
Credit hedging - banking book
2.3 
0.2 
 
 
2.2 
1.0 
 
0.1 
Credit hedging - trading book
                     
  - rates
17.5 
15.3 
 
0.9 
1.1 
 
19.9 
16.2 
 
0.9 
1.7 
  - credit and mortgage markets
14.4 
13.8 
 
0.4 
0.4 
 
4.6 
4.0 
 
0.3 
0.2 
  - other
1.0 
0.1 
 
0.1 
 
0.7 
0.1 
 
                       
 
310.6 
300.6 
 
9.3 
9.1 
 
398.4 
390.7 
 
15.8 
16.0 

Non-Core
                     
                       
Residual risk
23.0 
14.3 
 
1.1 
0.9 
 
30.0 
21.1 
 
2.4 
2.5 
Credit hedging - banking
  book (1)
7.2 
0.8 
 
0.1 
 
13.4 
3.7 
 
0.1 
Credit hedging - trading book
                     
  - rates
1.3 
0.8 
 
0.1 
 
1.3 
0.9 
 
  - credit and mortgage markets
32.9 
23.7 
 
1.6 
1.2 
 
38.3 
24.4 
 
2.0 
1.5 
  - other
0.2 
0.1 
 
 
0.2 
 
                       
 
64.6 
39.7 
 
2.9 
2.1 
 
83.2 
50.1 
 
4.5 
4.0 

By counterparty
                     
                       
Central government (APS)
113.1 
 
 
131.8 
 
(0.2)
Monoline insurers
5.9 
 
0.4 
 
8.6 
 
0.6 
CDPCs
22.4 
 
0.7 
 
24.5 
 
0.9 
Banks
164.9 
160.3 
 
6.1 
6.2 
 
204.1 
202.1 
 
8.5 
10.2 
Other financial institutions
181.0 
180.0 
 
5.0 
5.0 
 
234.8 
231.6 
 
10.5 
9.5 
Corporates
1.0 
 
 
9.6 
7.1 
 
(0.2)
0.3 
                       
 
488.3 
340.3 
 
12.2 
11.2 
 
613.4 
440.8 
 
20.1 
20.0 

Note:
(1)
Credit hedging in the banking book principally relates to portfolio management in Non-Core.
 
 
 
169

 

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk

Problem debt management
The following tables analyse loans and advances to banks and customers (excluding reverse repos) and the related debt management measures and ratios by division.

Refer to pages 94 to 99 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report and Accounts for policies, methodologies and approaches to problem debt management.
 
 
Gross loans to
   
Credit metrics
   
 
banks 
customers 
REIL 
Impairment 
provisions 
REIL as a % 
of gross 
loans to 
customers 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
%
%
£m 
£m 
UK Retail
854 
105,559 
4,115 
2,376 
3.9 
58 
295 
299 
UK Corporate
884 
98,108 
3,938 
1,845 
4.0 
47 
357 
218 
Wealth
1,747 
16,985 
229 
99 
1.3 
43 
22 
International Banking
5,219 
50,138 
682 
694 
1.4 
102 
62 
210 
Ulster Bank
2,286 
33,008 
6,234 
3,307 
18.9 
53 
717 
28 
US Retail & Commercial
232 
52,239 
1,022 
340 
2.0 
33 
43 
192 
                 
Retail & Commercial
11,222 
356,037 
16,220 
8,661 
4.6 
53 
1,496 
950 
Markets
23,614 
30,398 
345 
283 
1.1 
82 
19 
41 
Direct Line Group and other
4,316 
1,055 
                 
Core
39,152 
387,490 
16,565 
8,944 
4.3 
54 
1,515 
991 
Non-Core
403 
67,653 
23,088 
11,353 
34.1 
49 
1,215 
934 
                 
Group
39,555 
455,143 
39,653 
20,297 
8.7 
51 
2,730 
1,925 
                 
Total including disposal groups
39,643 
475,624 
41,106 
21,078 
8.6 
51 
2,730 
1,925 
                 
31 December 2011
           
Full year 
Impairment 
charge 
Full year 
Amounts 
written-off 
                 
UK Retail
628 
103,377 
4,087 
2,344 
4.0 
57 
788 
823 
UK Corporate
806 
98,563 
3,988 
1,623 
4.0 
41 
790 
658 
Wealth
2,422 
16,913 
211 
81 
1.2 
38 
25 
11 
International Banking
3,411 
57,728 
1,632 
851 
2.8 
52 
168 
125 
Ulster Bank
2,079 
34,052 
5,523 
2,749 
16.2 
50 
1,384 
124 
US Retail & Commercial
208 
51,562 
1,007 
455 
2.0 
45 
248 
373 
                 
Retail & Commercial
9,554 
362,195 
16,448 
8,103 
4.5 
49 
3,403 
2,114 
Markets
29,991 
31,490 
414 
311 
1.3 
75 
23 
Direct Line Group and other
3,829 
929 
                 
Core
43,374 
394,614 
16,862 
8,414 
4.3 
50 
3,403 
2,137 
Non-Core
619 
79,258 
23,983 
11,469 
30.3 
48 
3,838 
2,390 
                 
Group
43,993 
473,872 
40,845 
19,883 
8.6 
49 
7,241 
4,527 
                 
Total including disposal groups
44,080 
494,068 
42,394 
20,674 
8.6 
49 
7,241 
4,527 
 
 
170

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Key points
·
Total REIL decreased from £42.4 billion to £41.1 billion in the first half of 2012. REIL excluding disposal groups were lower than year-end at £39.7 billion; Group provisions coverage increased from 49% to 51%. Ulster Bank Group coverage increased from 53% to 56%, with both Core and Non-Core higher at 53% and 57% respectively reflecting continuing difficult credit conditions.
   
·
Within Core a £0.7 billion increase in Ulster Bank REIL was offset by reductions in International Banking.
   
·
REIL excluding disposal groups as a proportion of loans increased marginally from 8.6% to 8.7%, with Non-Core increasing from 30.3% to 34.1%, primarily driven by the Ulster Bank Non-Core commercial real estate portfolio.
   
·
Core annualised impairments fell to 0.7% of customer loans from 0.8% at 31 December 2011 aided by favourable trends in the UK Retail and US Retail & Commercial.
   
·
Credit metrics remained broadly stable across most sectors and overall ratios were 8.7% and 51% respectively compared with 8.6% and 49%, excluding disposal groups.
   
·
Commercial real estate lending included within Property and construction was as follows:
 
 
Total
 
Non-Core
 
30 June 
2012
31 December 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
Lending
£69.3bn 
£74.8bn 
 
£30.4bn 
£34.3bn 
REIL
£21.7bn 
£22.9bn 
 
£18.1bn 
£18.8bn 
Provisions
£9.4bn 
£9.5bn 
 
£8.0bn 
£8.2bn 
REIL as a % of gross loans to customers
31.3% 
30.6% 
 
59.5% 
54.8% 
Provisions as a % of REIL
43% 
42% 
 
44% 
44% 
 
Ulster Bank is a significant contributor to the Non-Core commercial real estate lending. Refer to the Key credit portfolios section on Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core).
 
 
 
171

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)
The following tables analyse loans and advances to banks and customers (excluding reverse repos and assets of disposal groups) and the related debt management by sector and geography (by location of office) for the Group, Core and Non-Core. Loans, REIL and provisions exclude amounts relating to businesses held for disposal, consistent with the balance sheet presentation required by IFRS.
30 June 2012
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Group
               
Government (1)
10,662 
Other finance
46,117 
876 
532 
1.9 
61 
1.2 
74 
195 
Personal
- mortgages
144,351 
5,475 
1,548 
3.8 
28 
1.1 
492 
238 
 
- unsecured
31,639 
2,667 
2,212 
8.4 
83 
7.0 
324 
369 
Property and construction
79,705 
22,133 
9,667 
27.8 
44 
12.1 
1,104 
696 
Manufacturing
25,767 
842 
492 
3.3 
58 
1.9 
57 
92 
Finance leases (2)
14,096 
725 
471 
5.1 
65 
3.3 
35 
77 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
21,949 
1,067 
578 
4.9 
54 
2.6 
126 
55 
Transport and storage
19,449 
727 
326 
3.7 
45 
1.7 
191 
Health, education and leisure
13,905 
1,048 
469 
7.5 
45 
3.4 
102 
52 
Hotels and restaurants
7,917 
1,494 
702 
18.9 
47 
8.9 
116 
34 
Utilities
8,058 
72 
29 
0.9 
40 
0.4 
Other
31,528 
2,389 
1,303 
7.6 
55 
4.1 
197 
84 
Latent
1,849 
(113)
                 
 
455,143 
39,515 
20,178 
8.7 
51 
4.4 
2,706 
1,900 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
102,506 
2,118 
379 
2.1 
18 
0.4 
58 
27 
  - personal lending
18,941 
2,324 
1,975 
12.3 
85 
10.4 
274 
298 
  - property and construction
57,939 
10,899 
3,939 
18.8 
36 
6.8 
564 
312 
  - other
121,738 
3,569 
2,520 
2.9 
71 
2.1 
241 
231 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
17,990 
2,564 
947 
14.3 
37 
5.3 
284 
10 
  - personal lending
2,221 
221 
190 
10.0 
86 
8.6 
27 
12 
  - property and construction
16,369 
10,595 
5,509 
64.7 
52 
33.7 
519 
299 
  - other
31,421 
4,770 
3,123 
15.2 
65 
9.9 
546 
255 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
23,312 
760 
210 
3.3 
28 
0.9 
150 
201 
  - personal lending
8,919 
121 
46 
1.4 
38 
0.5 
23 
59 
  - property and construction
4,681 
356 
84 
7.6 
24 
1.8 
48 
  - other
32,760 
465 
789 
1.4 
170 
2.4 
(18)
96 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
543 
33 
12 
6.1 
36 
2.2 
  - personal lending
1,558 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
  - property and construction
716 
283 
135 
39.5 
48 
18.9 
13 
37 
  - other
13,529 
436 
319 
3.2 
73 
2.4 
17 
15 
                 
 
455,143 
39,515 
20,178 
8.7 
51 
4.4 
2,706 
1,900 
                 
Banks
39,555 
138 
119 
0.3 
86 
0.3 
24 
25 

For the notes to this table refer to page 177.
 
 
 
172

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

31 December 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Full year 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
Full year 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Group
               
Government (1)
9,742 
-
Other finance
49,681 
1,049 
719 
2.1 
69 
1.4 
89 
87 
Personal
- mortgages
143,611 
5,084 
1,362 
3.5 
27 
0.9 
1,076 
516 
 
- unsecured
32,623 
2,737 
2,172 
8.4 
79 
6.7 
782 
1,286 
Property and construction
86,221 
23,417 
9,565 
27.2 
41 
11.1 
3,809 
1,415 
Manufacturing
28,132 
881 
504 
3.1 
57 
1.8 
227 
215 
Finance leases (2)
14,499 
794 
508 
5.5 
64 
3.5 
112 
170 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
23,653 
1,007 
516 
4.3 
51 
2.2 
180 
172 
Transport and storage
21,931 
589 
146 
2.7 
25 
0.7 
78 
43 
Health, education and leisure
14,692 
1,077 
458 
7.3 
43 
3.1 
304 
98 
Hotels and restaurants
8,304 
1,437 
643 
17.3 
45 
7.7 
334 
131 
Utilities
8,392 
88 
23 
1.0 
26 
0.3 
Other
32,391 
2,548 
1,158 
7.9 
45 
3.6 
792 
391 
Latent
1,986 
(545)
                 
 
473,872 
40,708 
19,760 
8.6 
49 
4.2 
7,241 
4,527 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
100,726 
2,076 
397 
2.1 
19 
0.4 
180 
25 
  - personal lending
20,207 
2,384 
1,925 
11.8 
81 
9.5 
645 
1,007 
  - property and construction
62,924 
11,947 
4,207 
19.0 
35 
6.7 
1,598 
721 
  - other
125,265 
4,256 
2,678 
3.4 
63 
2.1 
514 
655 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
18,946 
2,205 
713 
11.6 
32 
3.8 
467 
10 
  - personal lending
2,464 
209 
180 
8.5 
86 
7.3 
25 
126 
  - property and construction
18,138 
10,676 
5,132 
58.9 
48 
28.3 
2,234 
504 
  - other
34,497 
4,261 
2,873 
12.4 
67 
8.3 
1,267 
293 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
23,237 
770 
240 
3.3 
31 
1.0 
426 
481 
  - personal lending
8,441 
143 
66 
1.7 
46 
0.8 
112 
153 
  - property and construction
4,240 
450 
102 
10.6 
23 
2.4 
155 
  - other
37,015 
517 
895 
1.4 
173 
2.4 
(175)
180 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
702 
33 
12 
4.7 
36 
1.7 
  - personal lending
1,511 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
  - property and construction
919 
344 
124 
37.4 
36 
13.5 
(30)
35 
  - other
14,640 
436 
215 
3.0 
49 
1.5 
(32)
182 
                 
 
473,872 
40,708 
19,760
8.6 
49 
4.2 
7,241 
4,527 
                 
Banks
43,993 
137 
123 
0.3 
90 
0.3 
-

For notes to this table refer to page 177.
 
 
 
173

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

30 June 2012
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Government (1)
9,278 
Other finance
43,123 
424 
327 
1.0 
77 
0.8 
15 
194 
Personal
- mortgages
140,814 
5,175 
1,402 
3.7 
27 
1.0 
412 
129 
 
- unsecured
30,416 
2,564 
2,127 
8.4 
83 
7.0 
296 
330 
Property and construction
43,315 
3,870 
1,481 
8.9 
38 
3.4 
409 
139 
Manufacturing
21,928 
445 
240 
2.0 
54 
1.1 
42 
11 
Finance leases (2)
8,834 
158 
102 
1.8 
65 
1.2 
14 
26 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
20,080 
656 
363 
3.3 
55 
1.8 
81 
39 
Transport and storage
15,384 
276 
67 
1.8 
24 
0.4 
19 
Health, education and leisure
12,936 
633 
261 
4.9 
41 
2.0 
88 
38 
Hotels and restaurants
6,900 
957 
424 
13.9 
44 
6.1 
74 
16 
Utilities
6,382 
0.1 
75 
0.1 
Other
28,100 
1,262 
782 
4.5 
62 
2.8 
118 
37 
Latent
1,244 
(78)
                 
 
387,490 
16,428 
8,826 
4.2 
54 
2.3 
1,491 
966 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
102,449 
2,118 
379 
2.1 
18 
0.4 
58 
27 
  - personal lending
18,857 
2,298 
1,954 
12.2 
85 
10.4 
270 
285 
  - property and construction
33,716 
2,354 
891 
7.0 
38 
2.6 
260 
105 
  - other
106,562 
2,101 
1,405 
2.0 
67 
1.3 
158 
136 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
17,489 
2,487 
896 
14.2 
36 
5.1 
280 
  - personal lending
1,794 
149 
131 
8.3 
88 
7.3 
20 
  - property and construction
5,406 
1,276 
517 
23.6 
41 
9.6 
134 
13 
  - other
23,267 
2,343 
1,818 
10.1 
78 
7.8 
259 
166 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
20,528 
537 
115 
2.6 
21 
0.6 
74 
93 
  - personal lending
8,208 
116 
41 
1.4 
35 
0.5 
37 
  - property and construction
3,847 
162 
27 
4.2 
17 
0.7 
15 
21 
  - other
31,390 
254 
464 
0.8 
183 
1.5 
(51)
63 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
348 
33 
12 
9.5 
36 
3.4 
  - personal lending
1,557 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
  - property and construction
346 
78 
46 
22.5 
59 
13.3 
  - other
11,726 
121 
129 
1.0 
107 
1.1 
                 
 
387,490 
16,428 
8,826 
4.2 
54 
2.3 
1,491 
966 
                 
Banks
39,152 
137 
118 
0.3 
86 
0.3 
24 
25 

For the notes to this table refer to page 177.
 
 
 
174

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

31 December 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Full year 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
Full year 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Government (1)
8,359 
Other finance
46,452 
732 
572 
1.6 
78 
1.2 
207 
44 
Personal
- mortgages
138,509 
4,704 
1,182 
3.4 
25 
0.9 
776 
198 
 
- unsecured
31,067 
2,627 
2,080 
8.5 
79 
6.7 
715 
935 
Property and construction
45,485 
4,346 
1,229 
9.6 
28 
2.7 
648 
310 
Manufacturing
23,201 
458 
221 
2.0 
48 
1.0 
106 
125 
Finance leases (2)
8,440 
172 
110 
2.0 
64 
1.3 
31 
68 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
21,314 
619 
312 
2.9 
50 
1.5 
208 
119 
Transport and storage
16,454 
325 
52 
2.0 
16 
0.3 
47 
29 
Health, education and leisure
13,273 
576 
213 
4.3 
37 
1.6 
170 
55 
Hotels and restaurants
7,143 
952 
354 
13.3 
37 
5.0 
209 
60 
Utilities
6,543 
22 
0.3 
Other
28,374 
1,193 
627 
4.2 
53 
2.2 
538 
194 
Latent
1,339 
(252)
                 
 
394,614 
16,726 
8,292 
4.2 
50 
2.1 
3,403 
2,137 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
99,303 
2,024 
386 
2.0 
19 
0.4 
174 
24 
  - personal lending
20,080 
2,347 
1,895 
11.7 
81 
9.4 
657 
828 
  - property and construction
36,432 
3,012 
790 
8.3 
26 
2.2 
538 
252 
  - other
107,598 
2,192 
1,383 
2.0 
63 
1.3 
366 
398 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
18,393 
2,121 
664 
11.5 
31 
3.6 
437 
10 
  - personal lending
1,972 
143 
125 
7.3 
87 
6.3 
(8)
22 
  - property and construction
5,865 
1,109 
408 
18.9 
37 
7.0 
175 
10 
  - other
24,414 
2,430 
1,806 
10.0 
74 
7.4 
915 
183 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
20,311 
526 
120 
2.6 
23 
0.6 
162 
164 
  - personal lending
7,505 
136 
59 
1.8 
43 
0.8 
66 
85 
  - property and construction
2,825 
209 
25 
7.4 
12 
0.9 
16 
48 
  - other
34,971 
345 
583 
1.0 
169 
1.7 
26 
96 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
502 
33 
12 
6.6 
36 
2.4 
  - personal lending
1,510 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
  - property and construction
363 
16 
4.4 
38 
1.7 
(81)
  - other
12,570 
82 
29 
0.7 
35 
0.2 
(43)
17 
                 
 
394,614 
16,726 
8,292 
4.2 
50 
2.1 
3,403 
2,137 
                 
Banks
43,374 
136 
122 
0.3 
90 
0.3 
-

For the notes to this table refer to page 177.
 
 
 
175

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

30 June 2012
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Non-Core
               
Government (1)
1,384 
Other finance
2,994 
452 
205 
15.1 
45 
6.8 
59 
Personal
- mortgages
3,537 
300 
146 
8.5 
49 
4.1 
80 
109 
 
- unsecured
1,223 
103 
85 
8.4 
83 
7.0 
28 
39 
Property and construction
36,390 
18,263 
8,186 
50.2 
45 
22.5 
695 
557 
Manufacturing
3,839 
397 
252 
10.3 
63 
6.6 
15 
81 
Finance leases (2)
5,262 
567 
369 
10.8 
65 
7.0 
21 
51 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
1,869 
411 
215 
22.0 
52 
11.5 
45 
16 
Transport and storage
4,065 
451 
259 
11.1 
57 
6.4 
172 
Health, education and leisure
969 
415 
208 
42.8 
50 
21.5 
14 
14 
Hotels and restaurants
1,017 
537 
278 
52.8 
52 
27.3 
42 
18 
Utilities
1,676 
64 
23 
3.8 
36 
1.4 
Other
3,428 
1,127 
521 
32.9 
46 
15.2 
79 
47 
Latent
605 
(35)
                 
 
67,653 
23,087 
11,352 
34.1 
49 
16.8 
1,215 
934 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
57 
  - personal lending
84 
26 
21 
31.0 
81 
25.0 
13 
  - property and construction
24,223 
8,545 
3,048 
35.3 
36 
12.6 
304 
207 
  - other
15,176 
1,468 
1,115 
9.7 
76 
7.3 
83 
95 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
501 
77 
51 
15.4 
66 
10.2 
  - personal lending
427 
72 
59 
16.9 
82 
13.8 
  - property and construction
10,963 
9,319 
4,992 
85.0 
54 
45.5 
385 
286 
  - other
8,154 
2,427 
1,305 
29.8 
54 
16.0 
287 
89 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
2,784 
223 
95 
8.0 
43 
3.4 
76 
108 
  - personal lending
711 
0.7 
100 
0.7 
17 
22 
  - property and construction
834 
194 
57 
23.3 
29 
6.8 
(7)
27 
  - other
1,370 
211 
325 
15.4 
154 
23.7 
33 
33 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
195 
  - personal lending
  - property and construction
370 
205 
89 
55.4 
43 
24.1 
13 
37 
  - other
1,803 
315 
190 
17.5 
60 
10.5 
12 
                 
 
67,653 
23,087 
11,352 
34.1 
49 
16.8 
1,215 
934 
                 
Banks
403 
0.2 
100 
0.2 

For the notes to this table refer to page 177.
 
 
 
176

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

31 December 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
loans 
Full year 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
Full year 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Non-Core
               
Government (1)
1,383 
Other finance
3,229 
317 
147 
9.8 
46 
4.6 
(118)
43 
Personal
- mortgages
5,102 
380 
180 
7.4 
47 
3.5 
300 
318 
 
- unsecured
1,556 
110 
92 
7.1 
84 
5.9 
67 
351 
Property and construction
40,736 
19,071 
8,336 
46.8 
44 
20.5 
3,161 
1,105 
Manufacturing
4,931 
423 
283 
8.6 
67 
5.7 
121 
90 
Finance leases (2)
6,059 
622 
398 
10.3 
64 
6.6 
81 
102 
Retail, wholesale and repairs
2,339 
388 
204 
16.6 
53 
8.7 
(28)
53 
Transport and storage
5,477 
264 
94 
4.8 
36 
1.7 
31 
14 
Health, education and leisure
1,419 
501 
245 
35.3 
49 
17.3 
134 
43 
Hotels and restaurants
1,161 
485 
289 
41.8 
60 
24.9 
125 
71 
Utilities
1,849 
66 
22 
3.6 
33 
1.2 
Other
4,017 
1,355 
531 
33.7 
39 
13.2 
254 
197 
Latent
647 
(293)
                 
 
79,258 
23,982 
11,468 
30.3 
48 
14.5 
3,838 
2,390 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
1,423 
52 
11 
3.7 
21 
0.8 
  - personal lending
127 
37 
30 
29.1 
81 
23.6 
(12)
179 
  - property and construction
26,492 
8,935 
3,417 
33.7 
38 
12.9 
1,060 
469 
  - other
17,667 
2,064 
1,295 
11.7 
63 
7.3 
148 
257 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
553 
84 
49 
15.2 
58 
8.9 
30 
  - personal lending
492 
66 
55 
13.4 
83 
11.2 
33 
104 
  - property and construction
12,273 
9,567 
4,724 
78.0 
49 
38.5 
2,059 
494 
  - other
10,083 
1,831 
1,067 
18.2 
58 
10.6 
352 
110 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
2,926 
244 
120 
8.3 
49 
4.1 
264 
317 
  - personal lending
936 
0.7 
100 
0.7 
46 
68 
  - property and construction
1,415 
241 
77 
17.0 
32 
5.4 
(9)
107 
  - other
2,044 
172 
312 
8.4 
181 
15.3 
(201)
84 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
200 
  - personal lending
  - property and construction
556 
328 
118 
59.0 
36 
21.2 
51 
35 
  - other
2,070 
354 
186 
17.1 
53 
9.0 
11 
165 
                 
 
79,258 
23,982 
11,468 
30.3 
48 
14.5 
3,838 
2,390 
                 
Banks
619 
0.2 
100 
0.2 

Notes:
(1)
Government includes central and local government.
(2)
Includes instalment credit.
 
 
 
177

 

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Risk elements in lending (REIL)
REIL are stated without giving effect to any security held that could reduce the eventual loss should it occur or to any provisions marked. The table below details the movement in REIL for the first half of 2012.
 
 
Impaired loans
 
Other loans (1)
 
REIL
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
At 1 January 2012
15,306 
23,441 
38,747 
 
1,556 
542 
2,098 
 
16,862 
23,983 
40,845 
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(150)
(541)
(691)
 
51 
(7)
 44 
 
(99)
(548)
(647)
Additions
3,127 
2,529 
5,656 
 
1,167 
224 
1,391 
 
4,294 
2,753 
7,047 
Transfers
33 
124 
157 
 
(126)
(130)
(256)
 
(93)
(6)
(99)
Disposals and restructurings
(647)
(346)
(993)
 
(109)
(6)
(115)
 
(756)
(352)
(1,108)
Repayments
(1,536)
(1,513)
(3,049)
 
(1,116)
(295)
(1,411)
 
(2,652)
(1,808)
(4,460)
Amounts written-off
(991)
(934)
(1,925)
 
 
(991)
(934)
(1,925)
                       
At 30 June 2012
15,142 
22,760 
37,902 
 
1,423 
328 
1,751 
 
16,565 
23,088 
39,653 

Note:
(1)
Accruing loans past due 90 days or more where an impairment event has taken place but no impairment provision has been recognised. This category is used for fully collateralised non-revolving credit facilities.

The table below analyses the Group’s REIL between UK and overseas, based on the location of the lending office.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Impaired loans (1)
             
  - UK
7,672 
9,788 
17,460 
 
8,467 
10,580 
19,047 
  - overseas
7,470 
12,972 
20,442 
 
6,839 
12,861 
19,700 
               
 
15,142 
22,760 
37,902 
 
15,306 
23,441 
38,747 
               
Accruing loans past due
  90 days or more (2)
             
  - UK
1,286 
251 
1,537 
 
1,192 
508 
1,700 
  - overseas
137 
77 
214 
 
364 
34 
398 
               
 
1,423 
328 
1,751 
 
1,556 
542 
2,098 
               
Total REIL
16,565 
23,088 
39,653 
 
16,862 
23,983 
40,845 
               
REIL including disposal groups
   
41,106 
     
42,394 
               
REIL as a % of gross loans
  and advances (3)
4.4% 
34.0% 
8.6% 
 
4.4% 
30.1% 
8.6% 
Provisions as a % of REIL
54% 
49% 
51% 
 
50% 
48% 
49% 

Notes:
(1)
All loans against which an impairment provision is held.
(2)
Loans where an impairment event has taken place but no impairment provision recognised. This category is used for fully collateralised non-revolving credit facilities.
(3)
Includes disposal groups but excludes reverse repos.

Key point
·
Group REIL including disposal groups decreased by £1.3 billion in H1 2012 despite the difficult economic climate, due to several material write-offs and recoveries within Non-Core portfolios.
 
 
 
178

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Impairment provisions
The table below analyses impairment provisions in respect of loans and advances to banks and customers.
 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Individually assessed
2,797 
10,071 
12,868 
 
2,674 
9,960 
12,634 
Collectively assessed
4,785 
676 
5,461 
 
4,279 
861 
5,140 
Latent loss
1,244 
605 
1,849 
 
1,339 
647 
1,986 
               
Loans and advances to customers
8,826 
11,352 
20,178 
 
8,292 
11,468 
19,760 
Loans and advances to banks
118 
119 
 
122 
123 
               
Total provisions
8,944 
11,353 
20,297 
 
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
               
Provisions as a % of REIL
54% 
49% 
51% 
 
50% 
48% 
49% 
Customer provisions as a % of customer loans (1)
2.4% 
16.7% 
4.4% 
 
2.2% 
14.4% 
4.2% 

Note:
(1)
Includes disposal groups but excludes reverse repos.

Key point
·
Impairment provisions increased by £0.4 billion, primarily in collectively assessed portfolios, mainly driven by deteriorating credit metrics within the Ulster Bank mortgage portfolio where elevated levels of impairment continue to outpace write-offs.
 
 
 
179

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Impairment charge
The table below analyses the impairment charge for loans and securities.

 
Half year ended
 
30 June 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Individually assessed
596 
1,094 
1,690 
 
745 
2,374 
3,119 
Collectively assessed
973 
156 
1,129 
 
1,049 
262 
1,311 
Latent loss
(78)
(35)
(113)
 
(132)
(163)
(295)
               
Loans to customers
1,491 
1,215 
2,706 
 
1,662 
2,473 
4,135 
Loans to banks
24 
24 
 
Securities
             
  - sovereign debt (1)
 
842 
842 
  - other
38 
(119)
(81)
 
63 
13 
76 
               
Charge to income statement
1,553 
1,096 
2,649 
 
2,567 
2,486 
5,053 
               
Charge as a % of gross loans (2)
0.7% 
3.6% 
1.1% 
 
0.8% 
5.2% 
1.6% 

Notes:
(1)
Includes related interest rate hedge instruments.
(2)
Customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of gross loans and advances to customers including assets of disposal groups and excluding reverse purchase agreements.

Key points
·
The impairment charge of £2.6 billion in H1 2012 was £2.4 billion or 48% lower than H1 2011. This reflected lower loan impairments, primarily in Non-Core, and to a lesser extent, in Retail & Commercial, as well as lower securities impairments.
   
·
The total loan impairment charge was 34% lower year-on-year. Retail & Commercial loan impairment losses decreased due to an overall improvement in asset quality and risk appetite tightening in UK Retail and an improved credit environment in US Retail & Commercial.
   
·
The Group recognised an impairment charge of £0.8 billion in H1 2011 in relation to its Greek bond portfolio in Group Treasury. In H1 2012 there were write-backs relating to asset-backed securities in Non-Core.
   
·
Ulster Bank Core and Non-Core impairments were £1.2 billion compared with £2.5 billion in H1 2011, with Non-Core decreasing by £1.4 billion primarily in relation to individually assessed commercial real estate portfolio assets.
 
 
 
180

 

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Wholesale loan restructuring
As part of the Group's problem debt management process, a number of restructuring options are available when corrective action is deemed necessary. The vast majority of wholesale loan restructurings take place within the Global Restructuring Group (GRG). However, within its early problem management framework, the Group may agree various remedial measures with customers whose loans are performing but who are experiencing temporary financial difficulties. Refer to pages 95 and 96 of the Group's 2011 Annual Report for more details on wholesale loan restructuring.

The total amount of wholesale loan restructurings that achieved legal completion in the first half of 2012 and that individually exceed respective thresholds set at divisional level (which range from nil to £10 million) was £4.3 billion. In addition, a further £12.5 billion was in the process of being completed at 30 June 2012. Restructured loans, related internal asset quality bands, sector breakdown and types of restructuring are set out below.
Sector
AQ1-AQ9 (1)
£m 
 
AQ10 (2)
£m 
AQ10 (2)
provision 
coverage 
         
Half year ended 30 June 2012
       
Property
1,343 
 
1,108 
25 
Transport
666 
 
48 
62 
Telecoms, media and technology
291 
 
16 
15 
Retail and leisure
473 
 
14 
52 
Other
165 
 
131 
12 
         
 
2,938 
 
1,317 
25 
         
Year ended 31 December 2011
       
         
Property
1,980 
 
2,600 
18 
Transport
686 
 
694 
11 
Telecoms, media and technology
167 
 
12 
25 
Retail and leisure
503 
 
148 
24 
Other
1,139 
 
659 
52 
         
 
4,475 
 
4,113 
22 

Notes:
(1)
Probability of default is less than 100%.
(2)
Probability of default is 100%.

The table below analyses the incidence of the main types of restructuring by loan value.

Arrangement type
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
     
Variation in margin
12 
Payment holidays and loan rescheduling
89 
87 
Forgiveness of all or part of the outstanding debt
11 
31 
Other
11 

Note:
(1)
The total above exceeds 100% as an individual case can involve more than one type of arrangement.
 
 
 
181

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Wholesale loan restructuring (continued)

Key points
·
The value of wholesale loans restructured during the first half of 2012 was, on a pro-rata basis, in line with that restructured during 2011. Around 80% of restructuring activity (by loan value) was undertaken by the GRG, whilst the remaining 20% was undertaken within the divisions.
·
As anticipated, restructuring was more prevalent in the Group’s most material corporate sectors and in those sectors experiencing difficult market conditions, notably property, transport, retail and leisure. The flow of restructured property loans remained in line with 2011 on a pro-rata basis, although the proportion of restructurings taking place in the non-defaulted portfolio increased. Most of the property loans restructured during the first half were in Non-Core.
·
Provision coverage of restructured defaulted assets remained in line with that applied during 2011. Coverage of restructured property loans reflects that applied in the wider portfolio, with a higher coverage level observed for Ulster property cases than for non-Ulster cases.
·
Forgiveness of all or part of the outstanding debt is granted as a last resort and comprises only a small number of cases. It is therefore subject to large fluctuations from period to period. Payment holidays and loan reschedulings tend to be granted on a more linear basis and remained stable over the period.

Retail forbearance
Retail mortgage accounts in forbearance arrangements at 30 June 2012 totalled £7.1 billion. The mortgage arrears information for retail accounts in forbearance, related provision and type of arrangements are shown in the tables below. Refer to pages 97 to 99 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report for details on methodologies.

 
No missed
payments
 
1-3 months
in arrears
 
>3 months
in arrears
 
Total
 
Forborne 
balances 
as a % of 
total 
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
                           
30 June 2012
                         
UK Retail (1,2)
3,847 
19 
 
360 
15 
 
413 
61 
 
4,620 
95 
 
4.7 
Ulster Bank (1,2)
927 
104 
 
608 
69 
 
396 
145 
 
1,931 
318 
 
10.1 
RBS Citizens (3)
 
223 
24 
 
127 
13 
 
350 
37 
 
1.5 
Wealth
61 
 
 
91 
 
152 
 
1.7 
                           
 
4,835 
123 
 
1,191 
108 
 
1,027 
225 
 
7,053 
456 
 
4.7 
                           
31 December 2011
                         
                           
UK Retail (1,2)
3,677 
16 
 
351 
13 
 
407 
59 
 
4,435 
88 
 
4.7 
Ulster Bank (1,2)
893 
78 
 
516 
45 
 
421 
124 
 
1,830 
247 
 
9.1 
RBS Citizens (3)
 
91 
10 
 
89 
10 
 
180 
20 
 
0.8 
Wealth
121 
 
 
 
123 
 
1.3 
                           
 
4,691 
94 
 
958 
68 
 
919 
193 
 
6,568 
355 
 
4.4 

Notes:
(1)
Includes all forbearance arrangements whether relating to the customer’s lifestyle changes or financial difficulty.
(2)
Comprises the current stock position of forbearance deals agreed since early 2008 for UK Retail and early 2009 for Ulster Bank.
(3)
Forbearance stock reported at 30 June 2012 now includes home equity loans and lines as well as the residential mortgage portfolio.
 
 
 
182

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Retail forbearance (continued)

Key points

UK Retail
·
At 30 June 2012, £4.6 billion of mortgage loans representing 4.7% of the total mortgage assets were subject to some form of forbearance; this represents a 4% increase in forbearance stock since 31 December 2011. Of these, approximately 83% were up-to-date with payments (compared with approximately 97% of the mortgage population not subject to forbearance activity).
   
·
The most frequently occurring forbearance types were term extensions (41% of assets subject to forbearance at 30 June 2012), interest only conversions (26%) and capitalisations of arrears (19%). The stock of cases subject to interest only conversions reflects legacy policy; UK Retail no longer permits this type of forbearance treatment for customers in financial difficulty.
   
·
The provision cover on performing assets subject to forbearance is more than five times that on assets not subject to forbearance.
   
·
For unsecured portfolios in UK Retail, 1% of the population was subject to forbearance at 30 June 2012.

Ulster Bank
·
Ulster Bank Group is assisting customers in this difficult environment. Mortgage forbearance treatments have been in place since 2009 and are aimed at assisting customers in financial difficulty. At 30 June 2012, 10% of total mortgage assets (£1.9 billion) were subject to a forbearance arrangement, an increase from 9% (£1.8 billion) at 31 December 2011. The majority of these forbearance arrangements are in the performing book (79%) and not 90 days past due.
   
·
The provision cover on performing assets subject to forbearance is approximately ten times higher than that on performing assets not subject to forbearance.
   
·
The majority of the forbearance treatments offered by Ulster Bank are temporary concessions, accounting for 87% of assets subject to forbearance at 30 June 2012. These are offered for periods of one to three years and incorporate different levels of repayment based on the customer’s ability to pay.
   
·
Of these temporary forbearance types, the largest category at 30 June 2012 was interest only conversions, which accounted for 44% of total assets subject to forbearance. The other categories of temporary forbearance were payment concessions (positive and negative amortisation agreements, accounting for 20% and 15% of the total, respectively) and payment holidays (accounting for 8%).
   
·
For unsecured portfolios in Ulster Bank, 1.68% (by value) of the population was subject to forbearance at 30 June 2012.
 
 
183

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Problem debt management (continued)

Retail forbearance (continued)

 
UK Retail 
Ulster Bank 
RBS 
Citizens 
Wealth 
Total (1)
Forbearance arrangements
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
30 June 2012
         
Interest only conversions (temporary and permanent)
1,261 
846 
2,115 
Term extensions - capital repayment and interest only
2,007 
147 
85 
2,239 
Payment concessions/holidays
172 
832 
350 
22 
1,376 
Capitalisation of arrears
917 
106 
1,023 
Other
488 
37 
525 
           
 
4,845 
1,931 
350 
152 
7,278 
           
31 December 2011
         
           
Interest only conversions (temporary and permanent)
1,269 
795 
2,067 
Term extensions - capital repayment and interest only
1,805 
58 
97 
1,960 
Payment concessions/holidays
198 
876 
180 
1,254 
Capitalisation of arrears
864 
101 
965 
Other
517 
23 
540 
           
 
4,653 
1,830 
180 
123 
6,786 

Note:
(1)
As an individual case can include more than one type of arrangement, the analysis in the table on forbearance arrangements exceeds the total value of cases subject to forbearance.
 
 
 
184

 

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Commercial real estate
The commercial real estate lending portfolio totalled £69.3 billion at 30 June 2012, a £5.6 billion or 7% decrease from £74.8 billion at 31 December 2011. The commercial real estate sector comprises exposures to entities involved in the development of, or investment in, commercial and residential properties (including housebuilders). The analysis of lending utilisations below excludes rate risk management and contingent obligations.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Investment 
Development 
Total 
 
Investment 
Development 
Total 
By division (1)
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Core
             
UK Corporate
23,917 
4,450 
28,367 
 
25,101 
5,023 
30,124 
Ulster Bank
3,715 
762 
4,477 
 
3,882 
881 
4,763 
US Retail & Commercial
4,129 
68 
4,197 
 
4,235 
70 
4,305 
International Banking
1,014 
295 
1,309 
 
872 
299 
1,171 
Markets
441 
80 
521 
 
141 
61 
202 
               
 
33,216 
5,655 
38,871 
 
34,231 
6,334 
40,565 
               
Non-Core
             
UK Corporate
3,190 
1,274 
4,464 
 
3,957 
2,020 
5,977 
Ulster Bank
3,698 
7,683 
11,381 
 
3,860 
8,490 
12,350 
US Retail & Commercial
652 
16 
668 
 
901 
28 
929 
International Banking
13,633 
238 
13,871 
 
14,689 
336 
15,025 
               
 
21,173 
9,211 
30,384 
 
23,407 
10,874 
34,281 
               
Core and Non-Core
54,389 
14,866 
69,255 
 
57,638 
17,208 
74,846 


 
Investment
 
Development
 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
Total 
By geography (1)
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
30 June 2012
           
UK (excluding NI) (2)
27,566 
5,957 
 
959 
5,329 
39,811 
Ireland (ROI and NI) (2)
4,964 
1,077 
 
2,315 
5,719 
14,075 
Western Europe
7,569 
402 
 
19 
56 
8,046 
US
5,207 
986 
 
55 
29 
6,277 
RoW
648 
13 
 
129 
256 
1,046 
             
 
45,954 
8,435 
 
3,477 
11,389 
69,255 
             
31 December 2011
           
             
UK (excluding NI) (2)
28,653 
6,359 
 
1,198 
6,511 
42,721 
Ireland (ROI and NI) (2)
5,146 
1,132 
 
2,591 
6,317 
15,186 
Western Europe
7,649 
1,048 
 
52 
8,758 
US
5,552 
1,279 
 
59 
46 
6,936 
RoW
785 
35 
 
141 
284 
1,245 
             
 
47,785 
9,853 
 
3,998 
13,210 
74,846 

For the notes to these tables refer to the following page.
 
 
185

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Commercial real estate (continued)

 
Investment
 
Development
 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
By geography (1)
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
30 June 2012
           
UK (excluding NI) (2)
24,664 
8,859 
 
4,531 
1,757 
39,811 
Ireland (ROI and NI) (2)
3,031 
3,010 
 
688 
7,346 
14,075 
Western Europe
546 
7,425 
 
45 
30 
8,046 
US
4,724 
1,469 
 
68 
16 
6,277 
RoW
251 
410 
 
323 
62 
1,046 
             
 
33,216 
21,173 
 
5,655 
9,211 
69,255 
             
31 December 2011
           
             
UK (excluding NI) (2)
25,904 
9,108 
 
5,118 
2,591 
42,721 
Ireland (ROI and NI) (2)
3,157 
3,121 
 
793 
8,115 
15,186 
Western Europe
422 
8,275 
 
20 
41 
8,758 
US
4,521 
2,310 
 
71 
34 
6,936 
RoW
227 
593 
 
332 
93 
1,245 
             
 
34,231 
23,407 
 
6,334 
10,874 
74,846 

By sub-sector (1)
UK 
(excl NI) (2)
£m 
Ireland 
(ROI and 
 NI) (2)
£m 
Western 
Europe 
£m 
US 
£m 
RoW 
£m 
Total 
£m 
             
30 June 2012
           
Residential
11,286 
6,796 
458 
1,015 
269 
19,824 
Office
6,747 
1,279 
1,997 
248 
283 
10,554 
Retail
8,197 
1,567 
1,761 
150 
202 
11,877 
Industrial
3,927 
478 
374 
36 
101 
4,916 
Mixed/other
9,654 
3,955 
3,456 
4,828 
191 
22,084 
             
 
39,811 
14,075 
8,046 
6,277 
1,046 
69,255 
             
31 December 2011
 
             
Residential
12,870 
7,449 
1,100 
1,325 
319 
23,063 
Office
7,155 
1,354 
2,246 
404 
352 
11,511 
Retail
8,709 
1,641 
1,891 
285 
275 
12,801 
Industrial
4,317 
507 
520 
24 
105 
5,473 
Mixed/other
9,670 
4,235 
3,001 
4,898 
194 
21,998 
             
 
42,721 
15,186 
8,758 
6,936 
1,245 
74,846 

Notes:
(1)
Excludes commercial real estate lending in Wealth as these loans are generally supported by personal guarantees in addition to collateral. This portfolio, which totalled £1.4 billion at 30 June 2012 (31 December 2011 - £1.3 billion), continues to perform in line with expectations and requires minimal provisions.
(2)
ROI: Republic of Ireland; NI: Northern Ireland.
 
 
 
186

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Commercial real estate (continued)

Key points
·
In line with the Group’s strategy, the overall exposure to commercial real estate fell during the first half of 2012, mainly in the UK, Western Europe and Ireland. The overall mix in terms of geography, sub-sector and investment versus development remained broadly unchanged.
   
·
Most of the decrease was in Non-Core due to repayments and asset sales. The Non-Core portfolio totalled £30.4 billion (44% of the portfolio) at 30 June 2012 (31 December 2011 - £34.3 billion or 46% of the portfolio).
   
·
The growth in Markets was caused by an increase in the inventory of US commercial real estate loans earmarked for distribution in the commercial mortgage-backed securities warehouse. This activity is tightly controlled, including maximum portfolio size and holding period, and marked-to-market on a daily basis.
   
·
With the exception of exposure in Spain and Ireland, the Group had minimal commercial real estate exposure in eurozone periphery countries. Exposure in Spain was predominantly in the Non-Core portfolio and totalled £2.1 billion, of which 46% was performing. The remainder of the Spanish portfolio has already been subject to material provisions, which are regularly assessed by reference to re-appraised asset values. Asset values vary significantly by type and geographic location.
   
·
Short-term lending to property developers without sufficient pre-let revenue at origination to support investment financing after practical completion is classified as speculative. Speculative lending at origination represented less than 1% of the portfolio at 30 June 2012.
   
·
The commercial real estate sector is expected to remain challenging in key markets and new business will be accommodated from run-off of existing Core exposure.

 
 
187

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Commercial real estate (continued)

Maturity profile of portfolio
UK Corporate 
Ulster Bank 
US Retail & 
 Commercial 
International 
Banking 
Markets 
Total 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
30 June 2012
           
Core
           
< 1 year (1)
9,598 
2,465 
978 
199 
76 
13,316 
1-2 years 
3,911 
795 
575 
116 
5,404 
2-3 years
3,926 
165 
837 
551 
152 
5,631 
> 3 years
10,347 
1,052 
1,807 
443 
286 
13,935 
Not classified (2)
585 
585 
             
Total
28,367 
4,477 
4,197 
1,309 
521 
38,871 
             
Non-Core
           
< 1 year (1)
2,308 
9,796 
217 
5,208 
17,529 
1-2 years
377 
1,165 
133 
3,828 
5,503 
2-3 years
207 
115 
80 
2,113 
2,515 
> 3 years
1,315 
305 
238 
2,722 
4,580 
Not classified (2)
257 
257 
             
Total
4,464 
11,381 
668 
13,871 
30,384 

31 December 2011
           
             
Core
           
< 1 year (1)
8,268 
3,030 
1,056 
142 
12,496 
1-2 years
5,187 
391 
638 
218 
60 
6,494 
2-3 years
3,587 
117 
765 
230 
133 
4,832 
> 3 years
10,871 
1,225 
1,846 
581 
14,532 
Not classified (2)
2,211 
2,211 
             
Total
30,124 
4,763 
4,305 
1,171 
202 
40,565 
             
Non-Core
           
< 1 year (1)
3,224 
11,089 
293 
7,093 
21,699 
1-2 years
508 
692 
163 
3,064 
4,427 
2-3 years
312 
177 
152 
1,738 
2,379 
> 3 years
1,636 
392 
321 
3,126 
5,475 
Not classified (2)
297 
301 
             
Total
5,977 
12,350 
929 
15,025 
34,281 

Notes:
(1)
Includes on demand and past due assets.
(2)
Predominantly comprises overdrafts and multi-option facilities for which there is no single maturity date.

Key point
·
The majority of Ulster Bank Group’s commercial real estate portfolio was categorised as < 1 year, owing to the high level of non-performing assets in the portfolio. Ulster Bank places most restructured facilities on demand rather than extend the maturity date.
 
 
 
188

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Commercial real estate (continued)

Portfolio by AQ band
AQ1-AQ2 
£m 
AQ3-AQ4 
£m 
AQ5-AQ6 
£m 
AQ7-AQ8 
£m 
AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
£m 
Total 
£m 
               
30 June 2012
             
Core
924 
6,585 
17,716 
6,828 
2,399 
4,419 
38,871 
Non-Core
168 
1,248 
4,514 
3,377 
1,806 
19,271 
30,384 
               
 
1,092 
7,833 
22,230 
10,205 
4,205 
23,690 
69,255 
               
31 December 2011
             
               
Core
1,094 
6,714 
19,054 
6,254 
3,111 
4,338 
40,565 
Non-Core
680 
1,287 
5,951 
3,893 
2,385 
20,085 
34,281 
               
 
1,774 
8,001 
25,005 
10,147 
5,496 
24,423 
74,846 

Key points
·
The AQ distribution remained relatively unchanged in both Core and Non-Core during the first half of 2012. The high proportion of the portfolio in the AQ10 band was driven by exposures in Non-Core (Ulster Bank Group and International Banking) and Core (Ulster Bank).
   
·
Of the total portfolio of £69.3 billion at 30 June 2012, £31.4 billion (31 December 2011 - £34.7 billion) was managed within the Group’s standard credit processes and £5.2 billion (31 December 2011 - £5.9 billion) was receiving varying degrees of heightened credit management under the Group’s Watchlist process. A further £32.7 billion (31 December 2011 - £34.3 billion) was managed within the GRG and included watchlisted and non-performing exposures. The decrease in the portfolio managed by the GRG was driven by Non-Core reductions.
 
 
 
189

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Commercial real estate (continued)
The table below analyses commercial real estate lending by loan-to-value (LTV). Due to market conditions in Ireland and to a lesser extent in the UK, there is a shortage of market-based data. In the absence of external valuations, the Group deploys a range of alternative approaches to assess property values, including internal expert judgement and indexation.

 
Ulster Bank
 
Rest of the Group
 
Group
Loan-to-value
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
 £m 
 
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
£m 
 
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
 £m 
                 
30 June 2012
               
<= 50%
89 
37 
 
7,103 
321 
 
7,192 
358 
> 50% and <= 70%
535 
122 
 
13,490 
1,077 
 
14,025 
1,199 
> 70% and <= 90%
624 
208 
 
8,780 
1,179 
 
9,404 
1,387 
> 90% and <= 100%
509 
176 
 
2,320 
1,695 
 
2,829 
1,871 
> 100% and <= 110%
704 
523 
 
1,106 
1,946 
 
1,810 
2,469 
> 110% and <= 130%
767 
928 
 
670 
1,081 
 
1,437 
2,009 
> 130%
846 
9,601 
 
482 
3,271 
 
1,328 
12,872 
                 
Total with LTVs
4,074 
11,595 
 
33,951 
10,570 
 
38,025 
22,165 
Other (1)
188 
 
7,539 
1,337 
 
7,540 
1,525 
                 
Total
4,075 
11,783 
 
41,490 
11,907 
 
45,565 
23,690 
                 
Total portfolio average LTV (2)
138% 
262% 
 
67% 
189% 
 
75% 
227% 
                 
31 December 2011
               
                 
<= 50%
81 
28 
 
7,091 
332 
 
7,172 
360 
> 50% and <= 70%
642 
121 
 
14,105 
984 
 
14,747 
1,105 
> 70% and <= 90%
788 
293 
 
10,042 
1,191 
 
10,830 
1,484 
> 90% and <= 100%
541 
483 
 
2,616 
1,679 
 
3,157 
2,162 
> 100% and <= 110%
261 
322 
 
1,524 
1,928 
 
1,785 
2,250 
> 110% and <= 130%
893 
1,143 
 
698 
1,039 
 
1,591 
2,182 
> 130%
1,468 
10,004 
 
672 
2,994 
 
2,140 
12,998 
                 
Total with LTVs
4,674 
12,394 
 
36,748 
10,147 
 
41,422 
22,541 
Other (1)
38 
 
8,994 
1,844 
 
9,001 
1,882 
                 
Total
4,681 
12,432 
 
45,742 
11,991 
 
50,423 
24,423 
                 
Total portfolio average LTV (2)
140% 
259% 
 
69% 
129% 
 
77% 
201% 

Notes:
(1)
Other performing loans of £7.5 billion (31 December 2011 - £9.0 billion) include unsecured lending to commercial real estate clients, such as major UK housebuilders. The credit quality of these exposures was consistent with that of the performing portfolio overall. Other non-performing loans of £1.5 billion (31 December 2011 - £1.9 billion) are subject to the Group’s standard provisioning policies.
(2)
Weighted average by exposure.
 
 
 
190

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Commercial real estate (continued)

Key points
·
86% of the commercial real estate portfolio categorised as LTV > 100% was within Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) and International Banking (Non-Core). A majority of the portfolios are managed within the GRG and are subject to reviews at least quarterly and significant levels of provisions have been taken against these portfolios. Provisions as a percentage of REIL for the Ulster Bank Group commercial real estate portfolio was 56% at 30 June 2012 (31 December 2011 - 53%). The reported LTV levels are based on loan value (before provisions). The growth in the average LTV in the AQ10 category for the rest of the Group was mainly attributable to a corporate client which has been substantially provided for.
   
·
The average interest coverage ratios for UK Corporate (Core and Non-Core) and International Banking (Non-Core) were 2.69x and 1.29x, respectively, at 30 June 2012 (31 December 2011 - 2.71x and 1.25x, respectively). The US Retail & Commercial portfolio is managed on the basis of debt service coverage, which includes scheduled principal amortisation. The average debt service coverage for this portfolio was 1.28x at 30 June 2012 (31 December 2011 - 1.24x). As a number of different approaches are used within the Group and across geographies to calculate interest coverage ratios, they may not be comparable for different portfolio types and organisations.


Residential mortgages
The majority of the Group’s residential mortgage portfolio exposures are in the UK, Ireland and the US. The analysis below includes both Core and Non-Core balances.
 
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
     
UK Retail
98,044 
96,388 
Ulster Bank
19,172 
20,020 
RBS Citizens (1)
22,994 
24,153 
     
 
140,210 
140,561 

Note:
(1)
Restated.
 
 
 
191

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Residential mortgages (continued)
The table below details the distribution of residential mortgages by indexed LTV. LTV averages are calculated by transaction value.

 
UK Retail
 
Ulster Bank
 
RBS Citizens (3)
Loan-to-value (LTV)
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
 £m 
 
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
£m 
 
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
 £m 
                 
30 June 2012
               
<= 50%
21,571 
297 
 
2,210 
218 
 
4,212 
37 
> 50% and <= 70%
25,924 
406 
 
1,628 
151 
 
4,424 
53 
> 70% and <= 90%
34,087 
721 
 
1,968 
222 
 
6,656 
93 
> 90% and <= 100%
7,574 
354 
 
1,169 
119 
 
2,345 
53 
> 100% and <= 110%
3,869 
292 
 
1,291 
130 
 
1,593 
51 
> 110% and <= 130%
2,105 
244 
 
2,396 
308 
 
1,679 
52 
> 130%
105 
29 
 
5,939 
1,423 
 
1,249 
50 
                 
Total with LTVs
95,235 
2,343 
 
16,601 
2,571 
 
22,158 
389 
Other (1)
455 
11 
 
 
378 
69 
                 
Total
95,690 
2,354 
 
16,601 
2,571 
 
22,536 
458 
                 
Total portfolio average LTV (2)
67% 
81% 
 
110% 
135% 
 
78% 
94% 
                 
31 December 2011
               
                 
<= 50%
21,537 
285 
 
2,568 
222 
 
4,745 
49 
> 50% and <= 70%
25,598 
390 
 
1,877 
157 
 
4,713 
78 
> 70% and <= 90%
33,738 
671 
 
2,280 
223 
 
6,893 
125 
> 90% and <= 100%
7,365 
343 
 
1,377 
128 
 
2,352 
66 
> 100% and <= 110%
3,817 
276 
 
1,462 
130 
 
1,517 
53 
> 110% and <= 130%
1,514 
199 
 
2,752 
322 
 
1,536 
53 
> 130%
60 
15 
 
5,405 
1,117 
 
1,214 
55 
                 
Total with LTVs
93,629 
2,179 
 
17,721 
2,299 
 
22,970 
479 
Other (1)
567 
13 
 
 
681 
23 
                 
Total
94,196 
2,192 
 
17,721 
2,299 
 
23,651 
502 
                 
Total portfolio average LTV (2)
67% 
80% 
 
104% 
125% 
 
76% 
91% 

Notes:
(1)
Where no indexed LTV is held.
(2)
Calculated by value of debt outstanding.
(3)
Includes residential mortgages and home equity loans and lines (refer to page 194 for breakdown of balances).

 
 
192

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Residential mortgages (continued)

Key points

UK Retail
·
The UK Retail mortgage portfolio totalled approximately £98 billion at 30 June 2012, an increase of 1.7% from 31 December 2011.
   
·
The assets were prime mortgages and included £7.4 billion (7.6%) of exposure to residential buy-to-let. There was a small legacy portfolio of self-certified mortgages (0.3% of the total mortgage portfolio). Self-certified mortgages were withdrawn in 2004.
   
·
Gross new mortgage lending remained strong at £7.1 billion. Newly originated mortgages had an average LTV by transaction value of 65.4% during the first half of 2012 compared with 63.0% during 2011. The maximum LTV available to new customers was 90% except for those buying properties under the rules of the government-sponsored NewBuy Indemnity scheme. The scheme, which was introduced in March 2012, permits customers to borrow up to 95% of the value of new properties.
   
·
Based on the Halifax Price Index at March 2012, the portfolio average indexed LTV by weighted value increased marginally from 67.2% at 31 December 2011 to 67.7% at 30 June 2012.
   
·
The arrears rate (more than three payments in arrears, excluding repossessions and shortfalls post property sale) improved marginally from 1.6% to 1.5%. The number of properties repossessed in H1 2012 was broadly in line with the number repossessed in H2 2011, averaging 150 per month. Arrears rates remain sensitive to economic developments and are currently favoured by the low interest rate environment.
   
·
The mortgage impairment charge was £58 million for H1 2012, which compares favourably with £116 million for H1 2011 and £66 million for H2 2011.

Ulster Bank
·
Ulster Bank’s residential mortgage portfolio totalled £19.2 billion at 30 June 2012, with 88% in the Republic of Ireland and 12% in Northern Ireland. At constant exchange rates, the portfolio decreased 1.1% from 31 December 2011 as a result of natural amortisation and limited growth due to low market demand.
   
·
Average LTVs increased from 31 December 2011 to 30 June 2012, on a value basis, as a result of decreases in the house price index, notably in the first quarter of the year.
   
·
Refer to the Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) section for commentary on mortgage REIL and repossessions.
 
 
 
193

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios: Residential mortgages (continued)

Key points (continued)

RBS Citizens
·
At 30 June 2012, RBS Citizens’ residential real estate portfolio totalled £23.0 billion (31 December 2011 - £24.2 billion). The real estate portfolio included £6.5 billion of residential mortgages; for 99% of these, the Group held a first-lien mortgage (Core - £6.0 billion; Non-Core - £0.5 billion). The remainder comprised £16.5 billion of home equity loans and lines (Core - £14.2 billion; Non-Core - £2.3 billion).
   
·
RBS Citizens continues to focus on the ‘footprint states’ of New England, the Mid Atlantic and the Mid West, targeting low risk products and maintaining conservative risk policies. Loan acceptance criteria were tightened during 2009 to address deteriorating economic and market conditions. At 30 June 2012, £19.2 billion of loans (83% of the total portfolio) were to customers within these footprint states.
   
·
At 30 June 2012, around 12% of the residential real estate portfolio was in Non-Core. Of this, the largest proportion (75%) was the ‘serviced by others’ (SBO) home equity portfolio. The SBO portfolio consists of purchased pools of home equity loans and lines of credit. The annualised charge-off rate for these loans was 7.1% during the first half of 2012 (down from 8.7% during 2011), due to lending in out-of-footprint geographies, a high proportion (95%) of second-lien mortgages and high LTVs (average LTV of 116% at 30 June 2012). The SBO book has been closed to new purchases since 2007 and is in run-off, with exposure down from £2.3 billion at 31 December 2011 to £2.1 billion at 30 June 2012. The arrears rate of the SBO portfolio decreased from 2.3% at 31 December 2011 to 2.0% at 30 June 2012, as the Group charged off the worst loans and implemented more effective account servicing and collections practices following a change of servicer in 2009.
   
·
The weighted average LTV of the real estate portfolio increased slightly from 77% at 31 December 2011 to 78% at 30 June 2012, driven by slight declines in the Case-Shiller home price index. Excluding SBO, the weighted average LTV was 74.5%.
   
·
Impairments on the residential real estate portfolio continued to decline and were £115 million for H1 2012 compared with £165 million for H1 2011 and £158 million for H2 2011.
 
 
 
194

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios (continued)

Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core)

Overview
At 30 June 2012, Ulster Bank Group accounted for 10% of the Group’s total gross customer loans and 9% of the Group’s Core gross customer loans. The impairment charge for H1 2012 was £1,166 million, mainly driven by the residential mortgage and commercial real estate portfolios as high unemployment, austerity measures and economic uncertainty have reduced incomes and, together with limited liquidity, depressed the property market. For 2011, the H1 impairment charge was £2,540 million and the full year charge was £3,717 million.

Core
The impairment charge for H1 2012 was £717 million, with the mortgage sector accounting for £356 million (50%). For H1 2011, the charge was £730 million, with the mortgage sector accounting for £311 million (43%). For the whole of 2011, the charge was £1,384 million, with the mortgage sector accounting for £570 million (41%).

Non-Core
The impairment charge for H1 2012 was £449 million. The commercial real estate sector accounted for £398 million (89%); of this, development land accounted for £262 million (58%).

For H1 2011, the corresponding charge was £1,810 million, with the commercial real sector accounting for £1,697 million (94%), of which development land accounted for £1,313 million (73% of the total Non-Core charge). For the whole of 2011, the charge was £2,333 million, with the commercial real estate sector accounting for £2,160 million (93%), of which development land accounted for £1,551 million (66% of the total Non-Core charge).
 
 
 
195

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios

Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

 
Gross 
loans 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL 
as a % of 
gross loans 
Provisions 
as a % of 
REIL 
Provisions 
as a % of 
gross loans 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
Sector analysis
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
30 June 2012
               
Core
               
Mortgages
19,172 
2,561 
1,242 
13.4 
48 
6.5 
356 
11 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,715 
1,117 
481 
30.1 
43 
12.9 
91 
  - development
762 
335 
164 
44.0 
49 
21.5 
24 
Other corporate
7,908 
2,010 
1,226 
25.4 
61 
15.5 
217 
Other lending
1,451 
211 
194 
14.5 
92 
13.4 
29 
15 
                 
 
33,008 
6,234 
3,307 
18.9 
53 
10.0 
717 
28 
                 
Non-Core
               
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,698 
2,929 
1,430 
79.2 
49 
38.7 
136 
  - development 
7,683 
7,212 
4,374 
93.9 
61 
56.9 
262 
37 
Other corporate
1,619 
1,136 
656 
70.2 
58 
40.5 
51 
                 
 
13,000 
11,277 
6,460 
86.7 
57 
49.7 
449 
47 
                 
Ulster Bank Group
               
Mortgages
19,172 
2,561 
1,242 
13.4 
48 
6.5 
356 
11 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
7,413 
4,046 
1,911 
54.6 
47 
25.8 
227 
  - development
8,445 
7,547 
4,538 
89.4 
60 
53.7 
286 
37 
Other corporate
9,527 
3,146 
1,882 
33.0 
60 
19.8 
268 
Other lending
1,451 
211 
194 
14.5 
92 
13.4 
29 
15 
                 
 
46,008 
17,511 
9,767 
38.1 
56 
21.2 
1,166 
75 
                 
 
 
 
196

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios

Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

 
Gross 
loans 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL 
as a % of 
gross loans 
Provisions 
as a % of 
REIL 
Provisions 
as a % of 
gross loans 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
Sector analysis
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
31 December 2011
               
Core
               
Mortgages
20,020 
2,184 
945 
10.9 
43 
4.7 
570 
11 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,882 
1,014 
413 
26.1 
41 
10.6 
225 
  - development
881 
290 
145 
32.9 
50 
16.5 
99 
16 
Other corporate
7,736 
1,834 
1,062 
23.7 
58 
13.7 
434 
72 
Other lending
1,533 
201 
184 
13.1 
92 
12.0 
56 
25 
                 
 
34,052 
5,523 
2,749 
16.2 
50 
8.1 
1,384 
124 
                 
Non-Core
               
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,860 
2,916 
1,364 
75.5 
47 
35.3 
609 
  - development
8,490 
7,536 
4,295 
88.8 
57 
50.6 
1,551 
32 
Other corporate
1,630 
1,159 
642 
71.1 
55 
39.4 
173 
16 
                 
 
13,980 
11,611 
6,301 
83.1 
54 
45.1 
2,333 
49 
                 
Ulster Bank Group
               
Mortgages
20,020 
2,184 
945 
10.9 
43 
4.7 
570 
11 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
7,742 
3,930 
1,777 
50.8 
45 
23.0 
834 
  - development
9,371 
7,826 
4,440 
83.5 
57 
47.4 
1,650 
48 
Other corporate
9,366 
2,993 
1,704 
32.0 
57 
18.2 
607 
88 
Other lending
1,533 
201 
184 
13.1 
92 
12.0 
56 
25 
                 
 
48,032 
17,134 
9,050 
35.7 
53 
18.8 
3,717 
173 

Key points
·
Core REIL increased by £711 million or 13% compared with 31 December 2011 to £6,234 million at 30 June 2012.
   
·
Mortgages accounted for £377 million (53%) of the increase in Core REIL, driven by a continued challenging economic environment. Mortgage REIL as a percentage of gross mortgages was 13.4% (by value) at 30 June 2012 compared with 10.9% at 31 December 2011. The number of properties repossessed in H1 2012 was broadly in line with the number of repossessed in H2 2011, averaging 15 per month.
   
·
Non-Core REIL decreased by £334 million or 3% compared with 31 December 2011 to £11,277 million at 30 June 2012, as a result of lower defaults and increased restructuring in the commercial real estate portfolio.
   
·
At 30 June 2012, 64% of REIL was in Non-Core, of which the commercial real estate development portfolio accounted for 64%.
 
 
 
197

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Credit risk: Key credit portfolios

Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Commercial real estate
The commercial real estate lending portfolio for Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) totalled £15.9 billion at 30 June 2012, of which £11.4 billion or 72% was in Non-Core. The geographic split of the total Ulster Bank Group commercial real estate portfolio remained similar to 31 December 2011, with 27% in Northern Ireland, 62% in the Republic of Ireland and 11% in the UK (excluding Northern Ireland).

 
Investment
 
Development
   
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Total 
Exposure by geography
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
               
30 June 2012
             
Ireland (ROI and NI)
4,939 
1,077 
 
2,315 
5,719 
 
14,050 
UK (excluding NI)
1,287 
96 
 
91 
304 
 
1,778 
RoW
14 
 
11 
 
30 
               
 
6,240 
1,173 
 
2,411 
6,034 
 
15,858 
               
31 December 2011
             
               
Ireland (ROI and NI)
5,097 
1,132 
 
2,591 
6,317 
 
15,137 
UK (excluding NI)
1,371 
111 
 
95 
336 
 
1,913 
RoW
27 
 
32 
 
63 
               
 
6,495 
1,247 
 
2,686 
6,685 
 
17,113 

Key points
·
Commercial real estate remains the primary sector contributing to the Ulster Bank Group defaulted loan book. The outlook for the property sector remains challenging, with limited liquidity in the marketplace to support sales or refinancing. Asset values are regularly re-assessed because of depressed market conditions.
   
·
Within its early problem management framework, Ulster Bank may agree various measures with customers whose loans are performing but who are experiencing temporary financial difficulties. During H1 2012, commercial real estate loans amounting to £0.1 billion (each having exposures greater than £10 million) benefited from such measures.
   
·
During H1 2012, impaired commercial real estate loans amounting to £0.7 billion (for exposures greater than £10 million) were restructured and remain in the non-performing book.
 
 
 
198

 


Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Market risk
Market risk arises from changes in interest rates, foreign currency, credit spreads, equity prices and risk related factors such as market volatilities. The Group manages market risk centrally within its trading and non-trading portfolios through a comprehensive market risk management framework. This control framework includes qualitative and quantitative guidance in the form of comprehensive policy statements, dealing authorities, limits based on, but not limited to, value-at-risk (VaR), stress testing, positions and sensitivity analyses.

For a description of the Group’s basis of measurement and methodology enhancements, refer to pages 187 to 189 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report.

CRD III capital charges
Following the implementation of CRD III in 2011, the Group is required to calculate: (i) Stressed VaR  (SVaR) - an additional capital charge based on a stressed calibration of the VaR model; (ii) an Incremental Risk Charge (IRC) to capture the default and migration risk for credit risk positions in the trading book; and (iii) an All Price Risk (APR) measure for correlation trading positions, subject to a capital floor that is based on standardised securitisation charges. The capital charges at 30 June 2012 associated with these models are shown in the table below:

 
30 June 
31 March 
31 December 
 
2012 
2012 
2011 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Stressed VaR
1,670 
1,793 
1,682 
Incremental Risk Charge
528 
659 
469 
All Price Risk
199 
262 
297 

Key points
·
The FSA approved the inclusion of the Group’s US trading subsidiary in the regulatory models in March 2012, resulting in an increase in the IRC and SVaR at 31 March 2012.
   
·
During Q2 2012, the IRC and SVaR decreased due to general de-risking in sovereign, corporate and agency positions. At the end of Q2 2012, an enhanced IRC model was implemented, partially offsetting the decrease. The APR decreased during Q1 and Q2 due to the unwinding of trades in Non-Core.





 
199

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

Daily distribution of Markets trading revenues


Note:
(1)
The effect of any month end adjustments, not attributable to a specific daily market move, is spread evenly over the trading days in the month in question.

Key points
·
The average daily revenue earned by Markets’ trading activities in H1 2012 was £20 million, compared with £26 million for H1 2011. The standard deviation of the daily revenues for H1 2012 was £14 million, compared with £17 million in H1 2011. The standard deviation measures the variation of daily revenues about the mean value of those revenues.
   
·
The number of days with negative revenue increased from six in H1 2011 to thirteen in H1 2012. Trading conditions were challenging, characterised by low, flat interest rate curves and by risk aversion weighing on credit and emerging market sentiment. In light of the economic slowdown and political uncertainty in Europe, client volumes remained very subdued.
   
·
The two most frequent results were daily revenue of: (i) between £15 million and £20 million, and (ii) between £20 million and £25 million, each of which occurred 19 times in H1 2012. In H1 2011, the most frequent result was daily revenue of between £25 million and £30 million, which occurred 18 times.





 
 

 
200

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Market risk (continued)
The tables below detail VaR for the Group’s trading portfolios.

 
Half year ended
31 December 
2011 
30 June 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
Average 
Period 
end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period 
 end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Period 
 end 
Trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                     
Interest rate
66.3 
58.7 
95.7 
43.6 
 
49.8 
36.8 
79.2 
27.5 
68.1 
Credit spread
75.7 
50.2 
94.9 
44.9 
 
103.4 
64.6 
151.1 
60.0 
74.3 
Currency
12.6 
10.9 
21.3 
8.2 
 
10.8 
9.3 
18.0 
5.2 
16.2 
Equity
6.3 
6.2 
12.5 
3.3 
 
10.8 
12.0 
17.3 
5.2 
8.0 
Commodity
1.9 
1.3 
6.0 
0.9 
 
0.2 
0.3 
1.6 
2.3 
Diversification (1)
 
(45.3)
       
(61.0)
   
(52.3)
                     
Total
103.4 
82.0 
137.0 
66.5 
 
117.3 
62.0 
181.3 
60.8 
116.6 
                     
Core
75.3 
67.2 
118.0 
47.4 
 
84.0 
42.5 
133.9 
42.5 
89.1 
Non-Core
35.8 
24.3 
41.9 
22.1 
 
91.4 
51.4 
128.6 
47.5 
34.6 
                     
CEM
78.2 
75.8 
84.2 
73.3 
 
43.6 
33.5 
57.4 
30.3 
75.8 
                     
Total (excluding CEM)
50.4 
43.0 
76.4 
37.5 
 
97.4 
47.6 
150.0 
45.8 
49.7 

Note:
(1)
The Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, currencies and markets. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time. Diversification has an inverse relationship with correlation. The diversification factor is the sum of the VaR on individual risk types less the total portfolio VaR.

Key points
·
The Group’s average credit spread VaR for H1 2012 was considerably lower than that for the same period last year, due to the credit spread volatility experienced during the 2008 financial crisis dropping out of the time series window, combined with a reduction in the asset-backed securities trading inventory in Core and the restructuring of some monoline hedges relating to the Non-Core banking book.
   
·
Counterparty Exposure Management (CEM) manages the over-the-counter derivative counterparty credit risk on behalf of other Markets businesses. More recently, CEM also centrally manages the funding risk on these contracts. The CEM trading VaR was considerably higher in H1 2012 than in H1 2011, primarily due to the transfer of funding risk management from individual desks to CEM.
   
·
The period end interest rate VaR was higher for H1 2012 than H1 2011. The VaR increased during H2 2011, driven by: (i) pre-hedging activity associated with a large successful UK gilt syndication in which RBS participated; and (ii) positioning reflecting market expectations. The VaR remained at this higher level during H1 2012 given further pre-hedging and positioning activity ahead of subsequent government bond auctions.


 
201

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
58.8 
58.7 
84.5 
43.6 
 
73.8 
68.3 
95.7 
51.2 
Credit spread
67.3 
50.2 
90.1 
44.9 
 
84.2 
88.5 
94.9 
72.6 
Currency
12.6 
10.9 
18.0 
8.8 
 
12.5 
11.1 
21.3 
8.2 
Equity
5.1 
6.2 
7.8 
3.3 
 
7.5 
6.3 
12.5 
4.7 
Commodity
1.2 
1.3 
2.4 
0.9 
 
2.5 
1.3 
6.0 
1.0 
Diversification (1)
 
(45.3)
       
(69.0)
   
                   
Total
90.3 
82.0 
111.0 
66.5 
 
116.6 
106.5 
137.0 
97.2 
                   
Core
67.9 
67.2 
84.1 
47.4 
 
82.8 
74.5 
118.0 
63.6 
Non-Core
32.9 
24.3 
40.4 
22.1 
 
38.7 
39.3 
41.9 
34.2 
                   
CEM
77.3 
75.8 
83.7 
73.8 
 
79.1 
78.5 
84.2 
73.3 
                   
Total (excluding CEM)
47.4 
43.0 
63.2 
37.5 
 
53.5 
56.6 
76.4 
41.0 

Note:
(1)
The Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, currencies and markets. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time. Diversification has an inverse relationship with correlation. The diversification factor is the sum of the VaR on individual risk types less the total portfolio VaR.

Key points
·
The average and period end Non-Core and credit spread VaR were lower in Q2 2012 than in Q1 2012, as Non-Core continued its de-risking strategy through the disposal of assets and unwinding of trades.
   
·
The average and period end interest rate trading VaR were lower in Q2 2012 than in Q1 2012, driven by position reductions in the early part of Q2 2012.
 

 
 
202

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)
The tables below detail VaR for the Group’s non-trading portfolio, excluding the structured credit portfolio and loans and receivables.

 
Half year ended
31 December 
2011 
30 June 2012
 
30 June 2011
 
Average 
Period 
end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period 
 end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Period 
 end 
Non-trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                     
Interest rate
8.4 
6.0 
10.7 
6.0 
 
8.0 
8.3 
10.8 
5.7 
9.9 
Credit spread
12.6 
9.1 
15.4 
9.1 
 
21.4 
18.0 
39.3 
14.2 
13.6 
Currency
3.5 
3.5 
4.5 
3.2 
 
1.1 
3.3 
3.3 
0.1 
4.0 
Equity
1.8 
1.6 
1.9 
1.6 
 
2.3 
2.0 
3.1 
2.0 
1.9 
Diversification (1)
 
(11.2)
       
(13.1)
   
(13.6)
                     
Total
14.3 
9.0 
18.3 
9.0 
 
22.6 
18.5 
41.6 
13.4 
15.8 
                     
Core
14.0 
9.0 
19.0 
8.9 
 
22.0 
19.4 
38.9 
13.5 
15.1 
Non-Core
2.2 
1.7 
2.6 
1.6 
 
3.2 
4.3 
4.3 
2.2 
2.5 
                     
CEM
1.0 
1.0 
1.0 
0.9 
 
0.3 
0.3 
0.4 
0.3 
0.9 
                     
Total (excluding CEM)
14.1 
9.0 
17.8 
9.0 
 
22.5 
18.4 
41.4 
13.7 
15.5 

Note:
(1)
The Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, currencies and markets. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time. Diversification has an inverse relationship with correlation. The diversification factor is the sum of the VaR on individual risk types less the total portfolio VaR.

Key point
·
The average Core and credit spread VaR were considerably lower in H1 2012 than in H1 2011, due to reduced volatility in the market data time series, position reductions and a decrease in the size of the collateral portfolio. The reduction in collateral was driven by the restructuring of certain Dutch RMBS. This restructuring facilitated their eligibility as ECB collateral and allowed the disposal in H1 2012 of additional collateral purchased during H2 2011.


 
203

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Market risk (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
30 June 2012
 
31 March 2012
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Non-trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
7.2 
6.0 
8.3 
6.0 
 
9.6 
8.7 
10.7 
8.7 
Credit spread
11.4 
9.1 
13.4 
9.1 
 
13.9 
15.2 
15.4 
12.9 
Currency
3.3 
3.5 
3.6 
3.2 
 
3.7 
3.3 
4.5 
3.2 
Equity
1.6 
1.6 
1.8 
1.6 
 
1.9 
1.8 
1.9 
1.8 
Diversification (1)
 
(11.2)
       
(10.8)
   
                   
Total
12.8 
9.0 
15.5 
9.0 
 
15.7 
18.2 
18.3 
13.6 
                   
Core
12.3 
9.0 
14.8 
8.9 
 
15.7 
18.8 
19.0 
13.5 
Non-Core
1.8 
1.7 
2.5 
1.6 
 
2.5 
2.4 
2.6 
2.4 
                   
CEM
1.0 
1.0 
1.0 
0.9 
 
1.0 
0.9 
1.0 
0.9 
                   
Total (excluding CEM)
12.4 
9.0 
15.4 
9.0 
 
15.7 
17.4 
17.8 
13.5 

Note:
(1)
The Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, currencies and markets. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time. Diversification has an inverse relationship with correlation. The diversification factor is the sum of the VaR on individual risk types less the total portfolio VaR.

Key point
·
The Group’s total non-trading VaR was lower in Q2 2012 than in the previous quarter, largely due to decreases in the credit spread and interest rate VaR, which were driven by reduced volatility in the time series and the decrease in the collateral portfolio referred to on the previous page.
 

 
 
204

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

Structured Credit Portfolio
The Structured Credit Portfolio is within Non-Core. The risk in this portfolio is not measured or disclosed using VaR, as the Group believes this is not an appropriate tool for the banking book portfolio, which comprises illiquid debt securities. These assets are reported on a drawn notional and fair value basis, and managed on a third party asset and RWA basis. The table below shows the open market risk in the structured credit portfolio.

 
Drawn notional
 
Fair value
 
CDOs 
CLOs 
MBS (1)
Other 
 ABS 
Total 
 
CDOs 
CLOs 
MBS (1)
Other 
 ABS 
Total 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
1-2 years
122 
122 
 
114 
114 
2-3 years
69 
76 
 
65 
71 
3-4 years
49 
58 
 
46 
55 
4-5 years
103 
40 
143 
 
83 
37 
120 
5-10 years
379 
174 
277 
830 
 
352 
109 
242 
703 
>10 years
346 
359 
485 
573 
1,763 
 
139 
315 
308 
329 
1,091 
                       
 
346 
747 
769 
1,130 
2,992 
 
139 
676 
506 
833 
2,154 
                       
31 March 2012
                     
                       
1-2 years
54 
54 
 
48 
48 
2-3 years
153 
162 
 
143 
152 
4-5 years
18 
30 
93 
141 
 
17 
23 
86 
126 
5-10 years
368 
254 
248 
870 
 
334 
167 
210 
711 
>10 years
1,115 
432 
833 
557 
2,937 
 
202 
368 
569 
319 
1,458 
                       
 
1,115 
818 
1,126 
1,105 
4,164 
 
202 
719 
768 
806 
2,495 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
1-2 years
27 
27 
 
22 
22 
2-3 years
10 
196 
206 
 
182 
191 
4-5 years
37 
37 
95 
169 
 
34 
30 
88 
152 
5-10 years
32 
503 
270 
268 
1,073 
 
30 
455 
184 
229 
898 
>10 years
2,180 
442 
464 
593 
3,679 
 
766 
371 
291 
347 
1,775 
                       
 
2,212 
982 
781 
1,179 
5,154 
 
796 
860 
514 
868 
3,038 

Note:
(1)
MBS include sub-prime RMBS with a notional amount of £369 million (31 March 2012 - £396 million; 31 December 2011 - £401 million) and a fair value of £235 million (31 March 2012 - £258 million; 31 December 2011 - £252 million), all with residual maturities of >10 years.

Key point
·
The CDO drawn notional was significantly lower at 30 June 2012 than at 31 December 2011, due to the liquidation of legacy trust preferred securities and commercial real estate CDOs and the subsequent sale of the underlying assets. Some retained assets were added to the MBS portfolio during Q1 2012, increasing the MBS drawn notional at 31 March 2012, but were sold outright during Q2 2012, reducing the drawn notional back to the level seen at 31 December 2011.


 
205

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk

Introduction
Country risk is the risk of material losses arising from significant country-specific events such as sovereign events (default or restructuring); economic events (contagion of sovereign default to other parts of the economy, cyclical economic shock); political events (transfer or convertibility restrictions and expropriation or nationalisation); and natural disaster or conflict. Such events have the potential to affect elements of the Group’s credit portfolio that are directly or indirectly linked to the country in question and can also give rise to market, liquidity, operational and franchise risk related losses.

The risk that one or more of the weaker eurozone member states will default on its external debts and/or exit the eurozone is a particular concern. It carries with it the potential for broader economic contagion and even a complete break-up or restructuring of the eurozone. The potential for such events gives rise to redenomination risk - the risk that losses may occur when a country converts its currency and then suffers a sharp devaluation - in addition to other risks.

The Group’s overall exposure to redenomination risk is difficult to predict with certainty, but the key driving factors are the currency of exposures; the form and nature of the documentation, collateral and guarantees related to the exposures; and whether there are offsetting liabilities that would be redenominated at the same time. For the purposes of estimating funding mismatches at risk of redenomination (see below), the Group assumes that non-euro exposures, and certain facilities documented under international law, are unlikely to be affected by a redenomination event.

The Group believes that the balances reported in this section represent a realistic, if conservative, view of its asset exposure to redenomination risk and related risks. Assets that are not denominated in euros, and facilities that are guaranteed or documented under international law, are expected to have protection from redenomination, and analysis shows the Group’s actual exposure purely to redenomination risk is lower. However, a redenomination event would be accompanied by increased credit risk, for two reasons. First, capital controls would likely be introduced in the affected country - resulting in any non-redenominated assets, including non-euro assets, potentially becoming harder to service (transfer and convertibility event). Second, a sharp devaluation could imply payment difficulties for counterparties with large debts denominated in foreign currency (counterparty defaults).

The Group's focus has been on reducing its asset exposures and funding mismatches in the eurozone periphery countries. Total asset exposures to these countries fell by 10% in H1 2012. Estimated funding mismatches at 30 June 2012 are approximately £12 billion in Ireland and £7 billion in Spain. The mismatch positions in Portugal and Greece are modest. In Italy there are surplus liabilities of approximately £1 billion. The Group is taking steps to significantly reduce its Spanish funding mismatch and expects to make further progress in the second half of this year.







 
 
 
206

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Introduction (continued)
For further details of the Group’s approach to country risk management, refer to pages 166 to 168 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report.

The following tables show the Group’s exposures by country of incorporation of the counterparty at 30 June 2012. Countries shown are those where the Group’s balance sheet exposure to counterparties incorporated in the country exceeded £1 billion and the country had an external rating of A+ or below from S&P, Moody’s or Fitch at 30 June 2012, as well as certain eurozone countries. The numbers are stated before taking into account mitigants, such as collateral (with the exception of reverse repos), insurance or guarantees, which may have been taken to reduce or eliminate exposure to country risk events. Exposures relating to ocean-going vessels are not included due to their multinational nature.

Definitions of headings in the following tables:

Lending - comprises gross loans and advances to: central and local government; central banks, including cash balances; other banks and financial institutions, incorporating overdraft and other short-term facilities; corporates, in large part loans and leases; and individuals, comprising mortgages, personal loans and credit card balances. Lending includes impaired loans and loans where an impairment event has taken place but no impairment provision is recognised - risk elements in lending (REIL).

Debt securities - comprise securities classified as available-for-sale (AFS), loans and receivables (LAR), held-for-trading (HFT) and designated as at fair value through profit or loss (DFV). All debt securities other than LAR securities are carried at fair value. LAR debt securities are carried at amortised cost less impairment. HFT debt securities are presented as gross long positions (including DFV securities) and short positions per country. Impairment losses and exchange differences relating to AFS debt securities, together with interest are recognised in the income statement; other changes in the fair value of AFS securities are reported within AFS reserves, which are presented gross of tax.


 
207

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Introduction (continued)

Derivatives (net) - comprises the mark-to-market (mtm) value of such contracts after the effect of legally enforceable netting agreements but before the effect of collateral. In the event of counterparty default, this is the net amount due to the Group from the counterparty. Counterparty netting is applied within the regulatory capital model used.

Reverse repos (net) - comprises the mtm value of such contracts after the effect of legally enforceable netting agreements and collateral. Counterparty netting is applied within the regulatory capital model used.

Balance sheet - comprises lending exposures, debt securities and derivatives and reverse repo exposures, as defined above.

In addition, for eurozone periphery countries, derivative and reverse repo netting referred to above is disclosed.

Off-balance sheet - comprises contingent liabilities, including guarantees, and committed undrawn facilities.

Credit default swaps (CDSs) - under a CDS contract, the credit risk on the reference entity is transferred from the buyer to the seller. The fair value, or mtm, represents the balance sheet carrying value. The mtm value of CDSs is included within derivatives against the counterparty of the trade, as opposed to the reference entity. The notional is the par amount of the credit protection bought or sold and is included against the reference entity of the CDS contract.

The column CDS notional less fair value represents the notional less fair value amounts arising from sold positions netted against those arising from bought positions, which equals the net change in exposure for a given reference entity should the CDS contract be triggered by a credit event, assuming there is zero recovery rate. However, in most cases, the Group expects the recovery rate to be greater than zero and the change in exposure to be less than this amount.

Government - comprises central and local government.

Asset quality (AQ) - for the probability of default range relating to each internal asset quality band, refer to page 103 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report.

Eurozone periphery - comprises Ireland, Spain, Italy, Portugal, Greece and Cyprus.

Other eurozone - comprises Austria, Estonia, Finland, Malta, Slovakia and Slovenia.


 
208

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Summary

 
30 June 2012
 
Lending
 
Debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off- 
balance 
sheet 
 
Total 
 
CDS 
notional 
less fair 
value 
Government 
Central 
banks 
Other 
banks 
Other 
financial 
institutions 
Corporate 
Personal 
Total 
lending 
 
Of which 
Non- 
Core 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                               
Eurozone
                                             
Ireland
45 
1,800 
40 
374 
18,340 
17,978 
38,577 
 
9,723 
 
747 
 
1,822 
 
551 
 
41,697 
 
2,979 
 
44,676 
 
(67)
Spain
117 
107 
4,937 
337 
5,507 
 
3,207 
 
4,619 
 
2,261 
 
 
12,387 
 
1,962 
 
14,349 
 
(542)
Italy
32 
176 
257 
1,587 
25 
2,077 
 
1,007 
 
660 
 
2,317 
 
 
5,054 
 
2,677 
 
7,731 
 
(75)
Portugal
411 
417 
 
252 
 
143 
 
562 
 
 
1,122 
 
174 
 
1,296 
 
24 
Greece
30 
149 
12 
195 
 
69 
 
16 
 
351 
 
 
562 
 
46 
 
608 
 
(9)
Cyprus
39 
241 
14 
294 
 
127 
 
 
52 
 
 
346 
 
17 
 
363 
 
                                               
Eurozone
  periphery
58 
1,832 
333 
807 
25,665 
18,372 
47,067 
 
14,385 
 
6,185 
 
7,365 
 
551 
 
61,168 
 
7,855 
 
69,023 
 
(669)
                                               
Germany
17,351 
610 
299 
5,525 
156 
23,941 
 
4,527 
 
13,417 
 
10,283 
 
390 
 
48,031 
 
8,329 
 
56,360 
 
(1,769)
Netherlands
9,185 
617 
1,556 
4,755 
29 
16,143 
 
2,563 
 
8,548 
 
10,261 
 
634 
 
35,586 
 
11,954 
 
47,540 
 
(1,102)
France
498 
829 
176 
2,913 
73 
4,491 
 
2,028 
 
4,344 
 
7,877 
 
401 
 
17,113 
 
9,455 
 
26,568 
 
(1,688)
Belgium
300 
246 
493 
21 
1,060 
 
343 
 
1,282 
 
3,052 
 
21 
 
5,415 
 
1,402 
 
6,817 
 
(127)
Luxembourg
471 
2,100 
2,575 
 
1,072 
 
311 
 
1,578 
 
393 
 
4,857 
 
1,934 
 
6,791 
 
(304)
Other eurozone
60 
16 
73 
974 
13 
1,136 
 
172 
 
922 
 
1,743 
 
31 
 
3,832 
 
1,312 
 
5,144 
 
(150)
                                               
Total eurozone
617 
28,370 
2,706 
3,628 
42,425 
18,667 
96,413 
 
25,090 
 
35,009 
 
42,159 
 
2,421 
 
176,002 
 
42,241 
 
218,243 
 
(5,809)
                                               
Other countries
                                             
                                               
Japan
629 
477 
240 
326 
19 
1,691 
 
195 
 
10,331 
 
1,815 
 
178 
 
14,015 
 
721 
 
14,736 
 
(295)
India
85 
1,077 
37 
2,912 
96 
4,207 
 
213 
 
1,259 
 
137 
 
 
5,603 
 
1,492 
 
7,095 
 
(59)
China
195 
1,281 
60 
667 
28 
2,237 
 
56 
 
622 
 
365 
 
240 
 
3,464 
 
1,827 
 
5,291 
 
57 
South Korea
570 
620 
1,199 
 
 
769 
 
203 
 
150 
 
2,321 
 
806 
 
3,127 
 
(150)
Brazil
859 
203 
1,065 
 
62 
 
742 
 
44 
 
 
1,851 
 
273 
 
2,124 
 
496 
Turkey
135 
54 
120 
69 
998 
20 
1,396 
 
312 
 
313 
 
90 
 
 
1,799 
 
659 
 
2,458 
 
Russia
32 
810 
514 
50 
1,408 
 
66 
 
211 
 
45 
 
 
1,664 
 
538 
 
2,202 
 
(264)
Romania
23 
114 
378 
356 
879 
 
878 
 
313 
 
 
 
1,197 
 
126 
 
1,323 
 
(24)
 

 
 
209

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Summary (continued)
 
31 December 2011 (1)
 
Lending
 
Debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
sheet 
 
Total 
 
CDS 
notional 
less fair 
value 
Government 
Central 
banks 
Other 
banks 
Other 
financial 
institutions 
Corporate 
Personal 
Total 
lending 
 
Of which 
Non- 
Core 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                               
Eurozone
                                             
Ireland
45 
1,467 
136 
333 
18,994 
18,858 
39,833 
 
10,156 
 
886 
 
2,273 
 
551 
 
43,543 
 
2,928 
 
46,471 
 
53 
Spain
130 
154 
5,775 
362 
6,433 
 
3,735 
 
6,155 
 
2,391 
 
 
14,981 
 
2,630 
 
17,611 
 
(1,013)
Italy
73 
233 
299 
2,444 
23 
3,072 
 
1,155 
 
1,258 
 
2,314 
 
 
6,644 
 
3,150 
 
9,794 
 
(452)
Portugal
10 
495 
510 
 
341 
 
113 
 
519 
 
 
1,142 
 
268 
 
1,410 
 
55 
Greece
31 
427 
14 
485 
 
94 
 
409 
 
355 
 
 
1,249 
 
52 
 
1,301 
 
Cyprus
38 
250 
14 
302 
 
133 
 
 
56 
 
 
360 
 
68 
 
428 
 
                                               
Eurozone
  periphery
61 
1,549 
509 
855 
28,385 
19,276 
50,635 
 
15,614 
 
8,823 
 
7,908 
 
553 
 
67,919 
 
9,096 
 
77,015 
 
(1,356)
                                               
Germany
18,068 
653 
305 
6,608 
155 
25,789 
 
5,402 
 
15,767 
 
10,169 
 
166 
 
51,891 
 
7,527 
 
59,418 
 
(2,401)
Netherlands
7,654 
623 
1,557 
4,827 
20 
14,689 
 
2,498 
 
9,893 
 
10,010 
 
275 
 
34,867 
 
13,561 
 
48,428 
 
(1,295)
France
481 
1,273 
282 
3,761 
79 
5,879 
 
2,317 
 
7,794 
 
8,701 
 
345 
 
22,719 
 
10,217 
 
32,936 
 
(2,846)
Belgium
287 
354 
588 
20 
1,257 
 
480 
 
652 
 
2,959 
 
51 
 
4,919 
 
1,359 
 
6,278 
 
(99)
Luxembourg
101 
925 
2,228 
3,256 
 
1,497 
 
130 
 
2,884 
 
805 
 
7,075 
 
2,007 
 
9,082 
 
(404)
Other eurozone
121 
28 
77 
1,125 
12 
1,363 
 
191 
 
708 
 
1,894 
 
 
3,965 
 
1,297 
 
5,262 
 
(25)
                                               
Total eurozone
671 
27,282 
3,474 
4,355 
47,522 
19,564 
102,868 
 
27,999 
 
43,767 
 
44,525 
 
2,195 
 
193,355 
 
45,064 
 
238,419 
 
(8,426)
                                               
Other countries
                                             
                                               
Japan
2,085 
688 
96 
433 
26 
3,328 
 
338 
 
12,456 
 
2,443 
 
191 
 
18,418 
 
452 
 
18,870 
 
(365)
India
275 
610 
35 
2,949 
127 
3,996 
 
350 
 
1,530 
 
218 
 
 
5,744 
 
1,280 
 
7,024 
 
(105)
China
178 
1,237 
16 
654 
30 
2,124 
 
50 
 
597 
 
410 
 
 
3,134 
 
1,559 
 
4,693 
 
(62)
South Korea
812 
576 
1,396 
 
 
845 
 
251 
 
153 
 
2,645 
 
627 
 
3,272 
 
(22)
Brazil
936 
227 
1,167 
 
70 
 
790 
 
24 
 
 
1,981 
 
319 
 
2,300 
 
164 
Turkey
215 
193 
252 
66 
1,072 
16 
1,814 
 
423 
 
361 
 
94 
 
 
2,269 
 
437 
 
2,706 
 
10 
Russia
36 
970 
659 
62 
1,735 
 
76 
 
186 
 
47 
 
 
1,968 
 
356 
 
2,324 
 
(343)
Romania
66 
145 
30 
413 
392 
1,054 
 
1,054 
 
220 
 
 
 
1,280 
 
160 
 
1,440 
 


Note:
(1)
Lending and reverse repos have been revised to exclude cash-equivalent of collateral pledged against derivative liabilities and central bank facilities respectively.
 

 
 
210

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Summary (continued)
Reported exposures are affected by currency movements. Over the first half of 2012, sterling appreciated 1.4% against the US dollar and 3.5% against the euro.

Key points
·
Balance sheet and off-balance sheet exposures to most countries shown in the table declined in the first half of 2012, as the Group maintained a cautious stance and many clients reduced debt levels. The reductions were seen in all product categories except reverse repos, and in all client groups, with a few exceptions as noted below. Non-Core exposure declined as the strategy for disposal progressed, particularly in Germany and Spain.
   
·
Total eurozone - balance sheet exposure declined by £17.4 billion or 9% in the first half of 2012 to £176.0 billion, with reductions seen primarily in periphery countries but also in France, Germany and Luxembourg. This reflected exchange rate movements, sales of Greek, Spanish and Portuguese government bonds, write-offs, active exposure management and debt reduction efforts by bank clients.
   
·
Eurozone periphery - balance sheet exposure decreased in all peripheral countries to a combined £61.2 billion, a reduction by £6.8 billion or 10%, caused in part by reductions in AFS bonds. Most of the Group’s exposure arises from the activities of Markets, International Banking, Group Treasury and Ulster Bank (with respect to Ireland). Group Treasury has a portfolio of Spanish bank and financial institution market-based securities bonds. International Banking provides trade finance facilities to clients across Europe, including the eurozone periphery. Exposure to Cyprus amounted to £0.4 billion at 30 June 2012, comprising largely lending exposure to special purpose vehicles incorporated in Cyprus.
   
·
Japan - Exposure decreased during the first half of 2012, in part reflecting a reduction in International Banking’s cash management business and a change in Japanese yen clearing status from direct (self-clearing) membership to agency, resulting in a £2.2 billion reduction in AFS Japanese government bonds. Derivative exposure decreased because of reduced forward foreign exchange positions being taken by clients from the start of the new Japanese fiscal year (1 April).
   
·
CDS protection bought and sold:
 
The Group uses CDS contracts to service customer activity as well as to manage counterparty and country exposure. During the first half of 2012, eurozone gross notional CDS contracts, bought and sold, decreased significantly. This was caused by maturing of contracts and by efforts to reduce counterparty credit exposures and risk-weighted assets through derivative compression trades and other means. The fair value of bought and sold CDS contracts also decreased, due to the reduction in gross notional CDS positions and to a narrowing of CDS spreads over the first half of 2012 for a number of eurozone countries, including Portugal and Ireland.
 
Greek sovereign CDS positions were fully closed out in April, as the use of the collective action clause in the Greek debt swap resulted in a credit event occurring, which triggered Greek sovereign CDS contracts.





 
 
 
211

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Summary (continued)

Key points (continued)
 
The Group transacts CDS contracts primarily with investment-grade global financial institutions that are active participants in the CDS market. These transactions are subject to regular margining. For European peripheral sovereigns, credit protection has been purchased from a number of major European banks, predominantly outside the country of the reference entity. In a few cases where protection was bought from banks in the country of the reference entity, giving rise to wrong-way risk, the risk is mitigated through specific collateralisation.
 
Due to their bespoke nature, exposures relating to CDPCs and associated hedges have not been included as they cannot be meaningfully attributed to a particular country or reference entity. Nth-to-default basket swaps have also been excluded as they cannot be meaningfully attributed to a particular reference entity.

For more specific commentary on the Group’s exposure to Ireland, Spain, Italy, Portugal and Greece, refer to pages 217 to 227. For commentary on the Group’s exposure to other eurozone non-periphery countries, see page 241.



 
212

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Total eurozone

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
617 
 
12,621 
194 
 
19,238 
13,580 
 
18,279 
 
1,667 
 
 
20,563 
 
1,683 
 
22,246 
Central banks
28,370 
 
 
 
 
28 
 
 
28,398 
 
 
28,398 
Other banks
2,706 
 
5,488 
(684)
 
1,063 
1,358 
 
5,193 
 
28,824 
 
1,609 
 
38,332 
 
4,518 
 
42,850 
Other FI
3,628 
 
9,590 
(1,072)
 
1,274 
331 
 
10,533 
 
7,666 
 
811 
 
22,638 
 
6,522 
 
29,160 
Corporate
42,425 
13,993 
6,975 
 
825 
31 
 
400 
221 
 
1,004 
 
3,973 
 
 
47,403 
 
28,753 
 
76,156 
Personal
18,667 
2,664 
1,371 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18,668 
 
765 
 
19,433 
                                           
 
96,413 
16,657 
8,346 
 
28,524 
(1,531)
 
21,975 
15,490 
 
35,009 
 
42,159 
 
2,421 
 
176,002 
 
42,241 
 
218,243 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
671 
 
18,406 
81 
 
19,597 
15,049 
 
22,954 
 
1,924 
 
 
25,549 
 
1,056 
 
26,605 
Central banks
27,282 
 
20 
 
 
26 
 
35 
 
 
27,343 
 
 
27,343 
Other banks
3,474 
 
8,423 
(752)
 
1,272 
1,502 
 
8,193 
 
28,595 
 
1,090 
 
41,352 
 
4,493 
 
45,845 
Other FI
4,355 
 
10,494 
(1,129)
 
1,138 
471 
 
11,161 
 
9,854 
 
1,102 
 
26,472 
 
8,199 
 
34,671 
Corporate
47,522 
14,152 
7,267 
 
964 
24 
 
528 
59 
 
1,433 
 
4,116 
 
 
53,074 
 
30,551 
 
83,625 
Personal
19,564 
2,280 
1,069 
 
 
 
 
 
 
19,565 
 
765 
 
20,330 
                                           
 
102,868 
16,432 
8,336 
 
38,307 
(1,776)
 
22,541 
17,081 
 
43,767 
 
44,525 
 
2,195 
 
193,355 
 
45,064 
 
238,419 

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
33,378 
32,363 
 
3,674 
(3,531)
 
37,080 
36,759 
 
6,488 
(6,376)
Other banks
14,590 
14,564 
 
1,131 
(1,073)
 
19,736 
19,232 
 
2,303 
(2,225)
Other FI
11,517 
10,554 
 
499 
(448)
 
17,949 
16,608 
 
693 
(620)
Corporate
50,151 
45,800 
 
1,149 
(855)
 
76,966 
70,119 
 
2,241 
(1,917)
                       
 
109,636 
103,281 
 
6,453 
(5,907)
 
151,731 
142,718 
 
11,725 
(11,138)
 

 
 
213

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Total eurozone (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                             
Banks
53,212 
3,234 
 
1,295 
150 
 
186 
22 
 
 
54,693 
3,406 
Other FI
51,975 
2,787 
 
546 
37 
 
2,280 
214 
 
142 
 
54,943 
3,047 
                             
 
105,187 
6,021 
 
1,841 
187 
 
2,466 
236 
 
142 
 
109,636 
6,453 
                             
31 December 2011
                           
                             
Banks
67,624 
5,585 
 
1,085 
131 
 
198 
23 
 
 
68,907 
5,739 
Other FI
79,824 
5,605 
 
759 
89 
 
2,094 
278 
 
147 
14 
 
82,824 
5,986 
                             
 
147,448 
11,190 
 
1,844 
220 
 
2,292 
301 
 
147 
14 
 
151,731 
11,725 




 
214

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Eurozone periphery

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
58 
 
519 
(198)
 
4,524 
5,053 
 
(10)
 
103 
 
 
151 
 
72 
 
223 
Central banks
1,832 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,832 
 
 
1,832 
Other banks
333 
 
3,440 
(813)
 
287 
247 
 
3,480 
 
4,747 
 
473 
 
9,033 
 
105 
 
9,138 
Other FI
807 
 
2,041 
(674)
 
405 
48 
 
2,398 
 
896 
 
78 
 
4,179 
 
1,667 
 
5,846 
Corporate
25,665 
11,892 
6,246 
 
189 
 
148 
20 
 
317 
 
1,618 
 
 
27,600 
 
5,391 
 
32,991 
Personal
18,372 
2,634 
1,346 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18,373 
 
620 
 
18,993 
                                           
 
47,067 
14,526 
7,592 
 
6,189 
(1,684)
 
5,364 
5,368 
 
6,185 
 
7,365 
 
551 
 
61,168 
 
7,855 
 
69,023 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
61 
 
1,207 
(339)
 
4,854 
5,652 
 
409 
 
236 
 
 
706 
 
118 
 
824 
Central banks
1,549 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,549 
 
 
1,549 
Other banks
509 
 
5,279 
(956)
 
436 
318 
 
5,397 
 
4,350 
 
480 
 
10,736 
 
67 
 
10,803 
Other FI
855 
 
2,331 
(654)
 
228 
56 
 
2,503 
 
1,783 
 
73 
 
5,214 
 
1,862 
 
7,076 
Corporate
28,385 
12,272 
6,567 
 
274 
 
240 
 
514 
 
1,538 
 
 
30,437 
 
6,412 
 
36,849 
Personal
19,276 
2,258 
1,048 
 
 
 
 
 
 
19,277 
 
637 
 
19,914 
                                           
 
50,635 
14,530 
7,615 
 
9,091 
(1,945)
 
5,758 
6,026 
 
8,823 
 
7,908 
 
553 
 
67,919 
 
9,096 
 
77,015 

Derivative and reverse repo netting were £29,590 million (31 December 2011 - £32,506 million) and £3,195 million (31 December 2011 - £3,320 million) respectively.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
22,092 
22,292 
 
3,349 
(3,232)
 
25,883 
26,174 
 
5,979 
(5,926)
Other banks
6,639 
6,618 
 
778 
(751)
 
9,372 
9,159 
 
1,657 
(1,623)
Other FI
2,767 
2,498 
 
222 
(199)
 
3,854 
3,635 
 
290 
(262)
Corporate
7,567 
6,701 
 
691 
(571)
 
10,798 
9,329 
 
999 
(860)
                       
 
39,065 
38,109 
 
5,040 
(4,753)
 
49,907 
48,297 
 
8,925 
(8,671)
 

 
 
215

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Eurozone periphery (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
21,383 
2,718 
 
874 
136 
 
90 
14 
 
22,347 
2,868 
Other FI
15,731 
2,053 
 
189 
 
798 
114 
 
16,718 
2,172 
                       
 
37,114 
4,771 
 
1,063 
141 
 
888 
128 
 
39,065 
5,040 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
26,008 
4,606 
 
604 
112 
 
93 
14 
 
26,705 
4,732 
Other FI
22,082 
3,980 
 
394 
51 
 
726 
162 
 
23,202 
4,193 
                       
 
48,090 
8,586 
 
998 
163 
 
819 
176 
 
49,907 
8,925 


 
216

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Ireland

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
45 
 
109 
(36)
 
 
109 
 
 
 
156 
 
 
158 
Central bank
1,800 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,800 
 
 
1,800 
Other banks
40 
 
174 
(25)
 
66 
25 
 
215 
 
742 
 
473 
 
1,470 
 
40 
 
1,510 
Other FI
374 
 
51 
 
301 
 
348 
 
671 
 
78 
 
1,471 
 
632 
 
2,103 
Corporate
18,340 
10,311 
5,683 
 
75 
 
 
75 
 
406 
 
 
18,821 
 
1,785 
 
20,606 
Personal
17,978 
2,634 
1,346 
 
 
 
 
 
 
17,979 
 
520 
 
18,499 
                                           
 
38,577 
12,945 
7,029 
 
409 
(60)
 
377 
39 
 
747 
 
1,822 
 
551 
 
41,697 
 
2,979 
 
44,676 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
45 
 
102 
(46)
 
20 
19 
 
103 
 
92 
 
 
240 
 
 
242 
Central bank
1,467 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,467 
 
 
1,467 
Other banks
136 
 
177 
(39)
 
195 
14 
 
358 
 
981 
 
478 
 
1,953 
 
 
1,953 
Other FI
333 
 
61 
 
116 
35 
 
142 
 
782 
 
73 
 
1,330 
 
546 
 
1,876 
Corporate
18,994 
10,269 
5,689 
 
148 
 
135 
 
283 
 
417 
 
 
19,694 
 
1,841 
 
21,535 
Personal
18,858 
2,258 
1,048 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18,859 
 
539 
 
19,398 
                                           
 
39,833 
12,527 
6,737 
 
488 
(82)
 
466 
68 
 
886 
 
2,273 
 
551 
 
43,543 
 
2,928 
 
46,471 

Derivative and reverse repo netting were £16,122 million (31 December 2011 - £19,189 million) and £2,645 million (31 December 2011 - £2,324 million) respectively.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
2,294 
2,385 
 
360 
(376)
 
2,145 
2,223 
 
466 
(481)
Other banks
114 
111 
 
(8)
 
110 
107 
 
21 
(21)
Other FI
704 
644 
 
68 
(69)
 
523 
630 
 
64 
(74)
Corporate
316 
238 
 
(16)
16 
 
425 
322 
 
(11)
10 
                       
 
3,428 
3,378 
 
420 
(437)
 
3,203 
3,282 
 
540 
(566)
 

 
 
217

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Ireland (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
1,621 
230 
 
 
 
1,626 
231 
Other FI
1,343 
179 
 
161 
 
298 
10 
 
1,802 
189 
                       
 
2,964 
409 
 
166 
 
298 
10 
 
3,428 
420 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
1,586 
300 
 
 
 
1,588 
300 
Other FI
1,325 
232 
 
161 
 
129 
 
1,615 
240 
                       
 
2,911 
532 
 
163 
 
129 
 
3,203 
540 

Key points
·
At 30 June 2012, Ulster Bank Group (UBG) contributed 88% of the Group’s exposure to Ireland (31 December 2011 - 87%). The largest components of the Group’s exposure are corporate lending of £18.3 billion (more than half of which is to the property sector - mainly commercial real estate, plus construction and building materials) and personal lending of £18.0 billion (mainly mortgages). In addition, Ulster Bank Group has money market placings with the Central Bank of Ireland (CBI), and Markets has derivative exposure to financial institutions and large international clients with funding subsidiaries based in Ireland.
   
·
Group exposure decreased further in the first half of 2012, with a reduction in lending of £1.3 billion as a result of currency movements and de-risking in the portfolio. Derivative and repo exposure, largely in Markets, decreased by £0.5 billion mainly as a result of lower interest rates.

·
Government and Central bank
 
Exposure to the CBI fluctuates, driven by regulatory requirements and by deposits of excess liquidity as part of UBG’s asset and liability management.

·
Financial institutions
 
Markets, International Banking and UBG account for the majority of the Group’s exposure to financial institutions. The largest category is derivatives and reverse repos, where exposure is affected predominantly by market movements and much of the exposure is collateralised.

·
Corporate
 
Lending exposure fell by approximately £0.7 billion over the first half of 2012, driven by exchange rate movements and write-offs. Commercial real estate lending, nearly all in UBG, amounted to £10.5 billion at 30 June 2012, down £0.4 billion from 31 December 2011 amid continuing adverse market conditions. The commercial real estate lending exposure is largely in UBG Non-Core and includes REIL of £7.6 billion and loan provisions of £4.1 billion.

 
 
218

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Ireland (continued)

Key points (continued)
 
·
Personal
 
Overall lending exposure fell a further £0.9 billion as a result of exchange rate movements, amortisation, maturities, a small amount of write-offs, low new business volumes and active risk management. Residential mortgage loans amounted to £17.0 billion, including REIL of £2.5 billion and loan provisions of £1.1 billion. The housing market continues to suffer from weak domestic demand, with house prices now approximately 50% below their 2007 peak.

·
Non-Core (included above)
 
Ireland Non-Core lending exposure was £9.7 billion at 30 June 2012, down by £0.4 billion since 31 December 2011. The remaining lending portfolio largely consisted of exposures to real estate (80%), retail (6%) and leisure (4%).

 
 


 
219

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Spain

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
 
29 
(19)
 
383 
493 
 
(81)
 
 
 
(69)
 
70 
 
Central bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
117 
 
3,092 
(758)
 
163 
113 
 
3,142 
 
1,776 
 
 
5,035 
 
40 
 
5,075 
Other FI
107 
 
1,472 
(662)
 
67 
32 
 
1,507 
 
38 
 
 
1,652 
 
251 
 
1,903 
Corporate
4,937 
1,008 
226 
 
 
61 
10 
 
51 
 
444 
 
 
5,432 
 
1,544 
 
6,976 
Personal
337 
 
 
 
 
 
 
337 
 
57 
 
394 
                                           
 
5,507 
1,008 
226 
 
4,593 
(1,439)
 
674 
648 
 
4,619 
 
2,261 
 
 
12,387 
 
1,962 
 
14,349 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
 
33 
(15)
 
360 
751 
 
(358)
 
35 
 
 
(314)
 
116 
 
(198)
Central bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
130 
 
4,892 
(867)
 
162 
214 
 
4,840 
 
1,620 
 
 
6,592 
 
41 
 
6,633 
Other FI
154 
 
1,580 
(639)
 
65 
 
1,637 
 
282 
 
 
2,073 
 
169 
 
2,242 
Corporate
5,775 
1,190 
442 
 
 
27 
 
36 
 
454 
 
 
6,265 
 
2,247 
 
8,512 
Personal
362 
 
 
 
 
 
 
362 
 
57 
 
419 
                                           
 
6,433 
1,190 
442 
 
6,514 
(1,521)
 
614 
973 
 
6,155 
 
2,391 
 
 
14,981 
 
2,630 
 
17,611 

Derivative and reverse repo netting were £4,440 million (31 December 2011 - £4,384 million) and £487 million (31 December 2011 - £567 million) respectively.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
4,960 
4,968 
 
693 
(665)
 
5,151 
5,155 
 
538 
(522)
Other banks
1,779 
1,739 
 
145 
(136)
 
1,965 
1,937 
 
154 
(152)
Other FI
1,269 
1,087 
 
98 
(78)
 
2,417 
2,204 
 
157 
(128)
Corporate
3,168 
2,733 
 
282 
(232)
 
4,831 
3,959 
 
448 
(399)
                       
 
11,176 
10,527 
 
1,218 
(1,111)
 
14,364 
13,255 
 
1,297 
(1,201)
 
 
220

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Spain (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
5,602 
559 
 
51 
 
31 
 
5,684 
570 
Other FI
5,198 
595 
 
21 
 
273 
49 
 
5,492 
648 
                       
 
10,800 
1,154 
 
72 
11 
 
304 
53 
 
11,176 
1,218 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
6,595 
499 
 
68 
 
32 
 
6,695 
508 
Other FI
7,238 
736 
 
162 
 
269 
50 
 
7,669 
789 
                       
 
13,833 
1,235 
 
230 
 
301 
54 
 
14,364 
1,297 


Key points
·
The Group maintains strong relationships with banks, other financial institutions and large corporate clients.
·
The exposure to Spain is driven by corporate lending and a sizeable mortgage-backed securities covered bond portfolio. Exposure fell further in most categories in the first half of 2012, driven by the sale of part of the covered bond portfolio and a decline in corporate lending, as a result of steps to de-risk the portfolio.

·
Government and Central bank
 
The Group’s exposure was very small at 30 June 2012.

·
Financial institutions
 
The Group’s largest exposure was a covered bond portfolio of £4.6 billion at 30 June 2012, a decrease by £1.9 billion in H1 2012, largely as a result of sales. The portfolio continued to perform satisfactorily. However, the Group is monitoring the situation closely, including undertaking stress analyses.
 
A further £1.8 billion of the Group’s exposure consisted of derivatives to Spanish international banks and a few of the large regional banks, the majority of which was collateralised.
 
Lending to banks consists mainly of short-term uncommitted credit lines with the top two international Spanish banks.

·
Corporate
 
Lending decreased by £0.8 billion and off-balance exposure by another £0.7 billion, due to reductions mostly in the natural resources and property sectors. Commercial real estate lending amounted to £2.1 billion at 30 June 2012, nearly all in Non-Core. The majority of REIL and loan provisions relates to commercial real estate lending and further decreased over the first half of 2012, reflecting disposals and restructurings.

·
Non-Core (included above)
 
At 30 June 2012, Non-Core had lending exposure of £3.2 billion to Spain, a reduction of £0.5 billion or 14% since 31 December 2011. The real estate (67%), construction (12%) and electricity (8%) sectors account for the majority of the remaining lending exposure.
 
 
221

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Italy

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
 
326 
(108)
 
4,096 
4,520 
 
(98)
 
81 
 
 
(17)
 
 
(17)
Central bank
32 
 
 
 
 
 
 
32 
 
 
32 
Other banks
176 
 
118 
(11)
 
41 
84 
 
75 
 
1,515 
 
 
1,766 
 
25 
 
1,791 
Other FI
257 
 
516 
(12)
 
34 
11 
 
 539 
 
141 
 
 
937 
 
781 
 
1,718 
Corporate
1,587 
119 
38 
 
73 
 
80 
 
144 
 
580 
 
 
2,311 
 
1,859 
 
   4,170 
Personal
25 
 
 
 
 
 
 
25 
 
12 
 
37 
                                           
 
2,077 
119 
38 
 
1,033 
(131)
 
4,251 
4,624 
 
660 
 
2,317 
 
 
5,054 
 
2,677 
 
7,731 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
 
704 
(220)
 
4,336 
4,725 
 
315 
 
90 
 
 
405 
 
 
405 
Central bank
73 
 
 
 
 
 
 
73 
 
 
73 
Other banks
233 
 
119 
(14)
 
67 
88 
 
98 
 
1,064 
 
 
1,395 
 
23 
 
1,418 
Other FI
299 
 
685 
(15)
 
40 
13 
 
712 
 
686 
 
 
1,697 
 
1,146 
 
2,843 
Corporate
2,444 
361 
113 
 
75 
 
58 
 
133 
 
474 
 
 
3,051 
 
1,968 
 
5,019 
Personal
23 
 
 
 
 
 
 
23 
 
13 
 
36 
                                           
 
3,072 
361 
113 
 
1,583 
(249)
 
4,501 
4,826 
 
1,258 
 
2,314 
 
 
6,644 
 
3,150 
 
9,794 

Derivative and reverse repo netting were £8,709 million (31 December 2011 - £8,633 million) and £20 million (31 December 2011 - £187 million) respectively.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
11,654 
11,753 
 
1,607 
(1,528)
 
12,125 
12,218 
 
1,750 
(1,708)
Other banks
3,758 
3,771 
 
481 
(465)
 
6,078 
5,938 
 
1,215 
(1,187)
Other FI
753 
729 
 
50 
(45)
 
872 
762 
 
60 
(51)
Corporate
3,367 
3,051 
 
246 
(193)
 
4,742 
4,299 
 
350 
(281)
                       
 
19,532 
19,304 
 
2,384 
(2,231)
 
23,817 
23,217 
 
3,375 
(3,227)
 

 
 
222

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Italy (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
11,382 
1,375 
 
781 
121 
 
59 
10 
 
12,222 
1,506 
Other FI
7,141 
840 
 
 
162 
37 
 
7,310 
878 
                       
 
18,523 
2,215 
 
788 
122 
 
221 
47 
 
19,532 
2,384 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
12,904 
1,676 
 
487 
94 
 
61 
10 
 
13,452 
1,780 
Other FI
10,138 
1,550 
 
 
219 
43 
 
10,365 
1,595 
                       
 
23,042 
3,226 
 
495 
96 
 
280 
53 
 
23,817 
3,375 

Key points
·
The Group maintains strong relationships with Italian government entities, banks, other financial institutions and large corporate clients. Since the start of 2011, the Group has taken steps to reduce its risk through strategic exits where appropriate, or to mitigate its risk through increased collateral requirements, in line with its evolving appetite for Italian risk. Lending exposure to Italian counterparties was reduced by a further £1.0 billion in the first half of 2012, to £2.1 billion.

·
Government and Central bank
 
The Group is an active market-maker in Italian government bonds, resulting in large gross long and short positions in held-for-trading securities.

·
Financial institutions
 
The majority of the Group’s exposure relates to the top five banks. The Group’s product offering consists largely of collateralised trading products and, to a lesser extent, short-term uncommitted lending lines for liquidity purposes. During the first half of 2012, derivative exposure decreased by £0.5 billion due to market movements; risk is mitigated since most facilities are fully collateralised.
   
 
The AFS bond exposure was reduced by £0.2 billion.

·
Corporate
 
Lending declined by £0.9 billion, largely in lending to manufacturing companies.

·
Non-Core (included above)
 
Non-Core lending exposure was £1.0 billion at 30 June 2012, a £0.1 billion (13%) reduction since 31 December 2011, largely within unleveraged funds. The remaining lending exposure mainly comprised commercial real estate (28%), leisure (22%), electricity (15%) and industrials (11%).


 
 


 
223

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Portugal

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
 
55 
(35)
 
12 
23 
 
44 
 
17 
 
 
61 
 
 
61 
Other banks
 
56 
(19)
 
17 
25 
 
48 
 
413 
 
 
461 
 
 
461 
Other FI
 
 
 
 
44 
 
 
48 
 
 
51 
Corporate
411 
201 
161 
 
41 
 
 
47 
 
88 
 
 
546 
 
163 
 
709 
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
14 
                                           
 
417 
201 
161 
 
154 
(54)
 
38 
49 
 
143 
 
562 
 
 
1,122 
 
174 
 
1,296 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
 
56 
(58)
 
36 
152 
 
(60)
 
19 
 
 
(41)
 
 
(41)
Other banks
10 
 
91 
(36)
 
12 
 
101 
 
389 
 
 
500 
 
 
502 
Other FI
 
 
 
12 
 
30 
 
 
42 
 
 
42 
Corporate
495 
27 
27 
 
42 
 
18 
 
60 
 
81 
 
 
636 
 
258 
 
894 
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
13 
                                           
 
510 
27 
27 
 
194 
(93)
 
73 
154 
 
113 
 
519 
 
 
1,142 
 
268 
 
1,410 

Derivative and reverse repo netting were £93 million (31 December 2011 - £114 million) and £41 million (31 December 2011 - £220 million) respectively.

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
3,184 
3,186 
 
689 
(663)
 
3,304 
3,413 
 
997 
(985)
Other banks
984 
993 
 
 143 
(140)
 
1,197 
1,155 
 
264 
(260)
Other FI
 
(1)
 
 
(1)
Corporate
340 
309 
 
60 
(42)
 
366 
321 
 
68 
(48)
                       
 
4,516 
4,493 
 
893 
(846)
 
4,875 
4,894 
 
1,330 
(1,294)
 

 
 
224

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Portugal (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
2,677 
520 
 
37 
 
 
2,714 
527 
Other FI
1,770 
353 
 
 
32 
13 
 
1,802 
366 
                       
 
4,447 
873 
 
37 
 
32 
13 
 
4,516 
893 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
2,922 
786 
 
46 
12 
 
 
2,968 
798 
Other FI
1,874 
517 
 
 
33 
15 
 
1,907 
532 
                       
 
4,796 
1,303 
 
46 
12 
 
33 
15 
 
4,875 
1,330 

Key points
·
The portfolio, managed out of Spain, is focused on corporate lending and derivatives trading with the largest local banks. Medium-term activity has ceased with the exception of that carried out under a Credit Support Annex.
   
·
Exposure declined further during the first half of 2012, with continued reductions in lending and in off-balance sheet exposure, and a sale of Group Treasury’s AFS bonds, partially offset by an increase in derivative and repo exposure explained by a recovery in market prices.

·
Government and Central bank
 
The Group’s exposure to the Portuguese government at 30 June 2012 was £61 million, comprising very small derivative exposure and a small debt securities position - up from a net negative position at 31 December 2011 caused by a net short HFT debt securities position.

·
Financial institutions
 
A major proportion of the remaining exposure is focused on the top four systemically important financial groups. Exposures generally consist of collateralised trading products.

·
Corporate
 
The largest exposure is to the natural resources and transport sectors, concentrated on a few large, highly creditworthy clients.

·
Non-Core (included above)
 
The Non-Core division’s lending exposure to Portugal was reduced by £0.1 billion in the first half of 2012, to less than £0.3 billion. The portfolio largely comprised lending exposure to the land transport and logistics (39%), electricity (38%) and commercial real estate (18%) sectors.


 
225

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Greece

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
 
 
24 
 
16 
 
 
 
20 
 
 
20 
Other banks
 
 
 
 
287 
 
 
287 
 
 
287 
Other FI
30 
 
 
 
 
 
 
32 
 
 
32 
Corporate
149 
87 
98 
 
 
 
 
62 
 
 
211 
 
36 
 
247 
Personal
12 
 
 
 
 
 
 
12 
 
10 
 
22 
                                           
 
195 
87 
98 
 
 
24 
 
16 
 
351 
 
 
562 
 
46 
 
608 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
 
312 
 
102 
 
409 
 
 
 
416 
 
 
416 
Central bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
 
 
 
 
290 
 
 
290 
 
 
290 
Other FI
31 
 
 
 
 
 
 
33 
 
 
33 
Corporate
427 
256 
256 
 
 
 
 
63 
 
 
490 
 
42 
 
532 
Personal
14 
 
 
 
 
 
 
14 
 
10 
 
24 
                                           
 
485 
256 
256 
 
312 
 
102 
 
409 
 
355 
 
 
1,249 
 
52 
 
1,301 

Derivative netting was £223 million (31 December 2011 - £186 million).

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
 
 
3,158 
3,165 
 
2,228 
(2,230)
Other banks
 
(2)
 
22 
22 
 
(3)
Other FI
33 
33 
 
(6)
 
34 
34 
 
(8)
Corporate
376 
370 
 
119 
(120)
 
434 
428 
 
144 
(142)
                       
 
413 
407 
 
125 
(128)
 
3,648 
3,649 
 
2,383 
(2,383)
 
 

 
 
226

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Greece (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band
 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
101 
34 
 
 
 
101 
34 
Other FI
279 
86 
 
 
33 
 
312 
91 
                       
 
380 
120 
 
 
33 
 
413 
125 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
2,001 
1,345 
 
 
 
2,002 
1,346 
Other FI
1,507 
945 
 
63 
45 
 
76 
47 
 
1,646 
1,037 
                       
 
3,508 
2,290 
 
64 
46 
 
76 
47 
 
3,648 
2,383 


Key points
·
The Group has substantially reduced its exposure to Greece which it continues to actively manage, in line with the de-risking strategy that has been in place since early 2010. Much of the remaining exposure is collateralised or guaranteed. The remaining Greek exposure at 30 June 2012 was £0.6 billion, more than half of this being derivative exposure to banks (itself in part collateralised), the remainder is mostly corporate lending (part of this being exposure to local subsidiaries of international companies).

·
Government and Central bank
 
The Group participated in the restructuring of the Greek government debt in March 2012, which resulted in new bonds that were sold in March and April, and in £0.3 billion of AFS bonds issued by the European Financial Stability Facility incorporated in Luxembourg. The Group no longer holds any AFS bonds issued by the Greek government. A small HFT position, resulting from the sovereign debt restructuring in March has been retained to enable the Group to quote prices and stay relevant to key clients.

·
Financial institutions
 
Activity with Greek financial institutions is largely collateralised derivative and repo exposure and remains under close scrutiny.

·
Corporate
 
Lending exposure fell by £0.3 billion, largely due to a single name write-off.
   
 
The Group’s focus is on short-term trade facilities to the domestic subsidiaries of international clients, increasingly supported by parental guarantees.

·
Non-Core (included above)
 
The Non-Core division’s lending exposure to Greece was less than £0.1 billion at 30 June 2012, a slight reduction from 31 December 2011. The remaining lending portfolio primarily consisted of the following sectors: financial intermediaries (43%), construction (27%) and other services (13%).

 
 
 
227

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Cyprus

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Other bank
 
 
 
 
14 
 
 
14 
 
 
14 
Other FI
39 
 
 
 
 
 
 
39 
 
 
39 
Corporate
241 
166 
40 
 
 
 
 
38 
 
 
279 
 
 
               283 
Personal
14 
 
 
 
 
 
 
14 
 
13 
 
27 
                                           
 
294 
166 
40 
 
 
 
 
52 
 
 
346 
 
17 
 
363 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Other bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other FI
38 
 
 
 
 
 
 
39 
 
 
40 
Corporate
250 
169 
40 
 
 
 
 
49 
 
 
301 
 
56 
 
357 
Personal
14 
 
 
 
 
 
 
14 
 
10 
 
24 
                                           
 
302 
169 
40 
 
 
 
 
56 
 
 
360 
 
68 
 
428 

Derivative and reverse repo netting were £3 million (31 December 2011 - nil) and £2 million (31 December 2011 - £22 million) respectively.


 
228

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Germany

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
 
8,612 
500 
 
5,483 
1,695 
 
12,400
 
491 
 
 
12,891 
 
763 
 
13,654 
Central bank
17,351 
 
 
 
 
 
 
17,351 
 
 
          17,351 
Other banks
610 
 
630 
 
343 
578 
 
395
 
6,120 
 
191 
 
7,316 
 
266 
 
7,582 
Other FI
299 
 
353 
(33)
 
141 
45 
 
449
 
3,152 
 
199 
 
4,099 
 
1,270 
 
5,369 
Corporate
5,525 
254 
90 
 
163 
12 
 
17 
 
173
 
520 
 
 
6,218 
 
6,007 
 
12,225 
Personal
156 
 
 
 
 
 
 
156 
 
23 
 
179 
                                           
 
23,941 
258 
94 
 
9,758 
488 
 
5,984 
2,325 
 
13,417
 
10,283 
 
390 
 
48,031 
 
8,329 
 
56,360 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
 
12,035 
523 
 
4,136 
2,084 
 
14,087 
 
423 
 
 
14,510 
 
 
14,512 
Central bank
18,068 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18,070 
 
 
18,070 
Other banks
653 
 
1,376 
 
294 
761 
 
909 
 
5,886 
 
117 
 
7,565 
 
284 
 
7,849 
Other FI
305 
 
563 
(33)
 
187 
95 
 
655 
 
3,272 
 
49 
 
4,281 
 
1,116 
 
5,397 
Corporate
6,608 
191 
80 
 
109 
 
14 
 
116 
 
586 
 
 
7,310 
 
6,103 
 
13,413 
Personal
155 
19 
19 
 
 
 
 
 
 
155 
 
22 
 
177 
                                           
 
25,789 
210 
99 
 
14,083 
504 
 
4,631 
2,947 
 
15,767 
 
10,169 
 
166 
 
51,891 
 
7,527 
 
59,418 

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
2,895 
2,610 
 
64 
(64)
 
2,631 
2,640 
 
76 
(67)
Other banks
3,336 
3,331 
 
126 
(125)
 
4,765 
4,694 
 
307 
(310)
Other FI
2,595 
2,377 
 
13 
(10)
 
3,653 
3,403 
 
(2)
Corporate
14,387 
13,087 
 
(64)
99 
 
20,433 
18,311 
 
148 
(126)
                       
 
23,213 
21,405 
 
139 
(100)
 
31,482 
29,048 
 
538 
(505)
 
 

 
 
229

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Germany (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
11,166 
43 
 
142 
 
 
11,312 
46 
Other FI
11,527 
91 
 
17 
(1)
 
357 
 
11,901 
93 
                       
 
22,693 
134 
 
159 
 
361 
 
23,213 
139 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
14,644 
171 
 
163 
 
 
14,815 
175 
Other FI
16,315 
357 
 
18 
 
334 
 
16,667 
363 
                       
 
30,959 
528 
 
181 
 
342 
 
31,482 
538 


 
230

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Netherlands

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
 
1,306 
59 
 
1,270 
1,202 
 
1,374 
 
35 
 
 
1,410 
 
27 
 
1,437 
Central bank
9,185 
 
 
 
 
 
 
9,185 
 
 
9,185 
Other banks
617 
 
629 
119 
 
195 
377 
 
447 
 
7,676 
 
552 
 
9,292 
 
3,464 
 
12,756 
Other FI
1,556 
 
6,353 
(329)
 
310 
50 
 
6,613 
 
1,905 
 
81 
 
10,155 
 
2,207 
 
12,362 
Corporate
4,755 
588 
230 
 
83 
 
49 
18 
 
114 
 
645 
 
 
5,515 
 
6,244 
 
11,759 
Personal
29 
26 
21 
 
 
 
 
 
 
29 
 
12 
 
41 
                                           
 
16,143 
614 
251 
 
8,371 
(146)
 
1,824 
1,647 
 
8,548 
 
10,261 
 
634 
 
35,586 
 
11,954 
 
47,540 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
 
1,447 
74 
 
849 
591 
 
1,705 
 
40 
 
 
1,753 
 
 
    1,753 
Central bank
7,654 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,667 
 
 
7,667 
Other banks
623 
 
802 
217 
 
365 
278 
 
889 
 
7,410 
 
164 
 
9,086 
 
3,566 
 
12,652 
Other FI
1,557 
 
6,804 
(386)
 
290 
108 
 
6,986 
 
1,806 
 
108 
 
10,457 
 
3,388 
 
13,845 
Corporate
4,827 
621 
209 
 
199 
 
113 
 
307 
 
747 
 
 
5,884 
 
6,596 
 
12,480 
Personal
20 
 
 
 
 
 
 
20 
 
11 
 
31 
                                           
 
14,689 
624 
211 
 
9,252 
(89)
 
1,623 
982 
 
9,893 
 
10,010 
 
275 
 
34,867 
 
13,561 
 
48,428 

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
1,156 
1,108 
 
 20 
(20)
 
1,206 
1,189 
 
31 
(31)
Other banks
708 
747 
 
19 
(18)
 
965 
995 
 
41 
(42)
Other FI
3,275 
3,157 
 
100 
(94)
 
5,772 
5,541 
 
142 
(131)
Corporate
9,432 
8,364 
 
159 
(73)
 
15,416 
14,238 
 
257 
(166)
                       
 
14,571 
13,376 
 
298 
(205)
 
23,359 
21,963 
 
471 
(370)

 
 
 
231

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Netherlands (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                             
Banks
5,411 
42 
 
66 
 
 
 
5,481 
43 
Other FI
7,940 
145 
 
307 
32 
 
701 
69 
 
142 
 
9,090 
255 
                             
 
13,351 
187 
 
373 
33 
 
705 
69 
 
142 
 
14,571 
298 
                             
31 December 2011
                           
                             
Banks
7,605 
107 
 
88 
 
 
 
7,699 
108 
Other FI
14,529 
231 
 
308 
37 
 
676 
81 
 
147 
14 
 
15,660 
363 
                             
 
22,134 
338 
 
396 
38 
 
682 
81 
 
147 
14 
 
23,359 
471 


 
232

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: France

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
498 
 
1,110 
(27)
 
6,056 
4,596 
 
2,570
 
197 
 
 
3,265 
 
821 
 
4,086 
Central bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
829 
 
726 
 
143 
102 
 
767
 
6,309 
 
347 
 
8,252 
 
503 
 
8,755 
Other FI
176 
 
705 
(22)
 
180 
138 
 
747
 
655 
 
54 
 
1,632 
 
882 
 
2,514 
Corporate
2,913 
33 
13 
 
242 
14 
 
148 
130 
 
260
 
716 
 
 
3,889 
 
7,174 
 
   11,063 
Personal
73 
 
 
 
 
 
 
73 
 
75 
 
148 
                                           
 
4,491 
33 
13 
 
2,783 
(34)
 
6,527 
4,966 
 
4,344 
 
7,877 
 
401 
 
17,113 
 
9,455 
 
26,568 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
481 
 
2,648 
(14)
 
8,705 
5,669 
 
5,684 
 
357 
 
 
6,522 
 
911 
 
7,433 
Central bank
 
20 
 
 
20 
 
 
 
23 
 
 
23 
Other banks
1,273 
 
889 
(17)
 
157 
75 
 
971 
 
7,009 
 
262 
 
9,515 
 
474 
 
9,989 
Other FI
282 
 
642 
(40)
 
325 
126 
 
841 
 
592 
 
83 
 
1,798 
 
928 
 
2,726 
Corporate
3,761 
128 
74 
 
240 
 
72 
34 
 
278 
 
743 
 
 
4,782 
 
7,829 
 
12,611 
Personal
79 
 
 
 
 
 
 
79 
 
75 
 
154 
                                           
 
5,879 
128 
74 
 
4,439 
(62)
 
9,259 
5,904 
 
7,794 
 
8,701 
 
345 
 
22,719 
 
10,217 
 
32,936 

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
3,397 
2,714 
 
154 
(139)
 
3,467 
2,901 
 
228 
(195)
Other banks
3,518 
3,486 
 
201 
(172)
 
4,232 
3,995 
 
282 
(236)
Other FI
1,817 
1,509 
 
81 
(69)
 
2,590 
2,053 
 
136 
(117)
Corporate
14,134 
13,383 
 
226 
(196)
 
23,224 
21,589 
 
609 
(578)
                       
 
22,866 
21,092 
 
662 
(576)
 
33,513 
30,538 
 
1,255 
(1,126)

 
 
 
233

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: France (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
10,391 
279 
 
148 
10 
 
76 
 
10,615 
297 
Other FI
11,933 
343 
 
21 
 
297 
21 
 
12,251 
365 
                       
 
22,324 
622 
 
169 
11 
 
373 
29 
 
22,866 
662 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
13,353 
453 
 
162 
13 
 
79 
 
13,594 
474 
Other FI
19,641 
758 
 
24 
 
254 
22 
 
19,919 
781 
                       
 
32,994 
1,211 
 
186 
14 
 
333 
30 
 
33,513 
1,255 


 
234

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Belgium

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
 
745 
(94)
 
1,253 
718 
 
1,280 
 
95 
 
 
1,375 
 
 
1,375 
Central bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
300 
 
 
 
 
2,514 
 
21 
 
2,835 
 
 
2,842 
Other FI
246 
 
 
 
 
220 
 
 
466 
 
81 
 
547 
Corporate
493 
49 
18 
 
 
10 
 
 
220 
 
 
715 
 
1,306 
 
2,021 
Personal
21 
 
 
 
 
 
 
21 
 
 
29 
                                           
 
1,060 
49 
18 
 
753 
(94)
 
1,257 
728 
 
1,282 
 
3,052 
 
21 
 
5,415 
 
1,402 
 
6,817 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
 
742 
(116)
 
608 
722 
 
628 
 
89 
 
 
717 
 
 
717 
Central bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
11 
 
 
11 
Other banks
287 
 
 
 
 
2,399 
 
51 
 
2,741 
 
 
       2,749 
Other FI
354 
 
 
 
(3)
 
191 
 
 
542 
 
64 
 
606 
Corporate
588 
31 
21 
 
 
20 
 
23 
 
277 
 
 
888 
 
1,279 
 
2,167 
Personal
20 
 
 
 
 
 
 
20 
 
 
28 
                                           
 
1,257 
31 
21 
 
749 
(116)
 
629 
726 
 
652 
 
2,959 
 
51 
 
4,919 
 
1,359 
 
6,278 

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
1,569 
1,451 
 
60 
(55)
 
1,612 
1,505 
 
120 
(110)
Other banks
313 
311 
 
(6)
 
312 
302 
 
14 
(13)
Corporate
367 
355 
 
(3)
 
563 
570 
 
12 
(12)
                       
 
2,249 
2,117 
 
69 
(64)
 
2,487 
2,377 
 
146 
(135)

 
 
235

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Belgium (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
1,519 
46 
 
 
12 
 
1,533 
46 
Other FI
710 
23 
 
 
 
716 
23 
                       
 
2,229 
69 
 
 
17 
 
2,249 
69 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
1,602 
97 
 
 
12 
 
1,616 
98 
Other FI
866 
48 
 
 
 
871 
48 
                       
 
2,468 
145 
 
 
16 
 
2,487 
146 


 
236

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Luxembourg

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Other banks
 
10 
 
44 
 
52 
 
547 
 
12 
 
612 
 
 
612 
Other FI
471 
 
41 
(6)
 
221 
 
258 
 
824 
 
381 
 
1,934 
 
350 
 
2,284 
Corporate
2,100 
978 
310 
 
 
25 
29 
 
 
207 
 
 
2,308 
 
1,582 
 
          3,890 
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                                           
 
2,575 
978 
310 
 
56 
(5)
 
290 
35 
 
311 
 
1,578 
 
393 
 
4,857 
 
1,934 
 
6,791 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Other banks
101 
 
10 
 
 
17 
 
530 
 
16 
 
664 
 
 
664 
Other FI
925 
 
54 
(7)
 
82 
80 
 
56 
 
2,174 
 
789 
 
3,944 
 
711 
 
4,655 
Corporate
2,228 
897 
301 
 
 
58 
 
57 
 
180 
 
 
2,465 
 
1,294 
 
3,759 
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                                           
 
3,256 
897 
301 
 
69 
(7)
 
147 
86 
 
130 
 
2,884 
 
805 
 
7,075 
 
2,007 
 
9,082 

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Other FI
1,063 
1,013 
 
83 
(76)
 
2,080 
1,976 
 
118 
(108)
Corporate
1,577 
1,302 
 
97 
(83)
 
2,478 
2,138 
 
146 
(116)
                       
 
2,640 
2,315 
 
180 
(159)
 
4,558 
4,114 
 
264 
(224)

 
 
237

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Luxembourg (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
969 
71 
 
14 
 
 
983 
71 
Other FI
1,571 
103 
 
 
78 
 
1,657 
109 
                       
 
2,540 
174 
 
22 
 
78 
 
2,640 
180 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
1,535 
93 
 
16 
 
 
1,551 
93 
Other FI
2,927 
164 
 
10 
 
70 
 
3,007 
171 
                       
 
4,462 
257 
 
26 
 
70 
 
4,558 
264 


 
238

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Other eurozone (1)

 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
 
AFS and 
LAR debt 
securities 
AFS 
reserves 
 
HFT
debt securities
 
Total 
debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
 
Reverse 
repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
 
Off-balance 
 sheet 
 
Total 
Long 
Short 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Government
60 
 
329 
(46)
 
652 
316 
 
 665 
 
746 
 
 
1,471 
 
 
1,471 
Central bank
 
 
 
 
25 
 
 
25 
 
 
25 
Other banks
16 
 
53 
 
51 
52 
 
52 
 
911 
 
13 
 
992 
 
173 
 
1,165 
Other FI
73 
 
97 
(8)
 
17 
46 
 
68 
 
14 
 
18 
 
173 
 
65 
 
238 
Corporate
974 
199 
68 
 
135 
(2)
 
 
137 
 
47 
 
 
1,158 
 
1,049 
 
            2,207 
Personal
13 
 
 
 
 
 
 
13 
 
25 
 
38 
                                           
 
1,136 
199 
68 
 
614 
(56)
 
729 
421 
 
922 
 
1,743 
 
31 
 
3,832 
 
1,312 
 
5,144 
                                           
31 December 2011
                                         
                                           
Government
121 
 
327 
(47)
 
445 
331 
 
441 
 
779 
 
 
1,341 
 
25 
 
1,366 
Central bank
 
 
 
 
23 
 
 
23 
 
 
23 
Other banks
28 
 
63 
(1)
 
13 
70 
 
 
1,011 
 
 
1,045 
 
94 
 
1,139 
Other FI
77 
 
100 
(9)
 
25 
 
123 
 
36 
 
 
236 
 
130 
 
366 
Corporate
1,125 
12 
15 
 
134 
(4)
 
11 
 
138 
 
45 
 
 
1,308 
 
1,038 
 
2,346 
Personal
12 
 
 
 
 
 
 
12 
 
10 
 
22 
                                           
 
1,363 
12 
15 
 
624 
(61)
 
494 
410 
 
708 
 
1,894 
 
 
3,965 
 
1,297 
 
5,262 

 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Notional 
 
Fair value
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
CDS by reference entity
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Government
2,269 
2,188 
 
27 
(21)
 
2,281 
2,350 
 
54 
(47)
Other banks
76 
71 
 
(1)
 
90 
87 
 
(1)
Corporate
2,687 
2,608 
 
37 
(28)
 
4,054 
3,944 
 
70 
(59)
                       
 
5,032 
4,867 
 
65 
(50)
 
6,425 
6,381 
 
126 
(107)


For the note to this table refer to the following page.
 

 
 
239

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Other eurozone (1) (continued)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
 value 
 
Notional 
Fair 
value 
30 June 2012
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                       
Banks
2,373 
35 
 
49 
 
 
2,422 
35 
Other FI
2,563 
29 
 
 
44 
 
2,610 
30 
                       
 
4,936 
64 
 
52 
 
44 
 
5,032 
65 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
                       
Banks
2,877 
58 
 
50 
 
 
2,927 
59 
Other FI
3,464 
67 
 
 
30 
 
3,498 
67 
                       
 
6,341 
125 
 
54 
 
30 
 
6,425 
126 


Note:
(1)
Comprises Austria, Estonia, Finland, Malta, Slovakia and Slovenia.


 
240

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)

Risk management: Country risk: Eurozone non-periphery

Key points
·
Germany and Netherlands - The Group holds significant short-term surplus liquidity with central banks given credit risk and capital considerations and limited alternative investment opportunities; this exposure also fluctuates as part of the Group’s asset and liability management. In addition, net long HFT positions in German bonds in Markets increased, driven by market opportunities. Concurrently, German AFS bond positions in Group Treasury were reduced in line with internal liquidity management strategies.
   
·
France - During the first half of 2012, in anticipation of widening credit spreads and as part of general risk management, the Group reduced its holdings in French bonds, both AFS in Group Treasury and HFT in Markets.

·
Government and central banks
 
Belgium - Net HFT government bonds exposure increased by £0.6 billion reflecting fluctuations in market making positions.

·
Financial institutions
 
Germany and Netherlands - Derivative and repo exposure to financial institutions increased during the first half of 2012 by £0.7 billion in Netherlands, driven by a few large banks, and by £0.3 billion in Germany, spread over a larger number of names.
   
 
France - Approximately two thirds of the lending to banks is to the top three banks under uncommitted facilities.
   
 
Luxembourg - Lending to banks and non-bank financial institutions decreased by £0.6 billion during the first half of 2012, spread over a number of financial intermediaries, funds and banks.

·
Corporate
 
Germany - Lending to corporate clients fell by £1.1 billion, driven by reductions in the transport, media, commercial real estate, electricity and media sectors.
   
 
France - Corporate lending decreased by £0.8 billion, due to reductions in the telecommunications, commercial real estate and construction sectors.

·
Non-Core (included above)
 
Non-Core lending exposure has been generally reduced in line with the Group’s strategic plan.
   
 
Non-Core lending exposure in France was £2.0 billion at 30 June 2012, a decline of £0.3 billion since 31 December 2011. The lending portfolio mainly comprised property (41%) and sovereign and quasi-sovereign (24%) exposures.
   
 
Non-Core lending exposure in Germany was £4.5 billion at 30 June 2012, down £0.9 billion since 31 December 2011. Most of the lending was in the property (50%) and transport (27%) sectors.
 

 
 
241

 
Risk factors

The principal risks and uncertainties facing the Group are unchanged from those disclosed on pages 405 to 418 of the Group’s 2011 Annual Report.

Summary of our Principal Risks and Uncertainties
Set out below is a summary of certain risks which could adversely affect the Group. These should not be regarded as a complete and comprehensive statement of all potential risks and uncertainties. The summary should be read in conjunction with the Risk and balance sheet management section on pages 58 to 207 of the Groups 2011 Annual Report, which also includes a fuller description of these and other risk factors (pages 405 to 418).

·
The Group’s businesses, earnings and financial condition and liquidity have been and will continue to be affected by geopolitical conditions, the global economy, instability in the global financial markets and increased competition. Together with a perceived increased risk of default on the sovereign debt of certain European countries and unprecedented stresses on the financial system within the eurozone, the above factors have resulted in significant fluctuations in market conditions including interest rates, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads, and other market factors and consequent changes in asset valuations.
   
·
The Group’s ability to meet its obligations, including its funding commitments, depends on the Group’s ability to access sources of liquidity and funding. The inability to access liquidity and funding due to market conditions or otherwise could adversely affect the Group’s financial condition. Furthermore, the Group’s borrowing costs and its access to the debt capital markets and other sources of liquidity depend significantly on its and the UK Government’s credit ratings.
   
·
The Independent Commission on Banking has published its final report on competition and possible structural reforms in the UK banking industry. The Government has indicated that it supports and intends to implement the recommendations substantially as proposed which could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s structure, financial condition and results.
   
·
The Group’s ability to implement its Strategic Plan depends on the success of its efforts to refocus on its core strengths and its balance sheet reduction programme. As part of the Group’s Strategic Plan and implementation of the State Aid restructuring plan agreed with the European Commission and HM Treasury, the Group is undertaking an extensive restructuring which may adversely affect the Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition and give rise to increased operational risk and may impair the Group’s ability to raise new Tier 1 capital due to restrictions on its ability to make discretionary dividend or coupon payments on certain securities.
   
·
The occurrence of a delay in the implementation of (or any failure to implement) the approved proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to the Royal Bank may have a material adverse effect on the Group.
   
·
The Group or any of its UK bank subsidiaries may face the risk of full nationalisation or other resolution procedures and various actions could be taken by or on behalf of the UK Government in the event that any such entities are failing, or likely to fail, including actions in relation to any securities issued, new or existing contractual arrangements and transfers of part or all of the Group’s businesses.
   
·
The actual or perceived failure or worsening credit of the Group’s counterparties or borrowers and depressed asset valuations resulting from poor market conditions have adversely affected and could continue to adversely affect the Group.
 

 
 
242

 
Risk factors (continued)

·
The value of certain financial instruments recorded at fair value is determined using financial models incorporating assumptions, judgements and estimates that may change over time or may ultimately not turn out to be accurate.
   
·
Changes in interest rates, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads, bond, equity and commodity prices, basis, volatility and correlation risks and other market factors have significantly affected and will continue to affect the Group's business and results of operation.
   
·
The Group’s insurance businesses are subject to inherent risks involving claims on insured events.
   
·
The Group’s business performance, financial condition and capital and liquidity ratios could be adversely affected if its capital is not managed effectively or as a result of changes to capital adequacy and liquidity requirements, including those arising out of Basel III implementation (globally or by European or UK authorities), or if the Group is unable to issue Contingent B Shares to HM Treasury under certain circumstances.
   
·
Any significant developments in regulatory or tax legislation could have an effect on how the Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition, and the recoverability of certain deferred tax assets recognised by the Group is subject to uncertainty.
   
·
The Group is subject to substantial regulation and oversight, and any significant regulatory or legal developments could have an adverse effect on how the Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition. In addition, the Group is, and may be, subject to litigation and regulatory investigations that may adversely impact its business, results of operations and financial condition.
   
·
Operational and reputational risks are inherent in the Group’s operations.
   
·
The Group could fail to attract or retain senior management, which may include members of the Group Board, or other key employees, and it may suffer if it does not maintain good employee relations.
   
·
The Group may be required to make contributions to its pension schemes and government compensation schemes, either of which may have an adverse impact on the Group’s results of operations, cash flow and financial condition.
   
·
As a result of the UK Government’s majority shareholding in the Group it can, and in the future may decide to, exercise a significant degree of influence over the Group including on dividend policy, modifying or cancelling contracts or limiting the Group’s operations. The offer or sale by the UK Government of all or a portion of its shareholding in the company could affect the market price of the equity shares and other securities and acquisitions of ordinary shares by the UK Government (including through conversions of other securities or further purchases of shares) may result in the delisting of the Group from the Official List.
 

 
 
243

 
Additional information

 
30 June 
2012 
31 March 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
       
Ordinary share price*
215.3p 
276.4p 
201.8p 
       
Number of ordinary shares in issue*
6,017m 
5,955m 
5,923m 

*prior period data have been adjusted for the sub-division and one-for-ten share consolidation of ordinary shares, which took effect in June 2012.

Capitalisation of the Group
The following table shows the Group’s issued and fully paid share capital, owners’ equity and indebtedness on an unaudited consolidated basis in accordance with IFRS as at 30 June 2012.
 
 
As at 
30 June 
 2012 
 
£m 
   
Share capital - allotted, called up and fully paid
 
Ordinary shares of 100p
6,017 
B shares of £0.10
510 
Dividend access share of £0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of US$0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of €0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of £1.00
   
 
6,528 
Retained income and other reserves
67, 488 
   
Owners’ equity
74, 016 
   
Group indebtedness
 
Subordinated liabilities
25,596 
Debt securities in issue
119, 855 
   
Total indebtedness
145,451 
   
Total capitalisation and indebtedness
219,467 

Under IFRS, certain preference shares are classified as debt and are included in subordinated liabilities in the table above.
 
Since 30 June 2012 buybacks of debt securities net of issuances totalled £256 million.
 
Other than as disclosed above, the information contained in the tables above has not changed materially since 30 June 2012.
 

 
244

 
Additional information (continued)

Ratio of earnings to fixed charges

 
Quarter ended 
30 June 
 2012(3) 
Year ended 31 December
2011 
2010 
2009(3)
2008(3)
2007 
             
Ratio of earnings to combined fixed charges
  and preference share dividends (1,2)
           
  - including interest on deposits
0.91 
0.91 
0.94 
­0.75 
0.05 
1.45 
  - excluding interest on deposits
0.60 
0.25 
0.38 
­
 
5.73 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges only (1,2)
           
  - including interest on deposits
0.95 
0.91 
0.95 
­0.80 
0.05 
1.47 
  - excluding interest on deposits
0.72 
0.25 
0.44 
­
 
6.53 


Notes
(1)
For this purpose, earnings consist of income before tax and non-controlling interests, plus fixed charges less the unremitted income of associated undertakings (share of profits less dividends received). Fixed charges consist of total interest expense, including or excluding interest on deposits and debt securities in issue, as appropriate, and the proportion of rental expense deemed representative of the interest factor (one third of total rental expenses).
(2)
The earnings for the quarter ended 30 June 2012 and for years ended 31 December 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008, were inadequate to cover total fixed charges and preference share dividends. The coverage deficiency for total fixed charges and preference share dividends for the quarter ended 30 June 2012 was £177 million and for the years ended 31 December 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008 were £766 million, £523 million, £3,582 million and £26,287 million, respectively. The coverage deficiency for fixed charges only for quarter ended 30 June 2012 was £101 million and for the years ended 31 December 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008 were £766 million, £399 million, £2,647 million and £25,691 million, respectively
(3)
Based on unaudited numbers.
(4)
Negative ratios have been excluded.

 
 
245

 
 
 
Signatures

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
 

The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc
Registrant

 
/s/ Rajan Kapoor
 
Rajan Kapoor
 
Group Chief Accountant
 
31 August 2012  
 
 
 
 
246

 

 
 

 








Appendix 1
 
 

Businesses outlined for
Disposal
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

 

Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal

 
To comply with EC State Aid requirements the Group agreed to make a series of divestments by the end of 2013: the disposal of Direct Line Group, Global Merchant Services and its interest in RBS Sempra Commodities JV. The Group also agreed to dispose of its RBS England and Wales and NatWest Scotland branch-based businesses, along with certain SME and corporate activities across the UK (‘UK branch-based businesses’). The disposals of Global Merchant Services and RBS Sempra Commodities JV businesses have now effectively been completed.

The Group continues to work with Santander on the sale of the UK branch-based businesses. The complexity of the transaction and the focus on causing minimum disruption to customers is likely to lead to an extension of the process well into 2013.

Preparations for the planned IPO of Direct Line Group in the latter part of 2012 remain on track. The company is prepared for separation and, from 1 July, is operating on a substantially standalone basis with its own corporate functions and HR platform. Residual IT services will be provided by the Group under a Transitional Services Agreement. Direct Line Group returned £800 million to the Group during H1 2012 as part of the optimisation of its capital structure.

The table below shows total income and operating profit of Direct Line Group and the UK branch-based businesses.
 
 
Total income
 
Operating profit
before impairments
 
Operating profit
 
H1 2012 
FY 2011 
 
H1 2012 
FY 2011 
 
H1 2012 
FY 2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                 
Direct Line Group (1)
1,900 
4,286 
 
219 
407 
 
219 
407 
UK branch-based businesses (2)
458 
959 
 
253 
518 
 
186 
319 
                 
Total
2,358 
5,245 
 
472 
925 
 
405 
726 

The table below shows the estimated risk-weighted assets, total assets and capital of the businesses identified for disposal.

 
RWAs
 
Total assets
 
Capital
 
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
                 
Direct Line Group (1)
n/m 
n/m 
 
13.4 
13.9 
 
3.6 
4.4 
UK branch-based businesses (2)
10.3 
11.1 
 
19.2 
19.3 
 
1.0 
1.1 
                 
Total
10.3 
11.1 
 
32.6 
33.2 
 
4.6 
5.5 

Notes:
(1)
Total income includes investment income of £163 million (FY 2011 - £302 million). Total assets and estimated capital include approximately £0.9 billion of goodwill, of which £0.7 billion is attributed to Direct Line Group by RBS Group.
(2)
Estimated notional equity based on 10% of RWAs.
 
 
1

 
 
Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal (continued)

 
Further information on the UK branch-based businesses by division is shown in the tables below:

 
Division
 
Total
 
UK 
Retail 
UK 
Corporate 
 
H1 2012 
FY 2011 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
Income statement
         
Net interest income
157 
179 
 
336 
689 
Non-interest income
45 
77 
 
122 
270 
           
Total income
202 
256 
 
458 
959 
           
Direct expenses
         
  - staff
(35)
(40)
 
(75)
(158)
  - other
(47)
(28)
 
(75)
(166)
Indirect expenses
(30)
(25)
 
(55)
(117)
           
 
(112)
(93)
 
(205)
(441)
           
Operating profit before impairment losses
90 
163 
 
253 
518 
Impairment losses
(30)
(37)
 
(67)
(199)
           
Operating profit
60 
126 
 
186 
319 
           
Analysis of income by product
         
Loans and advances
57 
147 
 
204 
436 
Deposits
41 
73 
 
114 
245 
Mortgages
67 
 
67 
134 
Other
37 
36 
 
73 
144 
           
Total income
202 
256 
 
458 
959 
           
Net interest margin
4.60% 
3.19% 
 
3.72% 
3.57% 
Employee numbers (full time equivalents rounded to the
  nearest hundred)
2,700 
1,600 
 
4,300 
4,400 

 
Division
 
Total
 
UK 
Retail 
UK 
Corporate 
Markets 
 
30 June 
2012 
31 December 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets (excluding mark-to-
  market derivatives)
7.3 
11.5 
 
18.8 
18.9 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
7.5 
11.9 
 
19.4 
19.5 
Customer deposits
8.6 
13.1 
 
21.7 
21.8 
Derivative assets
0.4 
 
0.4 
0.4 
Derivative liabilities
0.1 
 
0.1 
0.1 
Risk elements in lending
0.5 
0.9 
 
1.4 
1.5 
Loan:deposit ratio
82% 
88% 
 
86% 
86% 
Risk-weighted assets
3.6 
6.7 
 
10.3 
11.1 

 
2

 

Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal (continued)

 
Direct Line Group
The following table analyses the results of Direct Line Group between ‘ongoing’ and ‘run-off’ businesses. The income statement for each period includes the results of Direct Line Versicherung AG (DLVAG) which was acquired by Direct Line Group on 2 April 2012.

 
Half year ended
30 June 2012
 
Half year ended
30 June 2011
 
Ongoing 
Run-off 
Total 
 
Ongoing 
Run-off 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Income statement
             
Earned premiums
2,019 
13 
2,032 
 
2,057 
64 
2,121 
Reinsurers' share
(161)
(4)
(165)
 
(114)
(114)
               
Net premium income
1,858 
1,867 
 
1,943 
64 
2,007 
Fees and commissions
(156)
(66)
(222)
 
(140)
(16)
(156)
Instalment income
62 
62 
 
70 
70 
Other income
30 
30 
 
61 
62 
               
Total income
1,794 
(57)
1,737 
 
1,934 
49 
1,983 
Net claims
(1,254)
29 
(1,225)
 
(1,449)
(39)
(1,488)
               
Underwriting profit/(loss)
540 
(28)
512 
 
485 
10 
495 
               
Staff expenses
(159)
(1)
(160)
 
(142)
(4)
(146)
Other expenses
(171)
(1)
(172)
 
(164)
(2)
(166)
               
Total direct expenses
(330)
(2)
(332)
 
(306)
(6)
(312)
Indirect expenses
(124)
(124)
 
(108)
(2)
(110)
               
Total expenses
(454)
(2)
(456)
 
(414)
(8)
(422)
               
Technical result
86 
(30)
56 
 
71 
73 
Investment income
134 
29 
163 
 
124 
133 
 
             
Operating profit/(loss)
220 
(1)
219 
 
195 
11 
206 
               
Performance ratios
             
 
             
Loss ratio
68% 
 
66% 
 
75% 
 
74% 
Commission ratio
8% 
 
12% 
 
7% 
 
8% 
Expense ratio
24% 
 
24% 
 
21% 
 
21% 
Combined operating ratio
100% 
 
102% 
 
103% 
 
103% 

Operating profit is reported before exceptional items of £109 million (H1 2011 - £8 million) primarily comprising separation and restructuring costs.

 
3

 
 
 
 

 









 

Appendix 2
 
 

Credit risk assets

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
Appendix 2 Credit risk assets

 
Credit risk assets
Credit risk assets analysed in this appendix are presented to supplement the balance sheet related credit risk analyses on pages 157 to 198. Credit risk assets consist of:

Lending - cash and balances at central banks and loans and advances to banks and customers (including overdraft facilities, instalment credit and finance leases);
   
Rate risk management, which includes foreign exchange transactions, interest rate swaps, credit default swaps and options. Exposures are mitigated by (i) offsetting in-the-money and out-of-the-money transactions where such transactions are governed by legally enforcing netting agreements; and (ii) the receipt of financial collateral (primarily cash and bonds) using industry standard collateral agreements; and
   
Contingent obligations, primarily letters of credit and guarantees.

Credit risk assets exclude issuer risk (primarily debt securities) and reverse repurchase arrangements. They take account of legal netting arrangements that provide a right of legal set-off but do not meet the offset criteria under IFRS.

Divisional analysis of credit risk assets
30 June 
2012 
£m 
31 December 
2011 
£m 
     
UK Retail
113,408 
111,070 
UK Corporate
103,528 
105,078 
Wealth
19,677 
20,079 
International Banking
72,644 
72,737 
Ulster Bank
36,605 
37,781 
US Retail & Commercial
56,176 
56,546 
     
Retail & Commercial
402,038 
403,291 
Markets
97,206 
114,327 
Other
67,065 
64,517 
     
Core
566,309 
582,135 
Non-Core
79,732 
92,709 
     
 
646,041 
674,844 

Key points
Total Core exposure decreased by 3% during the period, driven by reduced placement activity with central banks and a reduction in lending and derivatives exposure within the non-bank financial institutions sector.
   
Exposure in Retail & Commercial divisions remained broadly stable, with UK Retail being the only division experiencing growth, driven by an increase in exposure to UK mortgages in line with the Group’s strategy.
   
Non-Core exposure declined by 14% during the period, in line with the Group’s target, as a result of continued disposals and run-off of assets, significant restructurings and unwinding of trades. The decline was observed across all regions, with significant reductions in the commercial real estate, mortgages and financial guarantors sectors.

 
1

 

Appendix 2 Credit risk assets (continued)

 
Credit risk assets (continued)

Asset quality
Internal reporting and oversight of risk assets is principally differentiated by credit grades. Customers are assigned credit grades based on various credit grading models that reflect the key drivers of default for each customer type. All credit grades across the Group map to both a Group level asset quality scale, used for external financial reporting, and a master grading scale for wholesale exposures, used for internal management reporting across portfolios. Accordingly, measures of risk exposure may be readily aggregated and reported at increasing levels of granularity depending on stakeholder or business need.

The table below shows credit risk assets by asset quality (AQ) band:

   
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
Asset quality band
Core 
£m 
Non-Core 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Total 
 
Core 
£m 
Non-Core 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Total 
                     
AQ1
0% - 0.034%
182,074 
10,331 
192,405 
29.8 
 
195,826 
13,732 
209,558 
31.1 
AQ2
0.034% - 0.048%
19,331 
2,456 
21,787 
3.4 
 
18,366 
2,915 
21,281 
3.2 
AQ3
0.048% - 0.095%
26,794 
3,519 
30,313 
4.7 
 
27,082 
2,883 
29,965 
4.4 
AQ4
0.095% - 0.381%
66,630 
8,703 
75,333 
11.7 
 
65,491 
9,636 
75,127 
11.1 
AQ5
0.381% - 1.076%
93,450 
8,721 
102,171 
15.8 
 
92,503 
10,873 
103,376 
15.3 
AQ6
1.076% - 2.153%
66,151 
6,247 
72,398 
11.2 
 
67,260 
6,636 
73,896 
11.0 
AQ7
2.153% - 6.089%
35,504 
6,638 
42,142 
6.5 
 
36,567 
8,133 
44,700 
6.6 
AQ8
6.089% - 17.222%
13,404 
2,151 
15,555 
2.4 
 
11,921 
3,320 
15,241 
2.3 
AQ9
17.222% - 100%
10,909 
3,434 
14,343 
2.2 
 
12,710 
5,024 
17,734 
2.6 
AQ10
100%
19,630 
24,332 
43,962 
6.8 
 
20,029 
25,020 
45,049 
6.7 
Other (1)
 
32,432 
3,200 
35,632 
5.5 
 
34,380 
4,537 
38,917 
5.7 
                     
   
566,309 
79,732 
646,041 
100 
 
582,135 
92,709 
674,844 
100 

Note:
(1)
‘Other’ largely comprises assets covered by the standardised approach, for which a probability of default equivalent to those assigned to assets covered by the internal ratings based approach is not available.

 
2

 

Appendix 2 Credit risk assets (continued)

 
Asset quality (continued)
 
30 June 2012
 
31 December 2011
AQ10 credit risk assets by division
AQ10 
£m 
% of 
 divisional 
 credit risk 
 assets 
 
AQ10 
£m 
% of 
 divisional 
 credit risk 
 assets 
           
UK Retail
5,074 
4.5 
 
5,097 
4.6 
UK Corporate
5,607 
5.4 
 
5,484 
5.2 
Wealth
 
12 
0.1 
International Banking
926 
1.3 
 
1,736 
2.4 
Ulster Bank
6,834 
18.7 
 
6,305 
16.7 
US Retail & Commercial
647 
1.2 
 
646 
1.1 
           
Retail & Commercial
19,088 
4.7 
 
19,280 
4.8 
Markets
542 
0.6 
 
749 
0.7 
           
Core
19,630 
3.5 
 
20,029 
3.4 
Non-Core
24,332 
30.5 
 
25,020 
27.0 
           
 
43,962 
6.8 
 
45,049 
6.7 

Key points
Trends in the asset quality of the Group’s credit risk exposures in the first half of 2012 reflected changes in the composition of the Core portfolio (for details, see the commentary on pages 5 and 6 of this appendix) and the run-off of Non-Core assets. Overall, the asset quality of the Group’s corporate exposure was broadly maintained despite the difficult external conditions in the UK and ongoing uncertainty in the eurozone.
   
The decrease in the Group’s Core exposures within the AQ1 band reflects the decrease in the Group’s exposure to sovereigns.
   
Defaulted assets (AQ10) in Non-Core continued to increase as a percentage of the overall Non-Core portfolio due to the run-off and disposals of performing assets, in line with expectations. Weakness in the commercial real estate market continue to be the main driver of defaulted assets within Non-Core, with approximately 80% of the defaulted assets in Non-Core occurring in that sector.
   
Given continued weaknesses in the Irish economy, the stock of defaulted assets in the Ulster Bank portfolio continued to grow, driven by exposures in the personal and property sectors. Refer to the Risk management section on Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) for more details.
   
Defaulted credit risk assets within International Banking decreased significantly as successful restructurings led to a significant amount of exposure returning to the performing book.

 
3

 

Appendix 2 Credit risk assets (continued)


Credit risk assets by sector and geographical region

30 June 2012
UK 
£m 
Western 
 Europe 
(excl. UK)
£m 
North 
America 
£m 
Asia 
Pacific 
£m 
Latin 
America 
£m 
Other (1)
£m 
Total 
£m 
Core 
£m 
Non- 
Core 
£m 
                   
Personal
128,980 
19,367 
32,412 
1,589 
44 
1,133 
183,525 
178,762 
4,763 
Banks
3,984 
37,644 
5,511 
9,913 
1,560 
2,761 
61,373 
60,902 
471 
Other financial institutions
17,511 
12,736 
10,477 
3,827 
5,874 
814 
51,239 
42,743 
8,496 
Sovereign (2)
30,168 
32,343 
18,351 
670 
68 
1,292 
82,892 
81,830 
1,062 
Property
57,556 
25,226 
8,724 
1,185 
3,253 
1,451 
97,395 
57,846 
39,549 
Natural resources
6,720 
6,581 
7,544 
4,703 
913 
1,882 
28,343 
24,392 
3,951 
Manufacturing
9,855 
6,264 
6,911 
2,067 
826 
1,430 
27,353 
25,575 
1,778 
Transport (3)
13,066 
7,131 
4,751 
5,369 
2,477 
5,079 
37,873 
27,720 
10,153 
Retail and leisure
19,065 
5,612 
4,971 
1,186 
750 
602 
32,186 
28,132 
4,054 
Telecommunications, media
  and technology
5,122 
3,832 
3,377 
1,940 
73 
713 
15,057 
11,653 
3,404 
Business services
17,503 
3,396 
6,245 
881 
600 
180 
28,805 
26,754 
2,051 
                   
 
309,530 
160,132 
109,274 
33,330 
16,438 
17,337 
646,041 
566,309 
79,732 

31 December 2011
                 
                   
Personal
126,945 
20,254 
33,087 
1,604 
158 
1,114 
183,162 
176,201 
6,961 
Banks
4,720 
39,213 
3,952 
11,132 
1,738 
3,276 
64,031 
63,470 
561 
Other financial institutions
16,549 
15,960 
13,319 
3,103 
5,837 
1,159 
55,927 
45,548 
10,379 
Sovereign (2)
21,053 
31,374 
31,391 
3,399 
78 
1,581 
88,876 
87,617 
1,259 
Property
60,099 
27,281 
8,052 
1,370 
3,471 
1,480 
101,753 
58,323 
43,430 
Natural resources
6,552 
7,215 
8,116 
3,805 
1,078 
2,508 
29,274 
25,146 
4,128 
Manufacturing
9,583 
7,391 
7,098 
2,126 
1,011 
1,381 
28,590 
26,525 
2,065 
Transport (3)
13,789 
7,703 
4,951 
5,433 
2,500 
5,363 
39,739 
27,529 
12,210 
Retail and leisure
22,775 
6,101 
5,762 
1,488 
1,041 
675 
37,842 
32,766 
5,076 
Telecommunications, media
  and technology
5,295 
4,941 
3,202 
1,944 
139 
609 
16,130 
12,180 
3,950 
Business services
17,851 
3,719 
6,205 
910 
629 
206 
29,520 
26,830 
2,690 
                   
 
305,211 
171,152 
125,135 
36,314 
17,680 
19,352 
674,844 
582,135 
92,709 

Notes:
(1)
Comprises Central and Eastern Europe, the Middle East, Central Asia and Africa, and supranationals such as the World Bank.
(2)
Includes central bank exposures.
(3)
Excludes net investment in operating leases in shipping and aviation portfolios as they are accounted for as property, plant and equipment. However, operating leases are included in the monitoring and management of these portfolios.
(4)
Enhancements to Wealth credit systems in Q2 2012 resulted in refinements to sector classifications at 30 June 2012. The most significant impact has been a re-allocation of £2.6 billion from the retail and leisure sector across a number of other sectors. Prior period data have not been revised.

 
4

 

Appendix 2 Credit risk assets (continued)


Credit risk assets by sector and geographical region (continued)

Key points
Conditions in financial markets and the Group’s focus on risk appetite and sector concentration had a direct impact on the composition of its portfolio during 2011 and this has continued in the first half of 2012. The following key trends were observed:
 
A 7% decrease in exposures to sovereigns, driven by a reduction in the Group’s placing of deposits with central banks;
 
A 4% reduction in exposures to the property sector, driven by tightened controls in Core and a £4 billion reduction in Non-Core;
 
A 6% reduction in exposure to other banks, driven by economy-wide subdued borrowing activity;
 
An 8% reduction in exposure to financial institutions, driven by a reduction in lending and derivatives across a range of entities, including finance companies, financial services companies, funds, monoline insurers and CDPCs; and
 
A slight increase in exposure to the personal sector, driven by an increase in UK mortgages.
   
The Group’s sovereign portfolio comprises exposures to central governments, central banks and sub-sovereigns such as local authorities, primarily in the Group’s key markets in the UK, Western Europe and the US. Exposure predominantly comprises cash balances placed with central banks such as the Bank of England, the Federal Reserve and the Eurosystem (including the European Central Bank and central banks in the eurozone); consequently, the asset quality of this portfolio is high. Exposure to sovereigns fluctuates according to the Group’s liquidity requirements and cash positions, which determine the level of cash placed with central banks. Information on the Group’s exposure to governments, including eurozone peripheral sovereigns, can be found in the Risk management section on Country risk.
   
The banking sector is one of the largest in the Group’s portfolio. The sector is well diversified geographically and exposures are largely collateralised and tightly controlled through the combination of a single name concentration framework and a suite of credit policies specifically tailored to the sector and country limits. Exposures to the banking sector decreased by £2.7 billion during the period, primarily due to reduced interbank lending and derivative activity.
   
The Group’s exposure to the property sector totalled £97.4 billion at 30 June 2012 (a 4% decline since 31 December 2011), the majority of which relates to commercial real estate (refer to the Risk management section on Commercial real estate for further details). The remainder comprises lending to construction companies, housing associations and building material groups, which remained stable during the period.
   
Core personal lending continued to rise, driven by an increase in UK mortgages. This expansion is in line with strategy and has had no detrimental impact on credit quality (for more commentary refer to the Risk management section on Residential mortgages).
   
Exposure to the retail and leisure sector fell 15% from 31 December 2011, driven by a decline in the Core portfolio as many customers in this sector chose to de-lever balance sheets. The market outlook for this sector remains challenging, but certain sub-sectors have proven resilient to macroeconomic volatilities (e.g. food and beverages) as have large retailers with well established brands and multiple channel offerings. Whilst the sector continues to show wide variation in performance depending on sub-sector and end markets, credit metrics overall remained broadly stable during the period.

 
5

 

Appendix 2 Credit risk assets (continued)

 
Credit risk assets by sector and geographical region (continued)

Key points (continued)
Exposure to the transport sector includes asset-backed exposure to ocean-going vessels. The downturn observed in the shipping sector since 2008 continued into H1 2012, with oversupply of vessels, lower asset prices and lower charter rates. Credit quality in this portfolio continued to deteriorate and, despite no material defaults in this portfolio, the number of clients moved onto the Watchlist increased. The other component of this sector, land transport and logistics, performed satisfactorily in H1 2012.


 
 
6